Mercedes Benz Automobile 2001 CL 500 User Manual

CL  
Operator’s Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Our company and staff congratulate you on the purchase of your new Mercedes-Benz.  
Your selection of our product is a demonstration of your trust in our company name. Further, it exemplifies your desire  
to own an automobile that will be as easy as possible to operate and provide years of service.  
Your Mercedes-Benz represents the efforts of many skilled engineers and craftsmen. To ensure your pleasure of  
ownership, and for your safety and that of your passengers, we ask you to make a small investment of your time:  
Please read this manual carefully before putting it aside. Then return it to your vehicle where it will be handy for  
your reference.  
Please abide by the recommendations contained in this manual. They are designed to acquaint you with the  
operation of your Mercedes-Benz.  
Please abide by the warnings and cautions contained in this manual. They are designed to help improve the safety  
of the vehicle operator and occupants.  
We extend our best wishes for many miles of safe, pleasurable driving.  
DaimlerChrysler AG  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Central locking system ................... 34 Front seat adjustment .....................67  
Introduction  
Radio frequency and  
infrared remote control .............. 34  
Removal and installation  
Product information .......................... 7  
Operator’s manual ............................. 8  
Where to find it ................................ 13  
Reporting Safety Defects ................ 15  
of front seat head restraints ...... 71  
KEYLESS-GO ................................ 38 Backrest .............................................72  
Opening and closing  
windows and  
sliding/pop-up roof  
Lumbar support ............................... 74  
Multicontour backrest ..................... 74  
Seat heater ........................................ 76  
Instruments and controls  
from outside ................................. 45  
Panic button ................................. 47  
Mechanical keys .......................... 47  
Power closing assist for  
doors and trunk lid .................... 50  
Central locking switch .................... 50  
Automatic central locking .............. 52  
Emergency unlocking  
Seat ventilation system ...................79  
Power head restraints, rear ............ 81  
Seat belts and  
integrated restraint system .......82  
Seat belts ...........................................82  
Seat belt nonusage  
Instruments and controls ............... 18  
Door control panel .......................20  
Overhead control panel ...............21  
Dashboard .....................................22  
Center console ..............................24  
warning system ............................83  
BabySmartTM airbag  
Operation  
deactivation system ....................88  
Self-test BabySmartTM  
in case of accident ...................... 52  
Trunk ................................................. 53  
Trunk lid release switch ................ 57  
Vehicle keys ......................................28  
Start lock-out ....................................32  
General notes on the  
without special child  
seat installed .................................89  
central locking system ...............33 Trunk lid release/close switch ...... 58 Supplemental restraint  
system (SRS) ................................90  
Emergency tensioning  
retractor (ETR) ............................. 91  
Airbags ..............................................92  
Trunk lid emergency release .........61  
Antitheft alarm system ................... 62  
Tow-away alarm ............................... 64  
Easy-entry/exit feature .................. 66  
Contents  
1
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Contents  
2
Safety guidelines for the  
Incoming call ...............................131  
Navigation system ..........................132  
Distronic (DTR) ...............................133  
Trip computer .................................134  
Basic setting ...............................168  
Special settings ..........................169  
Air recirculation ......................... 171  
Activated charcoal filter ............172  
Economy mode ...........................173  
Residual engine heat  
utilization .................................... 174  
Switching the automatic  
climate control on and off .........175  
seat belt, emergency  
tensioning retractor  
and airbag ..................................100  
Infant and child  
Malfunction/warning  
restraint systems .......................102  
Steering wheel adjustment ..........105  
Rear view mirrors ..........................106  
Rear view mirror,  
automatic antiglare ...................106  
Memory function ............................111  
Instrument cluster ..........................114  
Multifunction steering wheel,  
multifunction display ...............120  
message memory ......................136  
Individual settings .........................138  
Setting the audio volume ............. 146  
(FSS) ........................................... 147  
Tire inflation  
Front center console storage  
compartment ventilation .......... 175  
pressure monitor .......................150 Rear window defroster .................. 176  
Engine oil level indicator ..............154 Rear passenger compartment  
adjustable air outlets ................177  
Power windows ...............................178  
Sliding/pop-up roof ....................... 181  
Interior lighting .............................184  
Rear window sunshade .................186  
Sun visors .......................................187  
Vanity mirrors ................................187  
Engine oil consumption ................155  
Exterior lamp switch ......................156  
Headlamp mode ..............................157  
Night security illumination ..........158  
Headlamp cleaning system ...........159  
Combination switch .......................160  
Hazard warning flasher  
switch ..........................................163 Interior ............................................188  
Automatic climate control .............164 Storage compartments  
Display and controls ..................166  
Dust filter .....................................167  
Trip and main odometer,  
FSS, tire inflation pressure  
monitor and  
engine oil level indicator .........124  
Audio systems ................................125  
Radio ............................................125  
CD player .....................................126  
Cassette player ...........................127  
Telephone ........................................128  
Telephone book ..........................128  
Redialing .....................................130  
and armrests ..............................188  
Glove box .....................................189  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Coat hooks ...................................... 192 Starting and turning off  
Electronic stability program  
(ESP) ...........................................271  
the engine ..................................227  
Cup holder ...................................... 193  
Ashtrays ..........................................196  
Lighter ............................................. 198  
Parcel net in trunk ........................ 199  
Cargo tie-down hooks ....................200  
Parcel net in front  
passenger footwell ....................200  
Telephone, general ........................201  
Garage door opener .......................202  
Infrared reflecting windshield ....206  
Automatic transmission ...............229 Active body control (ABC) ............275  
Parking brake ................................238 Level control system ...................... 276  
Driving instructions ......................239 Parking assist (Parktronic) ..........279  
Drive sensibly – save fuel ........239 What you should know  
at the gas station .......................284  
Check regularly  
Drinking and driving ................239  
Pedals ..........................................240  
Power assistance ........................ 240  
Brakes ..........................................240  
Parking ........................................ 242  
Tires ............................................. 243  
Snow chains ............................... 245  
Winter driving instructions ..... 246  
Deep water ..................................248  
Passenger compartment ...........248  
Traveling abroad ........................ 249  
Cruise control ................................250  
Distronic (DTR) ..............................253  
and before a long trip ...............287  
Instrument cluster display  
Malfunction and indicator  
lamps in the  
Driving  
instrument cluster ....................290  
On-board diagnostic system .....290  
Check engine malfunction  
indicator lamp .............................290  
Brake warning lamp ..................292  
Supplemental restraint  
Control and operation of radio  
transmitters ...............................208  
The first 1 000 miles  
(1 500 km) .................................209  
Maintenance ...................................209  
Tele Aid ........................................... 210  
Catalytic converter ........................220  
Emission control ............................221  
Starter switch .................................222  
Starter switch – KEYLESS-GO ......224  
system (SRS)  
indicator lamp .............................293  
Fuel reserve warning .................293  
ABS malfunction  
Brake assist system  
(BAS) ..........................................268  
Antilock brake system  
indicator lamp .............................294  
(ABS) ..........................................269  
Contents  
3
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Contents  
4
Electronic stability program  
(ESP) — warning lamp ...............295  
Distronic (DTR) —  
warning lamp ..............................295  
Seat belt nonusage  
warning lamp ..............................296  
Malfunction and indicator  
lamp in the center console ......296  
AIRBAG OFF indicator lamp .....296  
Malfunction and  
warning messages in the  
multifunction display ...............297  
DISPLAY DEFECTIVE  
(engine control unit) ..................298  
DISPLAY DEFECTIVE  
(several systems) ........................298  
BATTERY /ALTERNATOR ..........299  
ENTRANCE POSITION ..............300  
BRAKE ASSIST ...........................300  
BRAKE LINING WEAR ..............301  
BRAKE FLUID .............................301  
PARKING BRAKE .......................302  
TRUNK OPEN .............................302  
ELEC. STABIL. PROG.  
(Electronic stability  
Practical hints  
First aid kit .....................................324  
Fuses ................................................325  
Shelf below rear window ..............327  
Hood .................................................328  
Checking engine oil level .............331  
Automatic transmission  
fluid level ...................................332  
Active body control  
(ABC) fluid level ........................332  
Coolant level ...................................333  
Adding coolant ...........................333  
Windshield and headlamp  
washer system ...........................334  
Windshield and headlamp  
washer fluid mixing ratio .........334  
Spare wheel, vehicle tools,  
storage compartment ................335  
Jack ...................................................336  
Wheels .............................................337  
Tire Replacement .......................337  
Rotating wheels ..........................338  
Spare wheel ....................................338  
program) .....................................303  
COOLANT (coolant level) ......... 304  
COOLANT  
(coolant temperature) ...............305  
LIGHTING SYSTEM ................... 306  
LIGHT SENSOR .......................... 308  
TELEPHONE – FUNCTION ....... 309  
CRUISE CONTROL ..................... 309  
ACTIVE BODY CONTROL  
(ABC) ............................................310  
TIRE PRESSURE .........................312  
ENGINE OIL LEVEL ....................314  
SEAT BACKREST .........................315  
KEY ...............................................316  
DOOR ............................................316  
HOOD ............................................317  
TELE AID ......................................317  
ENGINE OIL LEVEL ....................318  
WASHER FLUID ..........................319  
LIGHT SENSOR .......................... 320  
DISTRONIC (DTR) ...................... 321  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Changing wheels ...........................340 Emergency operation of  
Cleaning the Distronic  
system sensor .............................378  
Cleaning the parktronic  
sliding/pop-up roof ..................369  
Tire inflation pressure ..................345  
Battery .............................................346  
Jump starting ..................................349  
Towing the vehicle .........................351  
Exterior lamps ................................354  
Headlamp assembly ...................355  
Taillamp assemblies ..................358  
Standby bulb function ...................361  
Changing batteries  
in the electronic main key .......363  
Synchronizing  
remote control ............................365  
Changing batteries  
Replacing wiper blades ................370  
Trunk lamp ......................................371  
Roof rack .........................................372  
system sensors ...........................378  
Wiper blades ...............................379  
Light alloy wheels ......................380  
Instrument cluster .....................381  
Steering wheel and  
gear selector lever ......................381  
Cup holder ...................................381  
Seat belts .....................................382  
Headliner and shelf  
below rear window .....................382  
Leather upholstery .....................382  
Hard plastic trim items .............382  
Plastic and rubber parts ............382  
Vehicle care  
Cleaning and care  
of the vehicle ..............................374  
Power washer .............................375  
Paintwork, painted body  
components .................................376  
Engine cleaning ..........................376  
Vehicle washing ..........................376  
Ornamental moldings ...............377  
in the KEYLESS-GO-card .........366  
Emergency engine  
shut-down ...................................368  
Fuel filler flap,  
Headlamps, taillamps,  
turn signal lenses ......................377  
manual release ..........................368  
Contents  
5
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Contents  
6
Technical data  
Index  
Spare parts service ........................384 Index ............................................... 401  
Warranty coverage .........................384  
Identification labels .......................385  
Layout of poly-V-belt drive ............387  
Technical data ................................388  
Fuels, coolants,  
lubricants etc. - capacities .......393  
Engine oils ......................................395  
Engine oil additives .......................395  
Air conditioner refrigerant ...........395  
Brake fluid ......................................395  
Premium unleaded gasoline ........396  
Fuel requirements .........................396  
Gasoline additives .........................397  
Coolants ...........................................397  
Consumer information ..................399  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Product information  
Kindly observe the following in your own best interest:  
We recommend using Mercedes-Benz original parts as well as conversion parts and accessories  
explicitly approved by us for your vehicle model.  
We have tested these parts to determine their reliability, safety and their special  
suitability for Mercedes-Benz vehicles.  
We are unable to make an assessment for other products and therefore cannot be held responsible  
for them, even if in individual cases an official approval or authorization by governmental or other  
agencies should exist. Use of such parts and accessories could adversely affect the safety, performance  
or reliability of your vehicle. Please do not use them.  
Mercedes-Benz original parts as well as conversion parts and accessories approved by us are available  
at your authorized Mercedes-Benz Center where you will receive comprehensive information, also on  
permissible technical modifications, and where proper installation will be performed.  
Introduction  
7
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Introduction  
8
Operator’s manual  
This Operator’s Manual contains a great deal of useful information. We urge you to read it carefully and familiarize  
yourself with the vehicle before driving.  
For your own safety and longer service life of the vehicle, we urge you to follow the instructions and warnings  
contained in this manual. Ignoring them could result in damage to the vehicle or personal injury to you or others.  
Vehicle damage caused by failure to follow instructions is not covered by the Mercedes-Benz Limited Warranty.  
Your vehicle may have some or all of the equipment described in this manual. Therefore, you may find explanations  
for optional equipment not installed in your vehicle. If you have any questions about the operation of any equipment,  
your authorized Mercedes-Benz Center will be glad to demonstrate the proper procedures.  
Service and warranty information  
The Service and Warranty Information Booklet contains detailed information about the warranties covering your  
Mercedes-Benz, including:  
New Car Limited Warranty,  
Emission System Warranty,  
Emission Performance Warranty,  
California, Massachusetts, and Vermont Emission Control System Warranty  
(California, Massachusetts, and Vermont only),  
State Warranty Enforcement Laws (Lemon Laws).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Important notice for California retail buyers of Mercedes-Benz automobiles  
Under California law you may be entitled to a replacement of your vehicle or a refund of the purchase price, if  
Mercedes-Benz USA, LLC or its authorized Mercedes-Benz Center fails to conform the vehicle to its express warranties  
after a reasonable number of repair attempts during the period of one year or 12 000 miles from original delivery of  
the vehicle. A reasonable number of repair attempts is presumed for a retail buyer (1) if the vehicle is out of service by  
reason of repair of substantial nonconformities for a cumulative total of more than 30 calendar days or (2) the same  
substantial non-conformity has been subject to repair four or more times and you have at least once directly  
notified us in writing of the need to repair the non-conformity and have given us an opportunity to perform the  
repair ourselves. Notifications should be sent to the nearest Mercedes-Benz Regional Office listed in the  
Service and Warranty Information Booklet.  
Maintenance  
The Service Booklet describes all the necessary maintenance work which should be performed at regular intervals.  
Always have the Service Booklet with you when you take the vehicle to your authorized Mercedes-Benz Center for  
service. The service advisor will record each service in the booklet for you.  
Introduction  
9
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Introduction  
10  
Roadside assistance  
The Mercedes-Benz Roadside Assistance Program provides factory trained technical help in the event of a breakdown.  
Calls to the toll-free Roadside Assistance number:  
1-800-FOR-MERCedes (in the USA)  
1-800-387-0100 (in Canada)  
will be answered by Mercedes-Benz Client Assistance Representatives 24 hours a day, 365 days a year.  
For additional information refer to the Mercedes-Benz Roadside Assistance Program brochure in your glove box.  
Change of address or ownership  
If you change your address, be sure to send in the “Change of Address Notice” found in the Service and Warranty  
Information Booklet, or simply call the Mercedes-Benz Client Assistance Center (in the USA) at  
1-800-FOR-MERCedes, or Customer Service (in Canada) at 1-800-387-0100. It is in your own interest that we can  
contact you should the need arise.  
If you sell your Mercedes, please leave all literature with the vehicle to make it available to the next operator.  
If you bought this vehicle used, be sure to send in the “Notice of Purchase of Used Car” found in the Service and  
Warranty Information Booklet, or call the Mercedes-Benz Client Assistance Center (in the USA) at  
1-800-FOR-MERCedes, or Customer Service (in Canada) at 1-800-387-0100.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Operating your vehicle outside the USA or Canada  
If you plan to operate your vehicle in foreign countries, please be aware that:  
Service facilities or replacement parts may not be readily available,  
unleaded gasoline for vehicles with catalytic converters may not be available; the use of leaded fuels will damage  
the catalysts,  
gasoline may have a considerably lower octane rating, and improper fuel can cause engine damage.  
Certain Mercedes-Benz models are available for delivery in Europe under our European Delivery Program. For details,  
consult your authorized Mercedes-Benz Center or write to:  
In the USA:  
In Canada:  
Mercedes-Benz USA, LLC  
European Delivery Department  
One Mercedes Drive  
Mercedes-Benz Canada, Inc.  
European Delivery Department  
849 Eglinton Avenue East  
Toronto, Ontario M4G 2L5  
Montvale, NJ 07645-0350  
Introduction  
11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Introduction  
12  
We continuously strive to improve our product, and ask for your understanding that we reserve the right to make  
changes in design and equipment. Therefore, information, illustrations and descriptions in this Operator’s Manual  
might differ from your vehicle.  
Optional equipment is also described in this manual, including operating instructions wherever necessary. Since they  
are special-order items, the descriptions and illustrations herein may vary slightly from the actual equipment of your  
vehicle.  
If there are any equipment details that are not shown or described in this Operator’s Manual, your authorized  
Mercedes-Benz Center will be glad to inform you of correct care and operating procedures.  
The Operator’s Manual and Service Booklet are important documents and should be kept with the vehicle.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Where to find it  
The Operator’s Manual is divided into eight sections:  
• Instruments and controls: An overview of all the controls that can be operated from the driver’s seat.  
• Operation: Information on the vehicle’s equipment and its operation.  
• Driving: Important information on driving.  
• Instrument cluster display: Displays and indicator lamps on the instrument cluster with brief instructions.  
• Practical hints: Assistance and instructions in the event of an emergency.  
• Car care: Instructions on caring for your vehicle.  
• Technical data: All the important technical data for your vehicle as well as consumer information such as fuels,  
coolants, lubricants etc. is contained here.  
• Index: Key terms to help you find a topic quickly.  
Other documents may also be supplied, depending on your vehicle’s equipment.  
Explanation of color used:  
Warning notices for the protection of yourself and  
others appear on red background.  
Introduction  
13  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Introduction  
14  
Problems with your vehicle  
If you should experience a problem with your vehicle, particularly one that you believe may affect  
its safe operation, we urge you to immediately contact your authorized Mercedes-Benz Center to  
have the problem diagnosed and corrected if required. If the matter is not handled to your  
satisfaction, please discuss the problem with the Mercedes-Benz Center management, or if  
necessary contact us at the following addresses:  
In the USA: Client Assistance Center  
Mercedes-Benz USA, LLC  
One Mercedes Drive  
Montvale, NJ 07645-0350  
In Canada:  
Customer Relations Department  
Mercedes-Benz Canada, Inc.  
849 Eglinton Avenue East  
Toronto, Ontario, M4G 2L5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
For the USA only:  
The following text is published as required of manufacturers under Title 49, Code of U.S. Federal Regulations,  
Part 575 pursuant to the “National Traffic and Motor Vehicle Safety Act of 1966”.  
Reporting Safety Defects  
If you believe that your vehicle has a defect which could cause a crash or could cause injury or  
death, you should immediately inform the National Highway Traffic Safety Administration  
(NHTSA) in addition to notifying Mercedes-Benz USA, LLC.  
If NHTSA receives similar complaints, it may open an investigation, and if it finds that a safety  
defect exists in a group of vehicles, it may order a recall and remedy campaign. However, NHTSA  
cannot become involved in individual problems between you, your retailer, or Mercedes-Benz USA,  
LLC.  
To contact NHTSA, you may either call the Auto Safety Hotline toll-free at 1-800-424-9393  
(or 366-0123 in Washington, D.C. area) or write to: NHTSA, U.S. Department of Transportation,  
Washington, D.C. 20590. You can also obtain other information about motor vehicle safety from  
the Hotline.  
Introduction  
15  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Instruments and controls  
Instruments and controls ............... 18  
Door control panel .......................20  
Overhead control panel ...............21  
Dashboard .....................................22  
Center console ..............................24  
Contents - Instruments and control  
17  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Instruments and controls  
Instruments and controls  
18  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
1 Door control panel, see page 20  
3 Dashboard, see page 22  
2 Overhead control panel, see page 21  
4 Center console, see page 24  
Instruments and controls  
19  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Instruments and controls  
Door control panel  
20  
1 Door handle, pull to open, see page 48  
2 Memory function (for storing seat, steering wheel,  
rear view mirror and exterior mirror settings),  
see page 111  
5
3 Seat heater, see page 76  
Seat ventilation, see page 79  
4
2
4 Front seat adjustment, see page 67  
3
5 Exterior mirror adjustment, see page 107  
1
Exterior mirrors, electrically folding, see page 109  
6 Power windows, see page 178  
7 Switch for rear door window override, see pages 178  
and 180  
6
7
6
8 Trunk lid release switch, see page 57  
Trunk lid opening/closing system switch, see  
page 58  
8
P72.10-2072-27  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Overhead control panel  
1 Interior lighting, see page 184  
2 Sliding/pop-up roof, see page 181  
3 Tele Aid (emergency call system), see page 210  
4 Hands-free microphone for Tele Aid, telephone and  
voice recognition system  
1
5 Rear view mirror, see page 106  
6 Garage door opener, see page 202  
2
3
4
5
6
P82.00-2030-27  
Instruments and controls  
21  
Instruments  
Operation  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Index  
and controls  
data  
   
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Instruments and controls  
Dashboard  
22  
16  
1
17  
17  
18  
13  
14  
2
18  
11  
5
19 20 21  
22  
23  
3
12  
10  
15  
4
6
9
7
8
P68.10-2434-29  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
1 Left front parktronic warning indicator,  
13 Instrument cluster, see page 114  
see page 281  
14 Voice recognition system switch, see separate  
2 Side air outlet, adjustable  
operating instructions  
3 Air volume control for side air outlet  
4 Exterior lamp switch, see page 156  
5 Headlamp washer button, see page 159  
6 Parking brake release, see page 238  
7 Hood lock release, see page 328  
8 Parking brake pedal, see page 238  
15 Starter switch, see page 222  
16 Right front parktronic warning indicator,  
see page 281  
17 Fixed air outlets  
18 Center air outlets, adjustable  
19 Air volume control for left center air outlet  
20 Air temperature control for center air outlets  
21 Air volume control for right center air outlet  
22 Glove box lock, see page 189  
9 Easy-entry/exit feature, see page 66  
Steering wheel adjustment, see page 105  
10 Combination switch, see page 160  
11 Cruise control switch, see page 250, or  
23 Glove box lid release, see page 189  
Distronic (DTR) switch, see page 253  
12 Multifunction steering wheel, see page 120  
Driver airbag, see page 92,  
Horn (with electronic key in starter switch  
position 1 or 2)  
Instruments and controls  
23  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Instruments and controls  
Center console  
24  
1 ESP (electronic stability program) control switch,  
see page 273  
2 Level control, see page 276  
3 ABC (active body control), see page 275  
4 Rear seat head restraints, automatic, see page 81  
5 Hazard warning flasher switch, see page 163  
6 Central locking switch, see page 50  
7 Antitheft alarm system, see page 62  
Switch for tow-away alarm, see page 64  
8 Parking assist (parktronic system) deactivation,  
see page 279  
9 Rear window sunshade, see page 186  
10 COMAND system, see separate operating  
instructions  
11 Automatic climate control, see page 164  
Rear window defroster, see page 176  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
12 Ashtray, see page 196  
15 AIRBAG OFF indicator lamp, see page 296  
Lighter, see page 198  
16 Distronic (DTR) – switch for distance notification  
13 Start-/Stop button  
function, see page 265  
Starter switch for KEYLESS-GO only, see page 224  
17 Distronic (DTR) – thumbwheel for setting distance,  
14 Automatic transmission, see page 229  
see page 265  
Instruments and controls  
25  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Contents - Operation  
26  
Trunk lid release/close switch ...... 58 Supplemental restraint  
Operation  
system (SRS) ................................90  
Emergency tensioning  
retractor (ETR) ............................. 91  
Airbags ..............................................92  
Safety guidelines for the  
Trunk lid emergency release .........61  
Antitheft alarm system ................... 62  
Tow-away alarm ............................... 64  
Easy-entry/exit feature .................. 66  
Front seat adjustment ..................... 67  
Removal and installation  
of front seat head restraints ......71  
Lumbar support ................................74  
Multicontour backrest .....................74  
Seat heater .........................................76  
Seat ventilation system .................. 79  
Power head restraints, rear ............81  
Seat belts and  
Vehicle keys ......................................28  
Start lock-out ....................................32  
General notes on the  
central locking system ...............33  
Central locking system ...................34  
Radio frequency and infrared  
remote control ..............................34  
KEYLESS-GO .................................38  
Opening and closing  
windows and  
sliding/pop-up roof  
seat belt, emergency  
tensioning retractor  
and airbag ..................................100  
Infant and child  
restraint systems .......................102  
Steering wheel adjustment ..........105  
Rear view mirrors ..........................106  
Rear view mirror,  
automatic antiglare ..................106  
Memory function ............................111  
Instrument cluster ..........................114  
Multifunction steering wheel,  
multifunction display ...............120  
Trip and main odometer,  
FSS, tire inflation pressure  
monitor and  
engine oil level indicator .........124  
Audio systems ................................125  
Radio ............................................125  
from outside ..................................45  
Panic button ..................................47  
Mechanical keys ...........................47  
Doors ..................................................48  
Power closing assist for  
doors and trunk lid .....................50  
Central locking switch ....................50  
Automatic central locking ..............52  
Emergency unlocking  
in case of accident ......................52  
Trunk .................................................53  
Trunk lid release switch .................57  
integrated restraint system ....... 82  
Seat belts .......................................... 82  
Seat belt nonusage  
warning system ............................ 83  
BabySmartTM airbag  
deactivation system ................... 88  
Self-test BabySmartTM  
without special child  
seat installed ................................ 89  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CD player .....................................126 Night security illumination ..........158 Power windows ...............................178  
Cassette player ...........................127 Headlamp cleaning system ...........159 Sliding/pop-up roof ....................... 181  
Telephone ........................................128 Combination switch .......................160 Interior lighting .............................184  
Telephone book ..........................128 Hazard warning flasher  
Rear window sunshade .................186  
switch ..........................................163  
Redialing .....................................130  
Incoming call .............................. 131  
Navigation system ..........................132  
Distronic (DTR) ...............................133  
Trip computer .................................134  
Malfunction/warning  
Sun visors .......................................187  
Vanity mirrors ................................187  
Interior ............................................188  
Storage compartments  
and armrests ..............................188  
Glove box .....................................189  
Automatic climate control .............164  
Display and controls ..................166  
Dust filter .....................................167  
Basic setting ................................168  
Special settings ...........................169  
Individual settings .........................138  
Setting the audio volume ..............146  
Flexible service system  
(FSS) ............................................147  
Tire inflation  
pressure monitor ......................150  
Engine oil level indicator ..............154  
Engine oil consumption ................155  
Exterior lamp switch .....................156  
Headlamp mode .............................157  
Air recirculation .........................171 Coat hooks ......................................192  
Activated charcoal filter ........... 172 Cup holder ......................................193  
Economy mode ........................... 173 Ashtrays ..........................................196  
Residual engine heat  
utilization .....................................174  
Switching the automatic  
climate control on and off ........ 175  
Front center console storage  
Lighter .............................................198  
Parcel net in trunk ........................199  
Cargo tie-down hooks ....................200  
Parcel net in front  
passenger footwell ....................200  
Telephone, general ........................201  
Garage door opener .......................202  
Infrared reflecting windshield ....206  
compartment ventilation .......... 175  
Rear window defroster ..................176  
Rear passenger compartment  
adjustable air outlets ............... 177  
Contents - Operation  
27  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Index  
data  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Warning!  
Car care  
Index  
Central locking system  
28  
Vehicle keys and KEYLESS-GO-cards (optional)  
Included with your vehicle are:  
When leaving the vehicle always remove the  
electronic key from the starter switch and take the  
KEYLESS-GO-card (if so equipped) with you, and  
lock your vehicle. Do not leave children unattended  
in the vehicle, or with access to an unlocked  
vehicle. Unsupervised use of vehicle equipment  
may cause serious personal injury.  
2 electronic main keys with integrated radio  
frequency and infrared remote controls plus  
removable mechanical key.  
The locking tabs for the mechanical key portion of  
the two electronic main keys are a different color to  
help distinguish each individual key.  
Vehicles with KEYLESS-GO:  
1 electronic reserve key without remote control  
See page 44 on how to use the electronic key together  
with the KEYLESS-GO-card.  
functions, plus removable mechanical key.  
Vehicles with KEYLESS-GO:  
2 KEYLESS-GO-cards without removable mechanical  
key.  
Important!  
In the case of the loss of a KEYLESS-GO-card, electronic  
keys or mechanical keys, please, contact an authorized  
Mercedes-Benz Center or call 1-800-FOR-MERCedes (in  
the USA), or 1-800-387-0100 (in Canada) as soon as  
possible to have the keys or KEYLESS-GO-card  
deactivated.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Electronic main key  
When using the mechanical key (2) for lock operations,  
it can be removed by sliding it out of the remote control.  
To do so, move locking tab (3) to the right and slide the  
mechanical key (2) in direction of arrow (4).  
The remote control transmitter is located in the  
electronic main key.  
1
The infrared receivers are located in the door handles.  
Note:  
3
Remove the mechanical key from the electronic main  
key when using valet parking service. To prevent access  
to trunk or storage compartments lock them separately  
and retain the mechanical key.  
2
4
P80.35-2031-26  
See page 53 for separate locking of trunk and page 189  
for locking of glove box.  
The electronic main key has an integrated radio  
frequency and infrared remote control, plus removable  
mechanical key.  
The remote control (1) operates all locks on the vehicle.  
The mechanical key (2) works only in the driver’s door,  
trunk, and storage compartment locks.  
Central locking system  
29  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
   
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Central locking system  
Electronic reserve key  
30  
The electronic reserve key (1) works only in the starter  
switch. There are no batteries inside the electronic  
reserve key.  
The mechanical key (2) works only in the driver’s door,  
trunk, and storage compartment locks.  
1
To use the mechanical key (2), remove it from its  
electronic reserve key (1).  
Note:  
We recommend that you carry the electronic reserve  
key plus mechanical key with you and keep it in a safe  
place (e.g. your wallet) so that it is always handy. Never  
leave the electronic reserve key in the vehicle.  
P80.35-2036-26  
The electronic reserve key is without remote control  
functions, plus removable mechanical key.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
KEYLESS-GO-card  
The validity of the KEYLESS-GO-card is checked every  
time when grasping a door handle or pushing the trunk  
lid release. Once the KEYLESS-GO-card is recognized  
outside the vehicle, the doors, trunk lid and fuel filler  
flap are unlocked, depending on the selected mode  
(global or selective unlocking mode, see page 43).  
Starter switch KEYLESS-GO, see page 224.  
1
Starting and turning off the engine with KEYLESS-GO,  
see page 227 and page 228.  
Note:  
In the case of a malfunction in the KEYLESS-GO-system,  
we recommend that you carry the electronic key plus  
mechanical key with you and keep them in a safe place  
so that they are always handy. Never leave the electronic  
key or a KEYLESS-GO-card in the vehicle.  
P80.30-2029-26  
The KEYLESS-GO-card (1) does not have a removable  
mechanical key.  
The functions of the KEYLESS-GO-card (1) are identical  
to those of the electronic main key. Carrying the card  
with you permits the use of the vehicle.  
Obtaining replacement keys  
Your vehicle is equipped with a theft deterrent locking  
system requiring a special key manufacturing process.  
For security reasons, replacement keys or the KEYLESS-  
GO-card can only be obtained from your authorized  
Mercedes-Benz Center.  
Central locking system  
31  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
   
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Central locking system  
Start lock-out  
32  
Note:  
In case the engine cannot be started (vehicle’s battery is  
in order), the system is not operational. Contact an  
authorized Mercedes-Benz Center or call 1-800-FOR-  
MERCedes (in the USA), or 1-800-387-0100 (in Canada).  
Important!  
Operating with electronic key:  
Removing the electronic key from the starter switch  
activates the start lock-out. The engine cannot be  
started.  
Inserting the electronic key in the starter switch  
deactivates the start lock-out.  
Operating with KEYLESS-GO:  
Turning off the engine with the start-/stop button on the  
gear selector lever activates the start lock-out. For  
turning off the engine with KEYLESS-GO, see page 228.  
Starting the engine with the start-/stop button  
deactivates the start lock-out, if a valid KEYLESS-GO-  
card is recognized inside the vehicle. For starting the  
engine with KEYLESS-GO, see page 227. The engine  
cannot be started with a KEYLESS-GO-card outside the  
vehicle.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
General notes on the central locking system  
Note:  
If neither the remote control nor KEYLESS-GO system  
functions, use the mechanical key to unlock or lock the  
vehicle. To start engine, insert the electronic key in the  
starter switch. There could be a slight delay until the  
electronic key can be turned in the starter switch.  
If the electronic key is inserted in the starter switch, the  
vehicle cannot be locked or unlocked with the remote  
control.  
If the vehicle cannot be locked or unlocked:  
Aim transmitter eye at a receiver on either door  
handle. Check the batteries of the electronic main  
key, see page 363, or synchronize the remote  
control, see page 365.  
Important!  
When unlocking the driver’s door with the mechanical  
key, the exterior lamps will flash and the alarm will  
sound.  
Vehicles with KEYLESS-GO only:  
A KEYLESS-GO-card must be recognized by the  
system as being outside the vehicle to enable the  
vehicle to be locked or unlocked (maximum distance  
between card and doors or trunk is approx. 3 ft. (1  
m). Check the location of the KEYLESS-GO-card, see  
page 38. Check the batteries of the KEYLESS-GO-  
card, see page 366. The trunk lid will open  
automatically if a KEYLESS-GO card is detected in  
the trunk, see page 38.  
To cancel the alarm, insert the electronic key in the  
starter switch, or press button Œ or on the  
electronic main key; or with the optional KEYLESS-GO-  
system, when carrying a KEYLESS-GO-card, by grasping  
a door handle or pressing the start-/stop button on the  
gear selector lever.  
Central locking system  
33  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
 
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Central locking system  
Central locking system  
34  
4
Radio frequency and infrared remote control  
3
The electronic main key has an integrated radio  
frequency and infrared remote control.  
2
1
Due to the extended operational range of the remote  
control, it could be possible to unintentionally lock or  
unlock the vehicle by pressing the transmit button. If  
one of the transmit buttons is pressed, the battery check  
lamp lights up briefly – indicating that the batteries are  
in order. See page 363 for checking batteries.  
5
P80.35-2032-26  
The vehicle doors, trunk and fuel filler flap can be  
centrally locked and unlocked via remote control.  
1 Transmit button  
Locking  
Opening and closing the windows and sliding/pop-up  
roof and switching on the driver’s seat ventilation can  
only be done with the infrared portion of the remote  
control. Aim transmitter eye at a receiver (6 or 7), press  
and hold transmit button Œ or , see page 45.  
Œ Unlocking  
Š Opening trunk (if not separately locked)  
2 Lamp for battery check (see page 363 for changing  
With vehicle centrally locked, the trunk can also be  
opened by using the remote control.  
batteries if it does not light up briefly)  
3 PANIC button  
If the electronic key is inserted in starter switch, the  
vehicle cannot be locked or unlocked, and the trunk lid  
cannot be opened with the remote control.  
4 Transmitter eye  
5 Locking tab for mechanical key  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
6 Infrared receiver in driver’s door handle  
7 Infrared receiver in passenger door handle  
Central locking system  
35  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Central locking system  
36  
Locking and unlocking with remote control  
If within 40 seconds of unlocking with the remote  
control, neither door nor trunk is opened, the electronic  
key is not inserted in the starter switch, or the central  
locking switch is not activated, the vehicle will  
automatically lock.  
Unlocking:  
Press transmit button Œ. All turn signal lamps blink  
once to indicate that the vehicle is unlocked.  
The remote control can be programmed for two kinds of  
unlocking modes (see below):  
Locking:  
Press transmit button once. All turn signal lamps  
blink three times to indicate that the vehicle is locked. If  
they do not blink three times, a door or trunk is not  
properly closed.  
Selective unlocking mode –  
Press transmit button Œ once to unlock driver’s door  
and fuel filler flap.  
Press transmit button Œ twice to unlock both doors,  
fuel filler flap, and trunk.  
Note:  
Global unlocking mode –  
Press transmit button Œ once to unlock both doors,  
fuel filler flap, and trunk.  
If the vehicle cannot be locked or unlocked by pressing  
the transmit button, then it may be necessary to change  
the batteries in the electronic main key (if ok, battery  
check lamp in electronic main key will light briefly  
when pressing transmit button) or to synchronize the  
remote control, see pages 363 and 365.  
Notes:  
If the trunk was previously locked separately, it will  
remain locked, see page 53.  
The presently active unlocking mode (selective or  
global) can only be determined by unlocking the vehicle  
with the remote control (see below for changing mode).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Choosing global or selective mode on remote control  
Important!  
Press and hold transmit buttons and Œ  
simultaneously for approx. 6 seconds to reprogram the  
remote control. Battery check lamp will blink two times  
indicating the completed mode change.  
Do not place remote control in trunk since trunk is  
locked when the lid is closed if the vehicle is centrally  
locked.  
Notes:  
If the trunk was previously locked separately, it will  
remain locked, see page 53.  
Opening the trunk  
The trunk lid will swing open automatically. You should  
always make sure there is sufficient clearance.  
Vehicles with optional trunk lid  
opening/closing system (see page 58):  
The switch operated opening/closing procedure can be  
immediately halted by pressing button Š on the  
electronic main key.  
A minimum height clearance of 6 ft. (1.85 m) is  
required to open the trunk lid.  
Press transmit button Š until trunk lid is open.  
Central locking system  
37  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
   
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Central locking system  
KEYLESS-GO  
38  
If the KEYLESS-GO-card is removed from the vehicle  
while the engine is running, or by placing the card  
in front of the center armrest (see page 190), the  
message “CHIP-CARD – NOT RECOGNIZED!” will  
appear repeatedly in the multifunction display,  
see page 318.  
Important!  
For the KEYLESS-GO-system to function properly, the  
operator should observe the following:  
The driver should carry the KEYLESS-GO-card with  
Find the card or change its present location (e.g.  
place it on the front passenger seat or insert it in  
shirt pocket).  
him/her.  
To avoid radio transmission interference, never store  
the KEYLESS-GO-card together with other electronic  
items (e.g. cellular telephones, other KEYLESS-GO-  
cards) or metallic objects (e.g. coins, metal foil).  
If the message “CHIP-CARD – NOT RECOGNIZED”  
is ignored for an extended period of time (approx.15  
minutes), the engine could stop by itself during a  
vehicle stop (e.g. traffic light). The vehicle can then  
no longer be centrally locked or the engine  
restarted. You must first find the card or change its  
present location (e.g. place it on the front passenger  
seat or insert it in shirt pocket). Start the engine  
again. See page 224.  
To lock or unlock the vehicle, the card must be  
recognized by the system as being located outside  
the vehicle. The card must be in close proximity to a  
door or the trunk lid (approx. 3 ft. [1 m]). To activate  
the start/stop button function, the KEYLESS-GO-  
card must be recognized by the system as being  
located inside the vehicle.  
Do not forget, the engine can be started by anyone  
with a KEYLESS-GO-card that is left inside the  
vehicle. Leaving the chip-card behind when exiting  
and locking the vehicle, the message “CHIP-CARD –  
STILL IN VEHICLE” appears in the multifunction  
display, see page 318.  
If the KEYLESS-GO-card is positioned farther away  
from the vehicle (e.g. inside clothing or a briefcase)  
and can no longer be recognized by the system, the  
vehicle cannot be locked or the engine started via  
the KEYLESS-GO-system.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Opening the driver’s door with the engine shut off  
and no electronic key in the starter switch, the  
message “CHIP-CARD – DO NOT FORGET” appears  
as a reminder, see page 318.  
Notes:  
The KEYLESS-GO-function also permits closing of  
windows and sliding/pop-up roof (convenience feature),  
see page 46.  
With the KEYLESS-GO-card in close proximity (approx.  
3 ft. [1 m]) of the vehicle, aiming a jet of water at a door  
handle (e.g. when washing the vehicle) or cleaning  
snow from a door, could lock or unlock the vehicle  
inadvertently.  
Important  
In the case of a malfunction in the KEYLESS-GO-system,  
we recommend that you carry the electronic key plus  
mechanical key with you and keep them in a safe place  
so that they are always handy. Never leave the electronic  
key in the vehicle.  
To prevent a possible inadvertent lockout, the trunk lid  
will open automatically if a KEYLESS-GO-card is  
recognized in the area of the rear shelf or inside the  
trunk.  
Central locking system  
39  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Central locking system  
40  
Locking and unlocking with KEYLESS-GO-card  
Notes:  
The door which was unlocked, can be opened  
immediately after the audible click. The other door can  
be opened after its lock button rises up.  
Unlocking:  
Grasp either door handle. All turn signal lamps blink  
once to indicate that the vehicle is unlocked.  
If the trunk was previously locked separately, it will  
remain locked, see page 53.  
The KEYLESS-GO-card can be programmed for two  
kinds of unlocking modes (see below):  
The presently active unlocking mode (selective or  
global) can be determined by pressing the button on the  
KEYLESS-GO-card (see page 43 for changing mode).  
Selective unlocking mode –  
Grasp driver’s door handle to unlock driver’s door and  
fuel filler flap.  
If within 40 seconds of unlocking with the  
KEYLESS-GO-card, neither door nor trunk is opened,  
the electronic key is not inserted in the starter switch,  
or the central locking switch is not activated, the vehicle  
will automatically lock.  
Grasping the passenger door, centrally unlocks the  
vehicle.  
Global unlocking mode –  
Grasp either door handle to unlock both doors, fuel filler  
flap, and trunk.  
For choosing global or selective mode on KEYLESS-GO-  
card, see page 43.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Note:  
Locking the vehicle with the door lock button (1) is only  
possible if a KEYLESS-GO-card is outside the vehicle.  
Locking:  
Press lock button (1) at either door. All turn signal  
lamps blink three times to indicate that the vehicle is  
locked. If they do not blink three times, a door or trunk  
is not properly closed, or the KEYLESS-GO-card is still in  
the vehicle. Check the multifunction display, see  
page 318.  
Central locking system  
41  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Central locking system  
42  
Notes:  
If the trunk was previously locked separately, it will  
remain locked, see page 53.  
The vehicle cannot be centrally unlocked via the trunk  
lid lock (2).  
To prevent a possible inadvertent lockout, the trunk lid  
will open automatically if a KEYLESS-GO-card is  
recognized in the area of the rear shelf or inside the  
trunk.  
Unlocking:  
Press trunk lid lock (2) to open trunk only.  
Locking:  
Press the trunk lid lock button (3). All turn signal lamps  
blink three times to indicate that the vehicle is locked. If  
they do not blink three times, a door or trunk is not  
properly closed or a KEYLESS-GO-card is still in the  
vehicle. Check the multifunction display, see page 318.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Choosing global or selective mode  
on KEYLESS-GO-card  
Checking last KEYLESS-GO-card locking mode  
Briefly press button (1). The indicator lamp (2) or (3)  
lights up in red (vehicle locked) or in green (vehicle  
unlocked).  
2
3
1
To choose between the selective or global opening mode  
press and hold button (1) until the indicator lamp at the  
requested symbol (2) or (3) comes on.  
Central locking system  
43  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
   
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Central locking system  
44  
Simultaneous use of electronic key and  
KEYLESS-GO-card  
If the electronic key is inserted in the starter switch  
while the gear selector lever is in position “P”, the  
electronic key takes over. The vehicle operates  
according to the electronic key position in the starter  
switch (see page 222), eventually even stopping the  
engine.  
When using the electronic key and the KEYLESS-GO-  
card at the same time, the electronic key overrules the  
KEYLESS-GO-card.  
If the engine is started with the start-/stop button on the  
gear selector lever, and afterwards the electronic key is  
inserted in the starter switch, the engine continues to  
run with the gear selector lever in positions “R”, “N”,  
“D” plus ranges “4”, “3”, “2”, “1” until it is stopped by  
using the start-/stop button on the gear selector lever.  
Warning!  
When leaving the vehicle always remove the  
electronic key from the starter switch, take the  
KEYLESS-GO-card with you, and lock your vehicle.  
Unsupervised use of vehicle equipment may cause  
serious personal injury.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Opening and closing windows and  
sliding/pop-up roof from outside  
(summer opening/convenience feature)  
Continue to press transmit button after locking  
the vehicle.  
The windows and sliding/pop-up roof begin to close  
after approx. 1 second.  
Aim transmitter eye of remote control at a door receiver.  
To interrupt closing procedure, release transmit button.  
Summer opening:  
(Operation with electronic main key)  
Ensure that all side windows and the sliding/pop-up  
roof are properly closed before leaving the vehicle.  
The sliding/pop-up roof and all side windows can be  
opened and the driver’s seat ventilation automatically  
switches on. See page 79 for seat ventilation.  
Warning!  
Never operate the windows or sliding/pop-up roof if  
there is the possibility of anyone being harmed by  
the opening or closing procedure.  
Continue to press transmit button Œ after unlocking  
the vehicle.  
The windows and sliding/pop-up roof begin to open  
after approx. 1 second. The driver’s seat ventilation  
automatically switches on. See page 79 for seat  
ventilation.  
In case the procedure causes potential danger, the  
procedure can be immediately halted by releasing  
the remote control button. To reverse direction of  
movement press Œ for opening or for  
closing.  
To interrupt opening procedure, release transmit  
button.  
Convenience feature:  
(Operation with electronic main key)  
The sliding/pop-up roof and the side windows can be  
closed.  
Central locking system  
45  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
     
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Warning!  
Car care  
Index  
Central locking system  
46  
Note:  
If the windows and sliding/pop-up roof cannot be  
operated automatically by pressing the transmit button  
of the remote control then it may be necessary to change  
the batteries in the electronic main key (if ok, battery  
check lamp in electronic main key will light briefly  
when transmitting), or to synchronize the remote  
control, see page 363 and 365.  
Never operate the windows or sliding/pop-up roof if  
there is the possibility of anyone being harmed by  
the closing procedure.  
In case the procedure causes potential danger, the  
procedure can be immediately halted by releasing  
the lock button. To reverse direction of movement  
pull and hold outside door handle.  
Convenience feature  
(Operation with KEYLESS-GO)  
Continue to press lock button on door handle after  
locking the vehicle.  
The windows and sliding/pop-up roof begin to close  
after approx. 1 second.  
To interrupt closing procedure, release lock button. To  
reverse direction (within 2 seconds after closing), pull  
and hold door handle. Opening of windows starts and  
continues for as long as the door handle is held but the  
door not opened.  
Ensure that all side windows and the sliding/pop-up  
roof are properly closed before leaving the vehicle.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Panic button  
Note:  
For operation in the USA only: This device complies  
with Part 15, Subpart C, Section 209 of the FCC Rules.  
Operation is subject to the following two conditions:  
(1) This device may not cause harmful interference, and  
1
(2) this device must accept any interference received,  
including interference that may cause undesired  
operation.  
WARNING: Changes or modification not expressly  
approved by party responsible for compliance could void  
the user’s authority to operate the equipment.  
P80.35-2035-26  
Mechanical keys  
To activate press and hold button (1) for at least one  
second. An audible alarm and blinking exterior lamps  
will operate for approximately 21/2 minutes.  
The mechanical keys work only in driver’s door, trunk,  
and storage compartment locks.  
Notes:  
To deactivate press button (1) again, or insert electronic  
key in starter switch.  
The mechanical key does not operate the central locking  
system or antitheft alarm system.  
The fuel filler flap cannot be locked or unlocked with  
the mechanical key.  
If the fuel filler flap cannot be opened, see page 368.  
Central locking system  
47  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
   
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Central locking system  
Doors  
48  
2
3
1
P80.30-2131-26  
1 Opening – pull handle  
4 Individual door from inside:  
Push lock button down to lock.  
2 Unlocking driver’s door  
5 Individual door from inside:  
3 Locking driver’s door  
Pull handle to unlock.  
Important!  
When you lock the driver’s door with the mechanical  
key, the door lock button should move down.  
The mechanical key does not operate the central locking  
system or antitheft alarm system.  
The passenger door must be locked with the door lock  
button – the driver’s door can only be locked when it is  
closed.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
If the vehicle has previously been locked from the  
outside, opening a door from the inside will trigger the  
alarm. When opening a door while the central locking  
system is in the:  
To unlock, pull inside door handles or turn mechanical  
key in driver’s door lock to position 2.  
When unlocking the driver’s door with the mechanical  
key, the exterior lamps will flash and the alarm will  
sound.  
selective unlocking mode, only that individual door  
is unlocked. The remaining door, the trunk and fuel  
filler flap remain locked.  
To cancel the alarm, insert the electronic key in the  
starter switch or press button Œ or on the  
electronic main key.  
global unlocking mode, both doors, the trunk and  
fuel filler flap are unlocked.  
Notes:  
When opening a door, the door window and rear side  
window lower slightly. After closing the door, the  
windows close again.  
In case of a malfunction in the central locking system  
the doors can be locked and unlocked individually.  
To lock, push down lock button or turn mechanical key  
in driver’s door lock to position 3. In addition lock the  
trunk.  
Central locking system  
49  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Central locking system  
50  
Power closing assist for doors and trunk lid  
The doors and the trunk lid close automatically if:  
the doors are positioned against the lock,  
the trunk lid is lowered against the lock.  
Central locking switch  
It is not necessary to slam the door or trunk lid closed, a  
pneumatic power-assisted mechanism draws doors and  
trunk lid closed quietly and automatically once the lid  
or door has been latched. When the pneumatic power-  
assisted mechanism has stopped, doors and/or trunk  
can be reopened.  
Warning!  
To prevent possible personal injury, always keep  
hands and fingers away from the door or trunk  
opening when closing a door or the trunk lid. Be  
especially careful when small children are around.  
1 Locking  
2 Unlocking  
The central locking switch is located in the center  
console.  
The pneumatic power closing assist mechanism  
cannot be interrupted once it has been engaged.  
The doors and trunk can only be locked with the central  
locking switch, if both doors are closed.  
To prevent personal injury, never actuate the  
closing assist mechanism by tampering with the  
door or trunk lid latch.  
If the vehicle was previously locked with the central  
locking switch, while in the selective remote control  
mode, only the door opened from the inside is unlocked.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
If the vehicle was previously locked with the central  
locking switch, while in the global remote control mode,  
the complete vehicle is unlocked when a door is opened  
from the inside.  
Warning!  
When leaving the vehicle always remove the  
electronic key from the starter switch, take the  
KEYLESS-GO-card (if so equipped) with you, and  
lock your vehicle. Do not leave children unattended  
in the vehicle, or with access to an unlocked  
vehicle. Unsupervised use of vehicle equipment  
may cause serious personal injury.  
Notes:  
If the vehicle was previously locked with the remote  
control or the lock button at any door handle (vehicles  
with KEYLESS-GO) the doors and trunk cannot be  
unlocked with the central locking switch.  
The fuel filler flap cannot be locked or unlocked with  
the central locking switch.  
If the vehicle has previously been locked from the  
outside, opening a door from the inside will trigger the  
alarm. To cancel the alarm, insert the electronic key in  
the starter switch or press button Œ or on the  
electronic main key; or (vehicles with KEYLESS-GO)  
when carrying the KEYLESS-GO-card, grasp the door  
handle or press the start-/stop button on the gear  
selector lever.  
Central locking system  
51  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Central locking system  
Automatic central locking  
52  
With the automatic central locking activated and the  
electronic key in starter switch position 2 (vehicles with  
KEYLESS-GO: operation position, see page 224), the  
vehicle doors will lock if the left front wheel as well as  
the right rear wheel spin at vehicle speeds of approx.  
9 mph (15 km/h) or more.  
With the automatic central locking system activated, the  
doors and trunk are locked at vehicle speeds of approx.  
9 mph (15 km/h) or more. The fuel filler flap remains  
unlocked.  
The automatic central locking function can be switched  
on or off. See page 138 for “Individual settings”.  
To prevent the vehicle door locks from locking,  
deactivate the automatic central locking. See page 138  
for “Individual settings”.  
Notes:  
If doors are unlocked with the central locking switch  
after activating the automatic central locking, and  
neither door is opened, then the doors remain unlocked  
even at vehicle speeds of approx. 9 mph (15 km/h) or  
more.  
Emergency unlocking in case of accident  
The doors unlock automatically a short time after an  
accident in which an airbag or emergency tensioning  
retractor deploys (this is intended to aid rescue and  
exit).  
If a door is opened from the inside at speeds of approx.  
9 mph (15 km/h) or less with the automatic central  
locking activated, the door will again be automatically  
locked at speeds of approx. 9 mph (15 km/h) or more.  
Important!  
When towing the vehicle, or with the vehicle on a  
dynamometer test stand, please, note the following:  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Trunk  
The lock is located in the license plate recess.  
When the trunk is separately locked, it remains locked  
when centrally unlocking the vehicle.  
To deny any unauthorized person access to the trunk,  
lock it separately with the mechanical key. Leave only  
the electronic key less its mechanical key with the  
vehicle.  
Notes:  
In case of a malfunction in the central locking system  
the trunk can be unlocked individually.  
To unlock and open the trunk lid, turn mechanical key  
to position 1 (see next page), hold and push to open.  
The mechanical key does not operate the central locking  
system or antitheft alarm system.  
0 Neutral position – push to open (arrow)  
1 Unlocking  
When unlocking the trunk with the mechanical key, the  
exterior lamps will flash and the alarm will sound.  
2 Separate locking of trunk – remove mechanical key  
in this position.  
Central locking system  
53  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
   
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Important!  
Car care  
Index  
Central locking system  
54  
To cancel the alarm, insert the electronic key in the  
starter switch or press button Œ or on the  
electronic main key; or (vehicles with KEYLESS-GO)  
when carrying the KEYLESS-GO-card, grasp the door  
handle or press the start-/stop button on the gear  
selector lever.  
Do not place mechanical key inside trunk, since trunk is  
locked again when closing the lid if the vehicle has been  
previously centrally locked.  
If the fuel filler flap cannot be opened, see page 368.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2
P88.50-2127-26  
P54.25-2392-26  
Vehicles without trunk lid opening/closing system:  
Vehicles with trunk lid opening/closing system:  
Lower trunk lid using handle (1) and close it with hands  
placed flat on trunk lid. Please remember to keep your  
fingers out of the space between the lid and the vehicle.  
Press trunk lid button (2) briefly. The trunk lid closes  
automatically.  
The trunk lid can also be closed with the trunk lid  
opening/closing switch located on the driver’s door, see  
page 58.  
Central locking system  
55  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
 
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Central locking system  
Warning!  
56  
In case of a malfunction the trunk lid can be opened and  
closed manually.  
To prevent possible personal injury, always keep  
hands and fingers away from the trunk opening  
when closing the trunk lid. Be especially careful  
when small children are around.  
To open, unlock trunk lid with the mechanical key and  
open lid by hand, see page 53.  
To close, lower trunk lid with hands placed flat on trunk  
lid. Please remember to keep your fingers out of the  
space between the lid and the vehicle.  
Always be sure persons who might get injured are  
away from the trunk area when you operate the  
trunk lid closing button located on the vehicle door.  
Vehicles with KEYLESS-GO:  
To interrupt the hydraulic power closing assist  
mechanism press trunk lid close button (2) inside  
the trunk lid, push in trunk lid lock, or press  
button Š on the electronic main key.  
To prevent a possible inadvertent lockout, the trunk lid  
will open automatically if a KEYLESS-GO-card is  
recognized in the area of the rear shelf or inside the  
trunk.  
Notes:  
The automatic closing process is interrupted if the  
trunk lid is pushed against an object. The trunk lid will  
reverse slightly and stop. In its final closing stage the  
hydraulic power closing assist mechanism releases the  
trunk lid which then drops into the lock by its own  
weight. Now the trunk lid will stop but not reverse  
slightly.  
Investigate and correct the cause of interruption.  
Now press trunk lid close button (2) again to close the  
trunk lid.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Trunk lid release switch  
(Vehicles without trunk lid opening/closing system)  
The trunk lid will swing open automatically. You should  
always make sure there is sufficient clearance.  
A minimum height clearance of 6 ft. (1.85 m) is  
required to open the trunk lid.  
To open the trunk, the vehicle must be at standstill. Pull  
up on switch until trunk lid is open.  
The indicator lamp in the switch remains on with trunk  
lid open.  
Notes:  
The trunk can also be opened by using the remote  
control. Press Š button.  
The trunk lid cannot be opened by the switch or the  
remote control when previously locked separately with  
the mechanical key. To open, see page 53.  
The switch is located on the driver’s door.  
The trunk lid cannot be opened with the trunk lid  
release switch when the vehicle was previously locked  
with the remote control. To unlock vehicle with the  
remote control, see page 34.  
Central locking system  
57  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
 
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Central locking system  
58  
Trunk lid opening/closing system (optional)  
To open trunk lid:  
Pull up on switch until trunk lid begins to open. The  
switch can now be released, the trunk lid opens  
automatically.  
To interrupt the opening process, either pull up on  
switch, or push in trunk lid lock, or press button Š  
on the remote control.  
The indicator lamp in the switch remains on with trunk  
lid open.  
To close trunk lid:  
Press upper half of switch until trunk lid is closed and  
the indicator lamp in the switch goes out.  
The switch is located on the driver’s door.  
Warning!  
When closing the trunk lid, be sure that there is no  
danger of anyone being harmed by the closing  
procedure. Be especially careful when small  
children are around. Maintain sight of trunk area  
while operating the door mounted switch.  
The trunk lid will open and close automatically. You  
should always make sure that there is sufficient  
clearance.  
A minimum height clearance of 6 ft. (1.85 m) is  
required to open the trunk lid.  
To interrupt the hydraulic power closing assist  
mechanism release trunk lid release/close switch  
and pull up to open.  
To open and close the trunk, the vehicle must be parked  
and unlocked.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Notes:  
The trunk can also be opened by using the remote  
control. Press Š button.  
The automatic closing process is interrupted, if the  
trunk lid is pushed against an object. The trunk lid will  
reverse slightly and stop. In its final closing stage the  
hydraulic power closing assist mechanism releases the  
trunk lid which then drops into the lock by its own  
weight. Now the trunk lid will stop but not reverse  
slightly.  
The trunk lid cannot be opened by the switch or the  
remote control when previously locked separately with  
the mechanical key. To open, see page 53.  
The trunk lid cannot be opened with the trunk lid  
opening/closing switch when the vehicle was  
previously locked with the central locking switch. To  
unlock vehicle with the central locking switch, see  
page 50.  
Investigate and correct the cause of interruption.  
Now press trunk lid opening/closing switch again to  
close the trunk lid.  
Vehicles with KEYLESS-GO:  
To prevent a possible inadvertent lockout, the trunk lid  
will open automatically if a KEYLESS-GO-card is  
recognized in the area of rear shelf or inside the trunk.  
In case of a malfunction the trunk lid can be opened and  
closed manually.  
To open, unlock trunk lid with the mechanical key and  
open lid by hand, see page 53.  
To close, lower trunk lid with hands placed flat on trunk  
lid. Please remember to keep your fingers out of the  
space between the lid and the vehicle.  
Central locking system  
59  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Central locking system  
Opening height restriction of trunk lid  
60  
Note:  
To fully open the trunk lid while opening height  
restriction activated, deactivate it.  
The trunk lid opening height can be restricted when  
transporting goods on a roof rack (e.g. presence of an  
MB sport luggage container). When activated, the trunk  
lid opens to below the roof line of the vehicle.  
To activate:  
Press upper half of trunk lid opening/closing switch for  
a minimum of 5 seconds.  
To deactivate:  
Press upper half of trunk lid opening/closing switch for  
a minimum of 5 seconds.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Trunk lid emergency release  
Note:  
The emergency release button (1) only unlocks and  
opens the trunk while the vehicle is standing.  
Important!  
The emergency trunk lid release button (1) does not  
open the trunk lid, if:  
the vehicle battery is discharged or disconnected,  
the trunk lid was previously locked separately with  
the mechanical key, see page 53.  
Illumination of the emergency release button (1):  
The button will blink for 30 minutes after opening the  
trunk.  
The emergency release button (1) is located in the trunk  
lid.  
The button will blink for 60 minutes after closing the  
trunk.  
Briefly press emergency release button (1).  
All doors, the fuel filler flap, and the trunk unlock; and  
the trunk lid opens.  
Central locking system  
61  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
 
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Antitheft alarm system  
Antitheft alarm system  
62  
The antitheft alarm is armed within approx. 10 seconds  
after locking the vehicle with the remote control or the  
lock button at each door handle (vehicles with  
KEYLESS-GO).  
A blinking lamp (1) indicates that the alarm is armed.  
Operation:  
Once the alarm system has been armed, the exterior  
vehicle lamps will flash and an alarm will sound when  
someone:  
opens a door,  
opens the trunk,  
opens the hood,  
1 Indicator lamp in switch located in center console  
attempts to raise the vehicle.  
The alarm will last approximately 21/2 minutes in form  
of flashing exterior lamps. At the same time an alarm  
will sound for 30 seconds. The alarm will stay on even if  
the activating element (a door for example) is  
immediately closed. If the alarm stays on for more than  
20 seconds, an emergency call is initiated automatically.  
See Tele Aid on page 210.  
The antitheft alarm is automatically armed or disarmed  
with the remote control or the KEYLESS-GO-function, by  
locking or unlocking the vehicle.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Notes:  
To cancel the alarm, insert the electronic key in the  
starter switch or press button Œ or on the  
electronic main key; or (vehicles with KEYLESS-GO)  
when carrying the KEYLESS-GO-card, grasp the door  
handle or press the start-/stop button on the gear  
selector lever.  
We recommend that you carry the electronic reserve  
key plus mechanical key with you and keep it in a safe  
place (e.g. your wallet) so that it is always handy. Never  
leave the electronic reserve key in the vehicle.  
When you unlock the driver’s door with the mechanical  
key, the exterior lamps will flash and the alarm will  
sound.  
Antitheft alarm system  
63  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Tow-away alarm  
64  
Tow-away alarm  
Once the alarm system has been armed, the exterior  
vehicle lamps will flash and an alarm will sound when  
someone attempts to raise the vehicle.  
The alarm will last approximately 21/2 minutes in form  
of flashing exterior lamps. At the same time an alarm  
will sound for 30 seconds. The alarm will stay on even if  
the vehicle is immediately lowered. To cancel the alarm,  
insert the electronic key in the starter switch or press  
button Œ or on the electronic main key; or  
(vehicles with KEYLESS-GO) when carrying the  
KEYLESS-GO-card, grasp the door handle or press the  
start-/stop button on the gear selector lever.  
If the alarm stays on for more than 20 seconds, an  
emergency call is initiated automatically. See Tele Aid  
on page 210.  
The switch is located in the center console.  
1 Press to switch off  
2 Indicator lamp  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
To prevent triggering the tow-away alarm feature, switch  
off the tow-away alarm before towing the vehicle, or  
when parking on a surface subject to movement, such  
as a ferry or auto train.  
Exit vehicle, and lock vehicle with the electronic main  
key or (vehicles with KEYLESS-GO) the lock button at  
each door handle.  
The tow-away alarm remains switched off until the  
vehicle is locked again with the electronic main key or  
the lock button at each door handle (vehicles with  
KEYLESS-GO) at which time it is automatically  
reactivated.  
To do so, turn electronic key in starter switch to  
position 1 or 0, or remove electronic key from starter  
switch. Press tow-away alarm switch (1). The indicator  
lamp (2) illuminates briefly.  
Tow-away alarm  
65  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Easy-entry/exit feature  
Easy-entry/exit feature  
66  
With the easy-entry/exit feature activated, the steering  
wheel tilts upwards to allow easier entry into and exit  
from the vehicle when the driver’s door is opened.  
However, the engine must be turned off.  
When the electronic key is inserted in the starter switch  
or, with a valid KEYLESS-GO-card, when pressing the  
start-/stop button on the gear selector lever, and if the  
driver’s door is closed, the steering wheel returns to the  
last position set for it.  
Warning!  
You must ensure that no one can become trapped  
or injured by the moving steering wheel with the  
easy-entry/exit feature activated and you open the  
driver’s door or remove the electronic key from the  
starter switch. Do not leave children unattended in  
the vehicle, or with access to an unlocked vehicle.  
Unsupervised use of vehicle equipment may cause  
serious personal injury.  
The switch is located on the steering column adjustment  
lever.  
Turn the switch in direction:  
1 to switch on  
2 to switch off  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Front seat adjustment  
Warning!  
When leaving the vehicle always remove the  
electronic key from the starter switch, take the  
KEYLESS-GO-card (if so equipped) with you, and  
lock your vehicle.  
Do not adjust the driver’s seat while driving.  
Adjusting the seat while driving could cause the  
driver to lose control of the vehicle.  
The power seats can also be operated with the  
driver’s or front passenger door open. Do not leave  
children unattended in the vehicle, or with access  
to an unlocked vehicle. Unsupervised use of vehicle  
equipment may cause serious personal injury.  
Never ride in a moving vehicle with the seat back  
reclined. Sitting in an excessively reclined position  
can be dangerous. You could slide under the seat  
belt in a collision. If you slide under it, the belt  
would apply force at the abdomen or neck. That  
could cause serious or fatal injuries. The seat back  
and seat belts provide the best restraint when the  
wearer is in an upright position and belts are  
properly positioned on the body.  
To operate the front power seat adjustment switches,  
turn the electronic key in starter switch to position 1  
or 2 (with a front door open, the power seats can also be  
operated with the electronic key removed or in starter  
switch position 0).  
Never place hands under seat or near any moving  
parts while a seat is being adjusted.  
Seats  
67  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Index  
data  
   
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Seats  
68  
Note:  
Do not move the front passenger seat completely  
forward if objects are stored in the parcel net in the  
front passenger side footwell. Items in the net may be  
damaged.  
4
3
2
4
5
2 Seat, up/down  
1
1
Press the switch (up/down direction) until  
comfortable seating position with still sufficient  
headroom is reached.  
3
2
3 Seat cushion tilt  
Press the switch in the direction of the arrow until  
your legs are slightly supported.  
The switches are located in both doors.  
4 Backrest tilt  
Press the switch in the direction of the arrow until  
your arms are slightly angled when holding the  
steering wheel.  
We recommend to adjust the power seat in the following  
order:  
1 Seat adjustment, fore/aft  
5 Seat cushion depth  
Press the switch (fore/aft direction) until a  
comfortable seating position is reached that still  
allows you to reach the accelerator/brake pedal  
safely. The position should be as far rearward as  
possible, consistent with ability to properly operate  
controls.  
Press the switch fore or aft until your legs are  
supported comfortably.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
6
7
6 Head restraint  
Adjust the head restraint angle (7) by hand. Push or pull  
the head restraint in direction of arrow.  
The height of the head restraint is adjusted  
automatically with the seat so that the back of the  
head is supported approximately at ear level. Adjust  
the head restraint using the switch if the preset  
position does not support the back of your head  
approximately at ear level.  
Storing seat positions  
The head restraint, steering wheel and rear view mirror  
positions are stored together with the seat position.  
See page 111 for notes on the memory function. For  
recalling a stored seat/head restraint/steering wheel/  
and rear view mirror position see page 112.  
Only minor personal adjustments, as described  
below, should then be required.  
For steering wheel adjustment, see page 105;  
inside rear view mirror, see page 106;  
exterior rear view mirrors, see page 107.  
Seats  
69  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Index  
data  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Warning!  
Car care  
Index  
Seats  
70  
Important!  
Prior to operating the vehicle, the driver should adjust  
the seat height for proper vision as well as fore/aft  
placement and backrest angle to insure adequate  
control, reach, operation, and comfort. The head  
restraint should also be adjusted for proper height. See  
also airbag section on page 92 for proper seat  
positioning.  
Children 12 years old and under must never ride in  
the front seat, except in a Mercedes-Benz  
authorized BabySmartTM compatible child seat,  
which operates with the BabySmartTM system  
installed in the vehicle to deactivate the passenger  
side front airbag when it is properly installed.  
Otherwise they will be struck by the airbag when it  
inflates in a crash. If this happens, serious or fatal  
injury will result.  
In addition, also adjust the steering wheel to ensure  
adequate control, reach, operation, and comfort.  
According to accident statistics, children are safer  
when properly restrained in the rear seating  
positions than in the front seating positions.  
Infants and small children must ride in back seats  
and be seated in an appropriate infant or child  
restraint system, which is properly secured with  
the vehicle’s seat belt, fully in accordance with the  
child seat manufacturer’s instructions.  
Both the inside and outside rear view mirrors should be  
adjusted for adequate rearward vision.  
Fasten seat belts. Infants and small children should be  
seated in a properly secured restraint system that  
complies with U.S. Federal Motor Vehicle Safety  
Standard 213 and Canadian Motor Vehicle Safety  
Standard 213.  
A child’s risk of serious or fatal injuries is  
significantly increased if the child restraints are  
not properly secured in the vehicle and the child is  
not properly secured in the child restraint.  
All seat, head restraint, steering wheel, and rear view  
mirror adjustments as well as fastening of seat belts  
should be done before the vehicle is put into motion.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Removal and installation of front seat head  
restraints  
Note:  
Tilt the backrest rearward for easier removal and  
installation of the head restraints.  
1
To remove:  
Press switch (1) downwards and hold until the head  
restraint is fully retracted. Pull head restraint out with  
one strong jerking movement.  
To install:  
Press switch (1) downwards and hold for about  
5 seconds.  
Press the head restraint down until it engages.  
Adjust head restraint to the desired position.  
P91.16-2030-26  
Warning!  
Caution!  
For your protection, drive only with properly  
positioned head restraints.  
Do not remove head restraints except when mounting  
seat covers. Whenever restraints have been removed be  
sure to reinstall them before driving.  
Adjust head restraint to support the back of the  
head approximately at ear level.  
Do not drive the vehicle without the seat head  
restraints. Head restraints are intended to help  
reduce injuries during an accident.  
Seats  
71  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Index  
data  
 
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Warning!  
Car care  
Index  
Seats  
72  
Backrest  
The seat belts provide protection only with the  
backrest locked in place and, therefore, must be  
locked in place with the vehicle in motion. Do not  
drive the vehicle when the backrest is not locked in  
place. If the warning message “SEAT BACKREST  
LEFT – LOCK!” or “SEAT BACKREST RIGHT –  
LOCK!” is displayed in the multifunction display,  
then the respective backrest is not engaged in its  
lock. Carefully slow down, and drive with caution  
to an area which is in a safe distance from the  
roadway. Always provide sufficient room behind  
the backrest and fold the backrest all the way back  
until it locks in place.  
The warning message is no longer displayed as  
soon as the backrest is locked in place. If both  
backrests are locked in place and the warning  
message is still displayed, have the system checked  
at your authorized Mercedes-Benz Center  
immediately.  
Folding forward:  
Lift release lever and fold backrest forward. The seat  
will automatically slide forward and the head restraint  
will move down.  
Folding back:  
Lift release lever and fold backrest back. The seat and  
head restraint return to their previous positions.  
To interrupt the procedure, activate the power seat  
switch located in the front door.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Notes:  
When leaving the vehicle always remove the  
electronic key from the starter switch, take the  
KEYLESS-GO-card (if so equipped) with you, and  
lock your vehicle.  
The automatic seat slide is provided with a safety  
feature.  
The automatic process is interrupted, if the backrest of  
the sliding seat is pushed against an occupant or object.  
The seat will slide forward and stop.  
The power seats can also be operated with the  
driver’s or passenger door open. Do not leave  
children unattended in the vehicle or with access  
to an unlocked vehicle. Unsupervised use of vehicle  
equipment may cause serious personal injury.  
Investigate and correct the cause of interruption.  
Now use memory button (page 112) or power seat switch  
(page 68) to bring seat into desired position.  
Never place hands under seat or near any moving  
parts during a seat adjustment procedure.  
When folding the backrest forward from a reclined  
position, and then folding it back, the backrest stops in a  
more upright position for the safety of any rear-seat  
passenger. Adjust the backrest until your arms are  
slightly angled when holding the steering wheel, see  
page 68.  
Seats  
73  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Index  
data  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Seats  
74  
Lumbar support (optional)  
Multicontour backrest (optional)  
2
1
3
4
1
P91.10-2089-26  
The thumbwheels are located on the sides of the front  
seats.  
The switch clusters are located on the sides of the front  
seats.  
The seats have an inflatable air cushion built into the  
backrest to provide additional lumbar support.  
1 Lumbar region  
2 Center section  
Turn the electronic key in starter switch to position 2.  
The inflation pressure of the air cushion can be  
continuously varied between position “0” (no pressure)  
and position “5” (maximum pressure) by changing the  
pressure regulator (1) setting.  
3 Backrest side cushions  
4 Massage function (PULSE)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Some models may be equipped with multicontour seats.  
These seats have inflatable air cushions built into the  
backrests to provide additional lumbar and side support.  
3 Backrest side cushions  
The lateral support increases or decreases as you  
press the button to the right or left. Adjust the side  
cushions to provide good lateral support.  
Turn the electronic key in starter switch to position 2 to  
operate.  
4 Massage function (PULSE)  
We recommend that you make the basic settings in the  
following order:  
The multicontour backrest is equipped with a  
massage function to help prevent fatigue during  
longer journeys.  
1 Lumbar region  
The PULSE function inflates and deflates the air  
cushions in the lumbar region rhythmically.  
Press j or k to select a lumbar region.  
Press and hold æ or ç to inflate or deflate the  
selected lumbar support.  
An indicator lamp on the switch lights up when the  
PULSE function is switched on. The PULSE function  
switches off automatically after approximately  
8 minutes.  
2 Center section  
Press æ or ç side of switch and hold; the air  
cushion will be inflated or deflated. Release the  
switch in the desired position.  
Seats  
75  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Index  
data  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Seats  
76  
Seat heater  
The seat heaters may automatically switch off if too  
many power consumers are switched on at the same  
time or if the battery charge is low. In this case, one or  
both indicator lamps will blink.  
The seat heaters can be switched on with the electronic  
key in starter switch positions 1 or 2.  
The buttons are located on each door.  
The seat heaters switch back on again automatically as  
soon as sufficient voltage is available.  
Notes:  
If the blinking of the indicator lamps is distracting to  
you, the seat heaters can be switched off.  
When in operation, the seat heater consumes a large  
amount of electrical power. It is not advisable to use the  
seat heater longer than necessary.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Vehicles without seat ventilation function:  
Normal heating mode:  
Press button (1).  
One indicator lamp in the switch lights up.  
The seat heater will be automatically switched off after  
approximately 30 minutes.  
Rapid heating mode:  
Press button (2).  
Both indicator lamps in the switch light up.  
1
2
The system switches over to normal heating mode  
automatically after approximately 5 minutes.  
P54.25-2131-26  
Turning off the heater:  
Press button (1) or (2) again.  
The indicator lamps go out. The seat heater is switched  
off.  
Seats  
77  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Index  
data  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Seats  
78  
Vehicles with seat ventilation function:  
Rapid heating mode:  
Press button (3) once.  
Both red indicator lamps above the button light up.  
The system switches over to normal heating mode  
automatically after approximately 5 minutes.  
Normal heating mode:  
Press button (3) twice.  
One red indicator lamp above the button lights up.  
3
The seat heater will be automatically switched off after  
approximately 30 minutes.  
P54.25-2132-26  
Turning off the heater:  
Press the button (3) again.  
The indicator lamps go out. The seat heater is switched  
off.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seat ventilation system  
The seat ventilators may automatically switch off if too  
many power consumers are switched on at the same  
time or if the battery charge is low. In this case, one or  
more indicator lamps will blink.  
The buttons are located on each door.  
Seat ventilation can be activated manually with the  
electronic key in starter switch positions 1 or 2, or by  
the summer opening function, see page 45.  
The seat ventilation switch back on again automatically  
as soon as sufficient voltage is available.  
If the blinking of the indicator lamps is distracting to  
you, the seat ventilators can be switched off.  
Notes:  
When in operation, the seat ventilation system  
consumes a large amount of electrical power. It is not  
advisable to use the seat ventilator longer than  
necessary.  
The maximum ventilation level (level 3) is automatically  
selected if the driver’s seat ventilation is activated by  
the summer opening function, see page 45.  
Seats  
79  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Index  
data  
   
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Seats  
80  
Level 2 ventilation setting (middle):  
Press button (1) again.  
Two blue indicator lamps above the button light up.  
Level 1 ventilation setting (minimum):  
Press button (1) again.  
One blue indicator lamp above the button lights up.  
Turning off the seat ventilation:  
Press button (1) again.  
The indicator lamps go out. The seat ventilation is  
1
switched off.  
P54.25-2133-26  
Manual activation:  
Turn the electronic key in starter switch to position 1  
or 2.  
Level 3 ventilation setting (maximum):  
Press button (1).  
Three blue indicator lamps above the button light up.  
The level of ventilation is decreased one step  
approximately every 10 minutes.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Power head restraints, rear  
Important!  
For safety reasons, always drive with the rear head  
restraints in the upright position when the rear seats  
are occupied.  
Keep the area around head restraints clear of articles  
(e.g. clothing) to not obstruct the folding operation of  
the head restraints.  
Notes:  
Both head restraints fold up or back together.  
The head restraints will position themselves  
automatically when the seats are occupied (seat belt  
buckled).  
The switches are located on the front and rear center  
console.  
Turn electronic key in starter switch to position 1 or 2.  
Activate switch:  
1 Place head restraints upright.  
2 Fold head restraints backward.  
Seats  
81  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Index  
data  
 
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Warning!  
Car care  
Index  
Restraint systems  
82  
Seat belts and integrated restraint system  
Children 12 years old and under must never ride in  
the front seat, except in a Mercedes-Benz  
authorized BabySmartTM compatible child seat,  
which operates with the BabySmartTM system  
installed in the vehicle to deactivate the passenger  
side front airbag when it is properly installed.  
Otherwise they will be struck by the airbag when it  
inflates in a crash. If this happens, serious or fatal  
injury will result.  
Your vehicle is equipped with seat belts for all seats,  
emergency tensioning retractors, dual front airbags,  
side impact airbags for driver, front and rear  
passengers, and head protective window curtain  
airbags. Their protective functions are designed to  
complement one another.  
Seat belts  
According to accident statistics, children are safer  
when properly restrained in the rear seating  
positions than in the front seating positions.  
Infants and small children must ride in back seats  
and be seated in an appropriate infant or child  
restraint system, which is properly secured with  
the vehicle’s seat belt, fully in accordance with the  
child seat manufacturer’s instructions.  
Important!  
Laws in most states and all Canadian provinces require  
seat belt use.  
All states and provinces require use of child restraints  
that comply with U.S. Federal Motor Vehicle Safety  
Standard 213 and Canadian Motor Vehicle Safety  
Standard 213.  
A child’s risk of serious or fatal injuries is  
significantly increased if the child restraints are  
not properly secured in the vehicle and the child is  
not properly secured in the child restraint.  
All child restraints systems are designed to be secured  
in vehicle seats by lap belts or the lap belt portion of a  
lap-shoulder belt.  
For your safety and that of your passengers we strongly  
recommend their use.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Seat belt nonusage warning system  
Warning!  
With the electronic key in starter switch position 2, a  
warning sounds for a short time if the driver’s seat belt  
is not fastened.  
The seat belts provide protection only with the  
backrest locked in place. Do not drive the vehicle  
when the backrest is not locked in place. If the  
warning message “SEAT BACKREST LEFT – LOCK!”  
or “SEAT BACKREST RIGHT – LOCK!” is displayed  
in the multifunction display, then the respective  
backrest is not engaged in its lock. For backrest see  
page 72.  
Automatic comfort-fit seat belt:  
An automatic comfort-fit feature for driver and front  
passenger seat belt is activated when the electronic key  
in the starter switch is turned to position 1 or 2.  
Never ride in a moving vehicle with the backrest  
reclined. Sitting in an excessively reclined position  
can be dangerous. You could slide under the seat  
belt in a collision. If you slide under it, the belt  
would apply force at the abdomen or neck. That  
could cause serious or even fatal injuries. The  
backrest and seat belt provide the best restraint  
when the wearer is in an upright position and the  
belt is properly positioned on the body.  
The retraction force of the inertia reel is reduced,  
increasing the level of seat belt comfort.  
Note:  
For cleaning and care of the seat belts see page 382.  
Restraint systems  
83  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
 
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Warning!  
Car care  
Index  
Restraint systems  
84  
Warning!  
Failure to wear and properly fasten and position  
your seat belt greatly increases your risk of  
injuries and their likely severity in an accident.  
You and your passengers should always wear seat  
belts.  
Never let more people ride in the vehicle than there  
are seat belts available. Be sure everyone riding in  
the vehicle is correctly restrained with a separate  
seat belt.  
If you are ever in an accident, your injuries can be  
considerably more severe without your seat belt  
properly buckled. Without your seat belt buckled,  
you are much more likely to hit the interior of the  
vehicle or be ejected from it. You can be seriously  
injured or killed.  
In the same crash, the possibility of injury or death  
is lessened if you are wearing your seat belt.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Fastening seat belts  
1 Latch plate  
2 Buckle  
3 Release button  
Push the latch plate (1) into the buckle (2) until it clicks.  
Do not twist the belt. A twisted seat belt may cause  
injury.  
To help avoid severe or fatal injuries, the lap belt should  
be positioned as low as possible on your hips and not  
across the abdomen.  
1
2
3
Warning!  
Always fasten your seat belt before driving off.  
Always make sure your passengers are properly  
restrained – even those sitting in the rear.  
Tighten the lap portion to a snug fit by pulling shoulder  
portion up.  
P91.40-200613-27  
Restraint systems  
85  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Index  
data  
 
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Warning!  
Car care  
Index  
Restraint systems  
86  
Operation of seat belts  
The inertia reel stops the belt from unwinding during  
sudden stops or when quickly pulling on the belt.  
USE SEAT BELTS PROPERLY.  
• Seat belts can only work when used properly.  
Never wear seat belts in any other way than as  
described in this section, as that could result  
in serious injuries in case of an accident.  
The locking function of the reel may be checked by  
quickly pulling out the belt.  
Caution!  
• Each occupant should wear their seat belt at all  
times, because seat belts help reduce the  
likelihood of and potential severity of injuries  
in accidents, including rollovers. The  
For safety reasons, avoid adjusting the seat or seat back  
into positions which could affect the correct seat belt  
positioning.  
integrated restraint system includes “SRS”  
(driver airbag, front passenger airbag, side  
impact airbags, head protection window  
curtain airbags for side windows), “ETR” (seat  
belt emergency tensioning retractors), and  
front seat knee bolsters. The system is  
designed to enhance the protection offered to  
properly belted occupants in certain frontal  
(front airbags) and side (side impact and  
window curtain airbags) impacts which exceed  
preset deployment thresholds.  
Unfastening of seat belts  
Press release button (3) in the belt buckle (2).  
Allow the retractor to completely rewind the seat belt by  
guiding the latch plate (1).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
• Never wear the shoulder belt under your arm,  
against your neck or off your shoulder. In a  
crash, your body would move too far forward.  
That would increase the chance of head and  
neck injuries. The belt would also apply too  
much force to the ribs or abdomen, which  
could severely injure internal organs such as  
your liver or spleen.  
• Each seat belt should never be used for more  
than one person at a time. Do not fasten a seat  
belt around a person and another person or  
other objects.  
• Belts should not be worn twisted. In a crash,  
you wouldn’t have the full width of the belt to  
manage impact forces. The twisted belt against  
your body could cause injuries.  
• Never wear belts over rigid or breakable  
objects in or on your clothing, such as  
eyeglasses, pens, keys etc., as these might  
cause injuries.  
• Pregnant women should also use a lap-  
shoulder belt. The lap belt portion should be  
positioned as low as possible on the hips to  
avoid any possible pressure on the abdomen.  
• Position the lap belt as low as possible on your  
hips and not across the abdomen. If the belt is  
positioned across your abdomen, it could cause  
serious injuries in a crash.  
• Never place your feet on the instrument panel  
or on the seat. Always keep both feet on the  
floor in front of the seat.  
Restraint systems  
87  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Restraint systems  
88  
Warning!  
USE CHILD RESTRAINTS PROPERLY.  
Children too big for child restraint systems must  
ride in back seats using regular seat belts. Position  
shoulder belt across chest and shoulder, not face or  
neck. A booster seat may be necessary to achieve  
proper belt positioning.  
Children 12 years old and under must never ride in  
the front seat, except in a Mercedes-Benz  
authorized BabySmartTM compatible child seat,  
which operates with the BabySmartTM system  
installed in the vehicle to deactivate the passenger  
front airbag when it is properly installed.  
BabySmartTM airbag deactivation system  
Special BabySmartTM compatible child seats, designed  
for use with the Mercedes-Benz system and available at  
any authorized Mercedes-Benz Center are required for  
use with the BabySmartTM airbag deactivation system.  
With the special child seat properly installed, the  
passenger front airbag will not deploy.  
Otherwise they will be struck by the airbag when it  
inflates in a crash. If this happens, serious or fatal  
injury will result.  
According to accident statistics, children are safer  
when properly restrained in the rear seating  
positions than in the front seating positions.  
Infants and small children must ride in the back  
seats and be seated in an appropriate infant or  
child restraint system, which is properly secured  
with the vehicle’s seat belt, fully in accordance  
with the child seat manufacturer’s instructions.  
The 7 indicator lamp located on the center console  
will be illuminated, except with electronic key removed  
or in starter switch position 0. The system does not  
deactivate the door mounted side impact airbag.  
A child’s risk of serious or fatal injuries is  
significantly increased if the child restraints are  
not properly secured in the vehicle and the child is  
not properly secured in the child restraint.  
BabySmartTM is a trademark of Siemens Automotive Corp.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Self-test BabySmartTM without special child seat  
installed  
Warning!  
The BabySmartTM airbag deactivation system will  
ONLY work with a special child seat designed to  
operate with it. It will not work with child seats  
which are not BabySmartTM compatible.  
After turning electronic key in starter switch to  
position 1 or 2, the 7 indicator lamp located on the  
center console comes on for approx. 6 seconds and then  
extinguishes.  
Never place anything between seat cushion and  
child seat (e.g. pillow), since it reduces the  
effectiveness of the deactivation system.  
If the indicator lamp should not come on or is  
continuously lit, the system is not functioning. You must  
see an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center before seating  
any child on the front passenger seat. See page 296 for  
notes on the 7 indicator lamp.  
Follow the manufacturer’s instructions for  
installation of special child seats.  
The passenger front airbag will not deploy only if  
the 7 indicator lamp remains illuminated.  
Please be sure to check the indicator every time  
you use the special system child seat. Should the  
light go out while the restraint is installed, please  
check installation. If the light remains out, do not  
use the BabySmartTM restraint to transport children  
on the front passenger seat until the system has  
been repaired.  
BabySmartTM is a trademark of Siemens Automotive Corp.  
Restraint systems  
89  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
 
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Restraint systems  
90  
Supplemental restraint system (SRS)  
Seat belt fastened  
first threshold exceeded: ETR activates  
second threshold exceeded: airbag also activates  
Seat belt not fastened  
Airbags are intended as a supplement to seat belts.  
Airbags alone cannot protect as well as airbags plus  
seat belts in impacts for which the airbags were  
designed to operate, and do not afford any protection  
whatsoever in crashes for which the airbags are not  
designed to deploy.  
Front seats:  
first threshold exceeded: airbag activates, not ETR  
Rear seats:  
The SRS uses two crash severity levels (thresholds) to  
activate either the emergency tensioning retractor (ETR)  
or front airbag or both. Activation depends on the  
direction and severity of the impact exceeding the  
preset thresholds and whether the seat belt is fastened.  
first threshold exceeded: ETR activates  
Driver and front passenger and rear seat systems  
operate independently of each other.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Emergency tensioning retractor (ETR)  
and in rear impacts exceeding a preset severity level.  
They remove slack from the belts in such a way that the  
seat belts fit more snugly against the body restricting its  
forward movement as much as possible.  
The seat belts for the front and rear seats are equipped  
with emergency tensioning retractors. These tensioning  
retractors are located in each belt’s inertia reel and  
become operationally ready with the electronic key in  
starter switch position 1 or 2.  
In cases of other frontal impacts, angled impacts, roll-  
overs, certain side impacts, or other accidents without  
sufficient frontal or rear impact forces, the emergency  
tensioning retractors will not be activated. The driver  
and passengers will then be protected by the fastened  
seat belts and inertia reel in the usual manner.  
The emergency tensioning retractors are designed to  
activate only when the seat belts are fastened during  
frontal impacts exceeding the first threshold of the SRS  
Restraint systems  
91  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
 
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Restraint systems  
92  
Airbags  
1 Driver airbag  
Front airbags  
2 Front passenger airbag  
The most effective occupant restraint system yet  
developed for use in production vehicles is the seat belt.  
In some cases, however, the protective effect of a seat  
belt can be further enhanced by an airbag.  
In conjunction with wearing the seat belts, the driver  
and front passenger airbags can provide increased  
protection for the driver and front passenger in certain  
frontal impacts exceeding preset thresholds.  
2
Side impact and head protection window curtain airbags  
can provide increased protection to belted occupants on  
the impacted side of the vehicle in side impacts  
exceeding its preset threshold.  
1
The operational readiness of the airbag system is  
verified by the indicator lamp “SRS” in the instrument  
cluster when turning the electronic key in starter switch  
to position 1 or 2. If no fault is detected, the lamp will go  
out after approximately 4 seconds; after the lamp goes  
out, the system continues to monitor the components  
and circuitry of the airbag system and will indicate a  
malfunction by coming on again. If the lamp does not  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
come on at all or if it fails to extinguish after  
approximately 4 seconds or if it comes on thereafter, a  
malfunction in the system has been detected.  
In the operational mode, after the indicator lamp has  
gone out following the initial check, interruptions or  
short circuits in the airbag ignition circuit and in the  
driver and front passenger seat belt buckle harnesses,  
and low voltage in the entire system are detected and  
indicated.  
The following system components are monitored or  
undergo a self-check: crash-sensor(s), airbag ignition  
circuits, front seat belt buckles, emergency tensioning  
retractors, seat sensor.  
Warning!  
Initially, when the electronic key is turned from starter  
switch position 0 to position 1 or 2, malfunctions in the  
crash sensor are detected and indicated (the “SRS”  
indicator lamp stays on longer than 4 seconds or does  
not come on).  
In the event a malfunction of the “SRS” is indicated  
as outlined above, the “SRS” may not be  
operational. For your safety, we strongly  
recommend that you visit an authorized  
Mercedes-Benz Center immediately to have the  
system checked; otherwise the “SRS” may not be  
activated when needed in an accident, which could  
result in serious or fatal injury, or it might deploy  
unexpectedly and unnecessarily which could also  
result in injury.  
Have the system checked at your authorized  
Mercedes-Benz Center immediately.  
Note:  
See page 293 for information on the supplemental  
restraint system (SRS) indicator lamp.  
Restraint systems  
93  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Restraint systems  
94  
The driver and passenger front airbags are designed to  
activate only in certain frontal impacts exceeding a  
preset threshold. The front passenger airbag deploys  
only if the front passenger seat is occupied and the  
7 indicator lamp on the center console is not  
illuminated.  
Note:  
Heavy objects on the front passenger seat can appear to  
the “SRS” to indicate the presence of an occupant in  
that seat which causes the passenger front airbag to  
deploy in a crash exceeding the appropriate threshold.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Side impact airbags, window curtain airbags  
Side impact airbags  
The side impact airbags are designed to activate only in  
certain side impacts exceeding a preset threshold. Only  
the side impact airbags on the impacted side of the  
vehicle deploy.  
4
The side impact airbag for the front passenger deploys  
only if the front passenger seat is occupied.  
The side impact airbag for the right rear passenger  
deploys only if a preset threshold is exceeded. The side  
impact airbag for the left rear passenger deploys  
together with the side impact airbag for the driver.  
3
3
Side impact airbags operate best in conjunction with a  
properly positioned and fastened seat belt.  
3 Side impact airbags  
Note:  
4 Window curtain airbags  
Heavy objects on front passenger seat can cause the  
front passenger side impact airbag to deploy in a crash.  
Restraint systems  
95  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
   
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Restraint systems  
96  
Window curtain airbags  
In cases of other frontal impacts, angled impacts,  
roll-overs, other side impacts, rear collisions, or  
other accidents, the airbags will not be activated.  
The driver and passengers will then be protected by  
the fastened seat belts.  
The head protection window curtain airbags afford  
greater protection against injuries to the head and  
upper body. They fill up in the area between the A and  
C pillars (see arrows) between the side windows and an  
occupant’s head.  
We caution you not to rely on the presence of the  
airbags in order to avoid wearing your seat belt.  
The window curtain airbags are designed to activate  
only in certain side impacts exceeding a preset  
threshold. Only the head protection window curtain  
airbag on the impacted side of the vehicle deploys.  
Warning!  
Airbags are designed to reduce the potential of  
injury in certain frontal (front airbags) impacts, or  
side (side impact and head protection window  
curtain airbags) impacts which may cause  
significant injuries, however, no system available  
today can totally eliminate injuries and fatalities.  
Important!  
Airbags are designed to activate only in certain  
frontal (front airbags) impacts, or side (side impact  
and head protection window curtain airbags)  
impacts which exceed preset thresholds.  
The activation of the “SRS” temporarily releases a  
small amount of dust from the airbags. This dust,  
however, is neither injurious to your health, nor  
does it indicate a fire in the vehicle. The dust might  
cause some temporary breathing difficulty for  
people with asthma or other breathing trouble. To  
avoid this, you may wish to get out of the vehicle as  
soon as it is safe to do so. If you have any breathing  
difficulty but cannot get out of the vehicle after the  
airbag inflates, then get fresh air by opening a  
window or door.  
Only during these types of impacts, if of sufficient  
severity to meet the deployment thresholds, will  
they provide their supplemental protection.  
The driver and passenger should always wear their  
seat belts, otherwise it is not possible for the airbags  
to provide their supplemental protection.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Your vehicle was originally equipped with airbags  
which are designed to activate in certain impacts  
exceeding a preset threshold to reduce the potential  
and severity of injury. It is important to your safety  
and that of your passenger that you replace deployed  
airbags and repair any malfunctioning airbags to  
ensure the vehicle will continue to provide crash  
protection for occupants.  
• Sit properly belted in an upright position with  
your back against the backrest.  
• Adjust the driver seat as far as possible  
rearward, still permitting proper operation of  
vehicle controls. The distance from the center  
of the driver’s breastbone to the center of the  
airbag cover on the steering wheel must be at  
least ten inches (25 cm) or more. You should be  
able to accomplish this by a combination of  
adjustments to the seat and steering wheel. If  
you have any problems, please see your  
authorized Mercedes-Benz Center.  
Warning!  
To reduce the risk of injury when the front airbags  
inflate, it is very important for the driver and front  
passenger to always be in a properly seated  
position and to wear your seat belt.  
• Do not lean with your head or chest close to the  
steering wheel or dashboard.  
For maximum protection in the event of a collision  
always be in normal seated position with your back  
against the backrest. Fasten your seat belt and  
ensure that it is properly positioned on your body.  
• Keep hands on the outside of steering wheel  
rim. Placing hands and arms inside the rim  
can increase the risk and potential severity of  
hand/arm injury when driver front airbag  
inflates.  
Since the airbag inflates with considerable speed  
and force, a proper seating and hands on steering  
wheel position will help to keep you at a safe  
distance from the airbag. Occupants who are  
unbelted, out of position or too close to the airbag  
can be seriously injured by an airbag as it inflates  
with great force in the blink of an eye:  
• Adjust the front passenger seat as far as  
possible rearward from the dashboard when  
the seat is occupied.  
Restraint systems  
97  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Warning!  
Car care  
Index  
Restraint systems  
98  
• Occupants, especially children, should never  
lean their heads in the area of the door or rear  
quarter interior trim panel where the side  
airbag inflates. This could result in serious  
injuries or death should the airbag be  
triggered. Always sit upright, properly use the  
seat belts and appropriate size infant or child  
restraint system.  
Accident research shows that the safest place for  
children in an automobile is in the rear seat.  
Should you choose to place a child 12 years old or  
under in the front passenger seat of your vehicle,  
you must properly use a BabySmartTM child  
restraint which will turn off the passenger side  
airbag. BabySmartTM will not, however, turn off any  
side impact airbag.  
• Children 12 years old and under must never  
ride in the front seat, except in a  
It should be noted that with respect to both front  
and rear side impact airbags there is a possibility  
for a side airbag related injury if occupants,  
especially children, are not properly seated or  
restrained when next to a side airbag which needs  
to deploy rapidly in a side impact in order to do its  
job.  
Mercedes-Benz authorized BabySmartTM  
compatible child seat, which operates with the  
BabySmartTM system installed in the vehicle to  
deactivate the passenger side front airbag  
when it is properly installed. Otherwise they  
will be struck by the airbag when it inflates in  
a crash. If this happens, serious or fatal injury  
can result.  
Failure to follow these instructions can result in  
severe injuries to you or other occupants.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
To help avoid the possibility of injury, please follow  
these guidelines: (1) occupants, especially  
children, should never place their bodies or lean  
their heads in the area of the front door or rear  
quarter trim panels where the side airbag inflates.  
This could result in serious injuries or death  
should the side airbag be activated; (2) always sit  
upright, properly use the seat belts and use an  
appropriately sized infant or child restraint system  
for all children 12 years old or under; and (3)  
always wear seat belts properly.  
If you believe that, even with the use of these  
guidelines, it would be safer for your rear seat  
occupants to have both rear quarter trim panel  
mounted side airbags deactivated, then  
deactivation can be accomplished upon your  
written election to do so at your authorized  
Mercedes-Benz Center at an additional cost. Please  
contact your local authorized Mercedes-Benz  
Center or call our Client Assistance Center at  
1-800-FOR-MERCedes (1-800-367-6372) for details.  
Restraint systems  
99  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
100  
Car care  
Index  
Restraint systems  
Safety guidelines for the seat belt, emergency  
tensioning retractor and airbag  
• Do not pass belts over sharp edges.  
• Do not make any modification that could  
change the effectiveness of the belts.  
Warning!  
• Do not use handles or coat hooks above doors  
and rear windows for placing such items as  
coat hangers etc..  
• Damaged seat belts or belts that were highly  
stressed in an accident must be replaced and  
their anchoring points must also be checked.  
Use only belts installed or supplied by an  
authorized Mercedes-Benz Center.  
• An airbag system component within the  
steering wheel gets hot after the airbag has  
inflated. Do not touch.  
• Airbags and “ETR’s” are designed to function  
on a one-time-only basis. An airbag or  
emergency tensioning retractor (ETR) that was  
activated must be replaced.  
• Improper work on the system, including  
incorrect installation and removal, can lead to  
possible injury through an unintended  
activation of the “SRS”.  
• No modifications of any kind may be made to  
any components or wiring of the “SRS”. This  
includes changing or removing any component  
or part of the “SRS”, the installation of  
• In addition, through improper work there is a  
risk of rendering the “SRS” inoperative or  
causing unintended airbag deployment. Work  
on the “SRS” must therefore only be performed  
by an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center.  
additional trim material, badges etc. over the  
steering wheel hub, front passenger airbag  
cover, door trim panels, or door frame trims,  
and installation of additional electrical/  
electronic equipment on or near “SRS”  
components and wiring. Keep area between  
airbags and occupants free from objects (e.g.  
packages, purses, umbrellas, etc.).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
When you sell your vehicle we strongly urge you to give  
notice to the subsequent owner that it is equipped with  
an “SRS” by alerting them to the applicable section in  
the Operator’s Manual.  
• For your protection and the protection of  
others, when scrapping the airbag unit or  
emergency tensioning retractor, our safety  
instructions must be followed. These  
instructions are available from your  
authorized Mercedes-Benz Center.  
• Given the considerable deployment speed and  
the textile structure of the airbags, there is the  
possibility of abrasions or other injuries  
resulting from airbag deployment.  
Restraint systems  
101  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
102  
Car care  
Index  
Restraint systems  
Infant and child restraint systems  
Important!  
We recommend all infants and children be properly  
restrained at all times while the vehicle is in motion.  
All lap-shoulder belts except the driver seat belt have  
special seat belt retractors for secure fastening of child  
restraints.  
The use of infant or child restraints is required by law in  
all 50 states and all Canadian provinces.  
Infants and small children should be seated in an  
appropriate infant or child restraint system properly  
secured by a lap-shoulder belt, and that complies with  
U.S. Federal Motor Vehicle Safety Standard 213 and  
Canadian Motor Vehicle Safety Standard 213.  
A statement by the child restraint manufacturer of  
compliance with this standard can be found on the  
instruction label on the restraint and in the instruction  
manual provided with the restraint.  
To activate, pull shoulder belt out completely and let it  
retract. During the seat belt retraction a ratcheting  
sound can be heard to indicate that the special seat belt  
retractor is activated. The belt is now locked.  
To deactivate, release seat belt buckle and let seat belt  
retract completely. The seat belt can again be used in  
the usual manner.  
When using any infant or child restraint system, be sure  
to carefully read and follow all manufacturer’s  
instructions for installation and use.  
Note:  
For child seats with mounting fittings for tether  
anchorages refer to page 104 (installation of infant and  
child restraint systems).  
Please read and observe warning labels affixed to inside  
of vehicle and to infant or child restraints.  
Warning!  
Never release the seat belt buckle while vehicle is  
in motion, since the special seat belt retractor will  
be deactivated.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Warning!  
Children too big for child restraint systems must  
ride in back seats using regular seat belts. Position  
shoulder belt across chest and shoulder, not face or  
neck. A booster seat may be necessary to achieve  
proper belt positioning for children from 41 lbs. to  
the point where a lap/shoulder belt fits properly  
without one.  
Children 12 years old and under must never ride in  
the front seat, except in a Mercedes-Benz  
authorized BabySmartTM compatible child seat,  
which operates with the BabySmartTM system  
installed in the vehicle to deactivate the passenger  
front airbag when it is properly installed.  
Otherwise they will be struck by the airbag when it  
inflates in a crash. If this happens, serious or fatal  
injury can result.  
When the child restraint is not in use, remove it  
from the vehicle or secure it with the seat belt to  
prevent the child restraint from becoming a  
projectile in the event of an accident.  
According to accident statistics, children are safer  
when properly restrained in the rear seating  
positions than in the front seating positions.  
Infants and small children must ride in back seats  
and be seated in an appropriate infant or child  
restraint system, which is properly secured with  
the vehicle’s seat belt, fully in accordance with the  
child seat manufacturer’s instructions.  
Infants and small children should never share a  
seat belt with another occupant. During an  
accident, they could be crushed between the  
occupant and seat belt.  
Restraint systems  
103  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
104  
Car care  
Index  
Restraint systems  
Installation of infant and child restraint systems  
1
P91.40-2205-26  
This vehicle is provided with tether anchorages for a top  
tether strap at each of the rear seating positions.  
To secure a tether strap to the anchorage, securely  
fasten the hook (3), which is part of the tether strap, to  
the anchorage ring (2). For safety, please make sure that  
the hook has attached to the ring beyond the safety  
catch, as illustrated.  
Prior to installing a tether strap, remove cover (1) from  
anchorage ring (2) and store in a convenient place (e.g.  
glove box).  
After removing the tether strap, reinstall the cover (1).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Steering wheel adjustment  
Warning!  
2
1
Do not adjust the steering wheel while driving.  
Adjusting the steering wheel while driving could  
cause the driver to lose the control of the vehicle.  
When leaving the vehicle always remove the  
electronic key from the starter switch, and take the  
KEYLESS-GO-card (if so equipped) with you.  
The steering wheel adjustment feature can also be  
operated with the driver’s door open. Do not leave  
children unattended in the vehicle, or with access  
to an unlocked vehicle. Unsupervised use of vehicle  
equipment may cause serious personal injury.  
2
1
P68.00-2011-26  
The stalk is located on the steering column.  
1 Steering column, lengthen or shorten column  
Move the stalk to the front or rear.  
2 Steering column, height  
To adjust the steering wheel position, turn the electronic  
key in starter switch to position 1 or 2. With the driver’s  
door open, the steering wheel can also be operated with  
the electronic key removed or in starter switch  
position 0. However any adjustment will be cancelled  
and the steering wheel will return to it’s position stored  
in memory if the driver’s door is closed or the electronic  
key is inserted in the starter switch.  
Move the stalk up or down.  
Note:  
The steering wheel adjustment can be stored together  
with the seat and mirror adjustment.  
See page 111 for notes on the memory function.  
Steering wheel adjustment  
105  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
   
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
106  
Car care  
Index  
Rear view mirrors  
Rear view mirrors  
Inside rear view mirror  
Manually adjust the mirror.  
Note:  
The automatic antiglare function does not react, if  
incoming light is not aimed directly at sensors in the  
mirror.  
Storing inside rear view mirror positions  
Warning!  
The seat, exterior rear view mirror and steering wheel  
positions are stored together with the interior rear view  
mirror position. See page 111 for notes on the memory  
function.  
In the case of an accident liquid electrolyte may  
escape the mirror housing when the mirror glass  
breaks.  
Electrolyte has an irritating effect. Do not allow the  
liquid come into contact with eyes, skin, clothing,  
or respiratory system. In cases it does, immediately  
flush affected area with water, and seek medical  
help if necessary.  
Rear view mirror, automatic antiglare  
Antiglare mode:  
With the electronic key in starter switch position 2, the  
mirror reflection brightness responds to changes in  
light sensitivity.  
With the gear selector lever in position “R”, or with the  
interior light switched on, the mirror brightness does  
not respond to changes in light sensitivity.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Exterior rear view mirrors  
Exterior mirror adjustment  
Turn the electronic key in starter switch to position 2.  
Push button to select mirror to be adjusted:  
Driver’s side – Push button (1).  
2
1
Passenger side – Push button (2).  
Push the adjustment button (3) up, down, left or right  
according to the setting desired.  
3
4
Note:  
The exterior rear view mirrors have electrically heated  
glass. The heater switches on automatically, depending  
on outside temperature.  
P88.70-2023-26  
Storing mirror positions in memory  
The buttons are located on the driver’s door.  
The exterior rear view mirror positions are stored in  
memory with the seat/steering column/interior rear  
view mirror position and can be recalled when  
necessary. See page 111 for notes on the memory  
function.  
Warning!  
Exercise care when using the passenger side  
exterior mirror. The mirror surface is convex  
(outwardly curved surface for a wider field of  
view). Objects in mirror are closer than they  
appear. Check your inside rear view mirror or  
glance over your shoulder before changing lanes.  
Rear view mirrors  
107  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
         
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
108  
Car care  
Index  
Rear view mirrors  
Parking position  
To store passenger mirror parking position:  
The passenger side exterior mirror can be adjusted and  
programmed to assist the driver during parking  
maneuvers (e.g. to observe the curb or other objects  
close to the vehicle).  
1. Turn electronic key to starter switch position 1 or 2.  
The vehicle must be stationary.  
2. Select passenger side mirror & and adjust the  
With the electronic key in starter switch position 2, and  
the exterior rear view mirror switch in the passenger  
side position, the passenger side mirror will be turned  
downward when placing the gear selector lever in “R”  
reverse.  
mirror to view the curb.  
3. Push the memory button “M” (4).  
4. Within 3 seconds push bottom of adjustment  
button (3).  
The mirror position can now be adjusted as desired.  
The mirror should not move.  
At speeds above approx. 6 mph (10 km/h), upon shifting  
gear selector lever from “R” Reverse, or upon pressing  
the driver’s side mirror button (1), the passenger side  
mirror will return to its previous position.  
Repeat the memory procedure if the mirror moves.  
5. Select driver side mirror. The passenger side mirror  
will return to its previous position.  
Note:  
One stored parking position is available for each of the  
two electronic main keys or each of the KEYLESS-GO-  
cards (vehicles with KEYLESS-GO).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Exterior mirrors, electrically folding  
Important!  
If an exterior mirror housing is forcibly pushed forward  
(hit from the rear), it must be repositioned manually by  
applying firm pressure until it snaps back into place.  
If an exterior mirror is forcibly pushed rearward (hit  
from the front), press button (2) to fold mirrors in, then  
press button (1) to fold mirrors out. Do not force mirror  
by hand.  
2
1
Before running the vehicle through an automatic car  
wash, fold mirrors in, otherwise they might get  
damaged.  
Note:  
P88.70-2024-26  
The mirrors can vibrate if they are not completely folded  
out.  
The buttons are located on the driver’s door.  
Turn the electronic key in starter switch to position 1  
or 2.  
1 Push button to fold both mirrors out.  
2 Push button to fold both mirrors in.  
Rear view mirrors  
109  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
 
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
110  
Car care  
Index  
Rear view mirrors  
Driver’s side exterior mirror, antiglare mode  
Warning!  
Antiglare mode:  
In the case of an accident liquid electrolyte may  
escape the mirror housing when the mirror glass  
breaks.  
With the electronic key in starter switch position 2, the  
mirror reflection brightness responds to changes in  
light sensitivity.  
Electrolyte has an irritating effect. Do not allow the  
liquid come into contact with eyes, skin, clothing,  
or respiratory system. In cases it does, immediately  
flush affected area with water, and seek medical  
help if necessary.  
With the gear selector lever in position “R”, or with the  
interior light switched on, the mirror brightness does  
not respond to changes in light sensitivity.  
Note:  
Important!  
The automatic antiglare function does not react, if  
incoming light is not aimed directly at sensors in the  
mirror.  
Electrolyte drops coming into contact with the vehicle  
paint finish can only be completely removed while in  
their liquid state, by applying plenty of water.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Memory function  
Three sets of seat/head restraint/steering wheel/and  
rear view mirror positions may be stored into memory.  
Together with the driver’s seat position you can store  
the positions for steering wheel, exterior mirrors and  
rear-view mirror.  
For the front passenger you can store the seat position.  
Three stored positions are available for each of the two  
electronic main keys or each of the KEYLESS-GO-cards.  
The memory and stored position buttons are located on  
the doors.  
1 Memory button, used to store selected positions  
which can be retrieved by pressing the buttons (2)  
2 Stored position buttons  
Memory function  
111  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
   
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
112  
Car care  
Index  
Memory function  
Storing positions into memory  
Recalling positions from memory  
Driver’s seat: with the electronic key in starter switch  
position 1 or 2 or with the driver’s door open and the  
electronic key inserted in the starter switch.  
To recall a seat/head restraint/steering wheel/inside  
rear view mirror and exterior rear view mirror position,  
push and hold button “1”, “2” or “3” until seat/head  
restraint/steering wheel and exterior rear view mirror  
movement has stopped.  
Front passenger seat: with electronic key in starter  
switch position 1 or 2 or the passenger door open.  
The seat/head restraint/steering wheel/inside rear view  
mirror and exterior rear view mirror movement stops  
when the button is released.  
Adjust the seat and multicontour backrest to the desired  
position. You can also adjust the steering wheel, the  
exterior mirrors electrically and the interior rear-view  
mirror by hand for the driver’s seat. See page 67 for  
front seat adjustment, page 107 for exterior mirror  
adjustment and page 105 for steering wheel adjustment.  
Caution!  
Do not operate the power seats using the memory  
button if the backrest is in an excessively reclined  
position. Doing so could cause damage to front or rear  
seats.  
Push memory button “M”, release and push a stored  
position button “1”,“ 2” or “3” within 3 seconds.  
First move backrest to an upright position.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Important!  
Warning!  
Prior to operating the vehicle, the driver should check  
and adjust if necessary the seat height, seat position  
fore and aft, and backrest angle to insure adequate  
control, reach and comfort. The head restraint should  
also be adjusted for proper height. See also airbag  
section for proper seat positioning.  
Children 12 years old and under must never ride in  
the front seat, except in a Mercedes-Benz  
authorized BabySmartTM compatible child seat,  
which operates with the BabySmartTM system  
installed in the vehicle to deactivate the passenger  
front airbag when it is properly installed.  
Otherwise they will be struck by the airbag when it  
inflates in a crash. If this happens, serious or fatal  
injury can result.  
In addition, also adjust the steering wheel to ensure  
adequate control, reach, operation and comfort. Both the  
inside and outside rear view mirrors should be adjusted  
for adequate rearward vision.  
According to accident statistics, children are safer  
when properly restrained in the rear seating  
positions than in the front seating positions.  
Infants and small children must ride in back seats  
and be seated in an appropriate infant or child  
restraint system, which is properly secured with  
the vehicle’s seat belt, fully in accordance with the  
child seat manufacturer’s instructions.  
Fasten seat belts. Infants and small children should be  
seated in a properly secured restraint system that  
complies with U.S. Federal Motor Vehicle Safety  
Standard 213 and Canadian Motor Vehicle Safety  
Standard 213.  
All seat, head restraint, steering wheel, and rear view  
mirror adjustments as well as fastening of seat belts  
should be done before the vehicle is put into motion.  
A child’s risk of serious or fatal injuries is  
significantly increased if the child restraints are  
not properly secured in the vehicle and the child is  
not properly secured in the child restraint.  
Memory function  
113  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
114  
Car care  
Index  
Instrument cluster  
Instrument cluster  
P54.30-3528-29  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
1 Knob for instrument cluster illumination,  
12 Multifunction display, see page 120  
see page 116  
Instrument cluster display, see page 297  
2 Engine malfunction indicator lamp, see page 290  
13 Trip odometer, see page 119 and 124  
3 Brake fluid low or parking brake engaged,  
14 Main odometer, see page 124  
see page 301  
15 Right turn signal indicator lamp, see combination  
4 Supplemental restraint system (SRS) malfunction  
switch on page 160  
indicator lamp, see page 293  
16 Tachometer, see page 119  
5 Coolant temperature gauge, see page 117  
17 Gear range indicator display, see selector lever  
6 Outside temperature indicator, see page 117  
7 Fuel gauge with reserve warning lamp, see page 293  
positions on page 232  
18 Digital clock  
To set the time, see COMAND operator’s manual  
8 Left turn signal indicator lamp, see combination  
switch on page 160  
19 Antilock brake system (ABS) malfunction indicator  
lamp, see page 294  
9 Speedometer, see page 118  
20 High beam headlamp indicator,  
see exterior lamp switch, page 156, and  
combination switch, page 160  
10 Electronic stability program (ESP) warning lamp,  
system is adjusting to road conditions, see page 295  
11 Distance warning lamp – vehicles with Distronic  
(DTR), distance to the vehicle ahead is insufficient,  
see page 264 and page 295.  
21 Fasten seat belts, see page 296  
22 Reset button J, see pages 116, 119  
Opening the door1.  
Activating the instrument cluster display  
Pressing button J on the instrument cluster1.  
The instrument cluster is activated by:  
Instrument cluster  
115  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
   
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
116  
Car care  
Index  
Instrument cluster  
Turning the electronic key in starter switch to  
Display illumination, changing basic settings for driving  
at dusk or in darkness:  
position 1 or 2.  
Press adjusting knob (1) – the knob will pop out.  
Switching on the exterior lamps.  
Rotate adjusting knob (1) clockwise – instrument lamp  
intensity increases.  
1
The instrument cluster is activated for approx. 30 seconds.  
Rotate adjusting knob (1) counterclockwise –  
instrument lamp intensity decreases.  
Instrument cluster illumination  
Push knob back into panel.  
The instrument cluster illumination is dimmed or  
brightened automatically to suit daylight lighting  
conditions.  
Note:  
It is not possible to select a basic brightness setting in  
daylight – the intensity is adjusted automatically.  
The instrument cluster illumination will also be  
adjusted when the vehicle’s exterior lamps are  
switched on.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Coolant temperature gauge (5)  
Outside temperature indicator (6)  
Warning!  
During severe operating conditions and stop-and-go city  
traffic, the coolant temperature may rise close to the red  
marking.  
The outside temperature indicator is not designed  
to serve as an Ice-Warning Device and is therefore  
unsuitable for that purpose. Indicated  
temperatures just above the freezing point do not  
guarantee that the road surface is free of ice.  
The engine should not be operated with the coolant  
temperature in the red zone. Doing so may cause  
serious engine damage which is not covered by the  
Mercedes-Benz Limited Warranty.  
The temperature sensor is located in the front bumper  
area. Due to its location, the sensor can be affected by  
road or engine heat during idling or slow driving. This  
means that the accuracy of the displayed temperature  
can only be verified by comparison to a thermometer  
placed next to the sensor, not by comparison to external  
displays (e.g. bank signs etc.).  
Warning!  
• Driving when your engine is badly overheated  
can cause some fluids which may have leaked  
into the engine compartment to catch fire. You  
could be seriously burned.  
• Steam from an overheated engine can cause  
serious burns and can occur just by opening  
the engine hood. Stay away from the engine if  
you see or hear steam coming from it. Turn off  
the engine, get out of the vehicle and do not  
stand near the vehicle until it cools down.  
Adaption to ambient temperature takes place in steps  
and depends on the prevailing driving conditions (stop-  
and-go or moderate, constant driving) and amount of  
temperature change.  
Note:  
The temperature indicator display can be set to read out  
in either Fahrenheit or Celsius. See page 140.  
Instrument cluster  
117  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
       
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
118  
Car care  
Index  
Instrument cluster  
Speedometer (9)  
Note:  
When the cruise control is activated, the segments on  
the speedometer scale between the set speed to the top  
of the scale are illuminated. Cruise control, see  
page 250.  
The speed display is set to read out for  
USA in mph  
Canada in km/h.  
When the Distronic (DTR) is activated, one or two  
segments around the speed stored in memory light up  
in the speedometer dial. Distronic (DTR), see page 253.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Trip odometer (13)  
Tachometer (16)  
To reset to “0” miles/km:  
The red marking on the tachometer denotes excessive  
engine speed.  
Activate the instrument cluster if it is not already  
activated by pressing the J button on the instrument  
cluster.  
Avoid this engine speed, as it may result in serious  
engine damage that is not covered by the  
Mercedes-Benz Limited Warranty.  
Press button è or ÿ on the multifunction  
steering wheel repeatedly until the trip odometer  
appears if it is not displayed. See page 124.  
To help protect the engine, the fuel supply is interrupted  
if the engine is operated within the red marking.  
Press button J on the instrument cluster.  
Instrument cluster  
119  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
       
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
120  
Car care  
Index  
Multifunction steering wheel, multifunction display  
Multifunction steering wheel, multifunction display  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Depending on your vehicle’s equipment, you may use  
the buttons on the multifunction steering wheel to call  
up, control and set the following systems in the  
multifunction display:  
4 Navigation system, see page 132  
5 Distronic (DTR), see page 253  
6 Trip computer, see page 134  
After start  
After reset  
Fuel tank content  
1 Trip odometer and main odometer, see page 119 and  
page 124  
Flexible service system (FSS), see page 147  
Tire inflation pressure monitor, see page 150  
Engine oil level indicator, see page 154  
7 Malfunction message memory, see page 136  
8 Individual settings, see page 138  
2 Audio systems, see page 125  
Press the è or ÿ button repeatedly until the  
required system is displayed.  
Radio, see page 125  
CD player, see page 126  
Cassette player, see page 127  
The display advances by one system each time the  
button is pressed.  
3 Telephone, see page 128  
You may call up additional displays within some of these  
categories by pressing the j or k button.  
Multifunction steering wheel, multifunction display  
121  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
122  
Car care  
Index  
Multifunction steering wheel, multifunction display  
Warning!  
Note:  
The displays in the multifunction display can be set to  
German, English, French, Italian or Spanish language.  
See the “TEXT” individual setting on page 140 for  
instructions on changing the language setting.  
A driver’s attention to the road must always be his/  
her primary focus when driving.  
For your safety and the safety of others, selecting  
features through the multifunction steering wheel  
should only be done by the driver when traffic and  
road conditions permit it to be done safely.  
Programming individual settings in the system can  
only be made while the vehicle is at standstill.  
The displays for the audio systems (radio, CD player,  
cassette player) will appear in English, regardless of the  
language selected.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Turn the electronic key in starter switch to position 1  
or 2.  
1
Press button:  
4 j for next display in system  
5 k for previous display in system  
6 è for next system  
2
7 ÿ for previous system  
8
8 æ to increase the volume, see page 146  
9 ç to decrease the volume, see page 146  
10 í to dial a telephone number, see page 128  
11 ì to end a call  
4
5
9
3
6
10  
7
11  
See page 128 for telephone and page 131 for  
instructions on answering an incoming call.  
Press the è or ÿ button repeatedly until the  
P46.10-2100-27  
required system is displayed.  
1 Multifunction steering wheel  
2 Multifunction display  
3 Horn pad  
The display advances by one system each time the  
button is pressed.  
You may call up additional displays in some systems by  
pressing the j or k button.  
Multifunction steering wheel, multifunction display  
123  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
124  
Car care  
Index  
Multifunction steering wheel, multifunction display  
Trip and main odometer, FSS, tire inflation pressure  
monitor and engine oil level indicator  
1 Trip odometer and main odometer  
See page 119 for instructions on resetting the trip  
odometer.  
2 FSS (Flexible service system), see page 147  
3 Tire inflation pressure monitor, see page 150  
4 Engine oil level indicator, see page 154  
Press è or ÿ button repeatedly until the trip  
odometer and main odometer display (1) appears.  
Press the j or k button repeatedly until the  
required display (2, 3, 4, 1) appears.  
Pressing the è or ÿ button displays the next or  
previous system.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Audio systems  
Radio  
1 Audio system is switched off.  
2 The radio is switched on.  
3 Wave band setting and memory location number,  
where appropriate.  
4 Station name setting or station frequency.  
5 This only appears when “MEMORY” rather than  
“FREQUENCY” has been selected in the Individual  
settings “VEHICLE”. See page 144.  
Switch on the radio, see COMAND operator’s manual.  
Press the è or ÿ button repeatedly until  
display (2) appears.  
Press button j or k repeatedly until the required  
station or frequency is displayed.  
Use the j of k button to select a stored station or  
station frequency. This depends on the selection made  
in the “STATION SEARCH USING” setting menu.  
See individual settings, page 138.  
Pressing the è or ÿ button displays the next or  
previous system.  
P54.30-2936-27  
Multifunction steering wheel, multifunction display  
125  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
       
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
126  
Car care  
Index  
Multifunction steering wheel, multifunction display  
CD player  
1 Audio system is switched off.  
2 The CD player is switched on.  
3 The number of the CD currently playing is displayed  
if you are using a CD changer.  
4 Track number.  
Switch on the CD player, see COMAND operator’s  
manual.  
Press the è or ÿ button repeatedly until  
display (2) appears.  
Press the j or k button repeatedly until the  
required track number (4) is displayed.  
Pressing the è or ÿ button displays the next or  
previous system.  
Note:  
To select a CD from the magazine, press a number on  
the COMAND system key pad located in the center  
dashboard.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Cassette player  
1 Audio system is switched off.  
2 The cassette player is switched on.  
3 Side being played.  
Switch on the cassette player, see COMAND operator’s  
manual.  
Press the è or ÿ button repeatedly until  
display (2) appears.  
Pressing the j button fast forwards on to the next  
track.  
Pressing the k button rewinds the cassette to the  
beginning of the current track.  
Pressing the è or ÿ button displays the next or  
previous system.  
Notes:  
To select the reverse side of the tape, enter request on  
the COMAND system located in the center dashboard.  
To eject the inserted tape, press “EJT” on the COMAND  
system located in the center dashboard.  
Multifunction steering wheel, multifunction display  
127  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
   
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
128  
Car care  
Index  
Multifunction steering wheel, multifunction display  
Telephone  
1 The telephone is switched off.  
Telephone book  
2 The vehicle is currently outside the transmitter or  
receiver range.  
3 The telephone is ready for use.  
4 Name selected from the telephone book.  
5 Number for the name selected. Dialing commences.  
6 Dialing is completed. The name is displayed. The  
display remains for the duration of the call.  
7 Memory location number.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
The telephone must be switched on.  
Press the í button when the name you require  
appears in the display (4). The telephone number (5) is  
dialed.  
Press the è or ÿ button repeatedly until the  
display (3) appears. See the separate telephone  
instructions manual.  
The name will be displayed when dialing is completed.  
Display (6) remains for the duration of the call.  
If display (2) appears, no service is available.  
Pressing the ì button hangs up and display (3)  
appears.  
Pressing j or k “browses” alphabetically  
forwards or backwards through the telephone book,  
providing it was previously downloaded. See telephone  
operator’s manual for details concerning downloading.  
Pressing button j or k for longer than a second  
“browses” rapidly through the telephone book. The  
name selected appears in the display.  
Pressing the è or ÿ button displays the next or  
previous system.  
Note:  
Press the ì button if you do not wish to make a call.  
The procedure is cancelled and display (3) appears.  
Multifunction steering wheel, multifunction display  
129  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
130  
Car care  
Index  
Multifunction steering wheel, multifunction display  
Redialing  
1 The telephone is ready for use.  
2 Number or name stored in the redial memory.  
3 Number in the redial memory — redialing has  
commenced.  
4 Dialing is completed and the name stored in the  
telephone book is displayed or the number dialed  
will remain displayed if no name has been stored.  
The display remains for the duration of the call.  
5 Memory location numbers — the 10 most recently  
dialed numbers are stored.  
L0, most recently dialed number,  
L1 to L9, previously dialed numbers.  
P54.30-2899-27  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
The telephone must be switched on.  
Incoming call  
Press the è or ÿ button repeatedly until the  
display (1) appears.  
Pressing the í button activates the redial memory  
and the most recently dialed number is displayed.  
Pressing the j or k button “browses” forward or  
backwards through the redial memory. The number  
selected appears in the display.  
Note:  
The telephone must be switched on.  
Press the ì button if you do not wish to make a call.  
The procedure is cancelled and display (1) appears.  
1 “CALL” — you are being called.  
Press the í button to answer the call.  
Press the í button when the required number or  
name appears in the display (2).  
The telephone number (3) is dialed.  
Press the ì button to hang up or if you do not wish  
to answer the incoming call.  
Once dialing is completed the name (4) is displayed if  
the name is stored in the telephone book; failing that  
the number dialed will remain displayed. The display  
remains for the duration of the call.  
Pressing the ì button hangs up and display (1)  
appears.  
Pressing the è or ÿ button displays the next or  
previous system.  
Multifunction steering wheel, multifunction display  
131  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
   
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
132  
Car care  
Index  
Multifunction steering wheel, multifunction display  
Navigation system  
1 The navigation system is switched off.  
2 The navigation system is switched on but no  
destination has been specified.  
3 The navigation system is switched on and  
destination guidance is active.  
Press the è or ÿ button repeatedly until the  
required system is displayed.  
See the separate COMAND (Cockpit Management and  
Data System) instruction manual for notes on the  
navigation system.  
Pressing the è or ÿ button displays the next or  
previous system.  
P54.30-2985-27  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Distronic (DTR)  
1 Distronic (DTR) is deactivated. The actual  
distance (4) and the should-be distance (5) to the  
vehicle in front (3) are displayed.  
2 Distronic (DTR) is activated.  
The message “DTR OFF” appears for five seconds  
when Distronic is being deactivated.  
3 Vehicle ahead. Only appears if a vehicle is detected  
ahead.  
4 Actual distance to vehicle ahead.  
5 Should-be distance to vehicle ahead.  
6 Own vehicle.  
Press the è or ÿ button repeatedly until the  
required system is displayed.  
Distronic (DTR), see page 253.  
Pressing the è or ÿ button displays the next or  
previous system.  
Multifunction steering wheel, multifunction display  
133  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
 
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
134  
Car care  
Index  
Multifunction steering wheel, multifunction display  
Trip computer  
1 “AFTER START” — short distance memory  
2 “AFTER RESET” — long distance memory  
3 Fuel tank contents and estimated range remaining  
4 Distance covered “AFTER START” or  
“AFTER RESET”  
5 Elapsed time “AFTER START” or “AFTER RESET”  
6 Average speed “AFTER START” or “AFTER RESET”  
7 Average fuel consumption “AFTER START” or  
“AFTER RESET”  
Press the button è or ÿ repeatedly until the  
display (1, 2 or 3) appears.  
Press the j or k button until the “AFTER START”  
short distance memory (1), the “AFTER RESET” long  
distance memory (2) or fuel tank contents and  
estimated range remaining indicator (3) appears.  
Pressing the è or ÿ button displays the next or  
previous system.  
Note:  
The most recently selected display (1, 2 or 3) always  
appears the next time the trip computer is called up.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Transferring values from the previous journey to the  
“AFTER START” short distance memory (1):  
To reset the short “AFTER START” (1) or long  
“AFTER RESET” distance memory (2):  
The “AFTER START” display will flash until a distance of  
approximately 1 mile (1.6 km) has been covered or two  
minutes have elapsed since the engine was restarted.  
During this period you can incorporate the values for  
the previous journey by pressing button J in the  
instrument cluster.  
Call up the relevant display (1 or 2) using the j or  
k button and press the J button in the  
instrument cluster until the values are reset to “0”.  
Multifunction steering wheel, multifunction display  
135  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
136  
Car care  
Index  
Multifunction steering wheel, multifunction display  
Malfunction/warning message memory  
Press the è or ÿ button repeatedly until the  
message memory (1 or 2) is displayed.  
Press the j or k button if display (2) appears.  
The stored messages will now be displayed in order.  
See page 297 for malfunction and warning messages.  
Display (2) will reappear after you have scanned all the  
malfunction and warning messages.  
Should any malfunction or warning messages be stored  
while driving, they will reappear in the display (2) when  
the electronic key is in starter switch position 0 or  
removed from the starter switch.  
The malfunction or warning messages will now be  
displayed for approximately 5 seconds each. Pressing  
the J button in the instrument cluster displays the  
next malfunction and warning message immediately.  
1 There are no messages stored in the system.  
2 Number of messages stored in the system.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
The message memory will be cleared when the  
electronic key is turned in the starter switch to  
position 1 or 2. Should any subsequent faults occur,  
they will be displayed in the message memory.  
Important!  
Malfunction and warning messages are only indicated  
for certain systems and displayed to a low level of detail.  
The malfunction and warning messages are simply a  
reminder with respect to the operation of certain  
systems and do not replace the driver’s responsibility to  
maintain the vehicle’s operating safety by having all  
required maintenance and safety checks performed on  
the vehicle and by bringing the vehicle to an authorized  
Mercedes-Benz Center to address the malfunction and  
warning messages. See page 297.  
Pressing the è or ÿ button displays the next or  
previous system.  
Multifunction steering wheel, multifunction display  
137  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
138  
Car care  
Index  
Multifunction steering wheel, multifunction display  
Individual settings  
1 Preliminary display of the individual settings.  
2 “SETTINGS” – the requested menu can be called up  
in this options menu:  
“INSTRUMENT CLUSTER”, see page 140.  
“LIGHTING”, see page 142.  
“VEHICLE”, see page 144.  
R
R
These three menus contain additional submenus.  
Individual settings can be selected in these  
submenus.  
3 Selection marker  
Pressing button æ or ç on the multifunction  
steering wheel controls the selection marker.  
4 See below for instructions on returning the setting  
menus to the factory settings.  
5 Acknowledgment  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Press the è or ÿ button repeatedly until the  
individual setting preliminary display (1) appears.  
To return menu “SETTINGS” (2) to its factory  
setting:  
Press the j or k button until the setting menu  
“SETTINGS” (2) is displayed.  
Call up the individual setting preliminary  
display (1).  
Pressing the æ or ç button controls the selection  
marker (3) in setting menu (2).  
Press the J button in the instrument cluster for  
approximately 3 seconds. Display (4) will appear.  
“INSTRUMENT CLUSTER”, see page 140.  
“HEADLAMP MODE”, see page 142.  
“VEHICLE”, see page 144.  
Press the J Button once more. The menu  
“SETTINGS” is reset to factory settings,  
acknowledged by display (5).  
The individual setting preliminary display (1) will  
appear if you do not press the J button within  
about 5 seconds. The setting menus will not be  
reset.  
Pressing the è or ÿ button displays the next or  
previous system.  
Notes:  
These settings may only be performed with the vehicle  
at standstill and with the electronic key in starter switch  
position 1 or 2.  
The individual setting preliminary display (1) will  
appear if you speed up.  
The setting menu previously called up will reappear  
when the vehicle stops, providing no other system has  
been called up in the meantime.  
Multifunction steering wheel, multifunction display  
139  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
140  
Car care  
Index  
Multifunction steering wheel, multifunction display  
“INSTRUMENT CLUSTER”  
3
R
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
1 Preliminary display of the individual settings  
Press button æ or ç until the menu  
“INSTRUMENT CLUSTER” is selected by the selection  
marker (3).  
2 “SETTINGS” – the menu “INSTRUMENT CLUSTER”  
can be called up in this option menu.  
Press the j or k button until the required  
display (4 to 6) is displayed. Pressing the æ or ç  
button controls the selection marker. The settings made  
are stored and applied immediately.  
3 Selection marker  
Pressing button æ or ç on the multifunction  
steering wheel controls the selection marker.  
4 “TEMP. INDICATOR” – the unit set is displayed in  
the outside temperature display, in the instrument  
cluster and in the automatic air conditioner display.  
The individual setting preliminary display (1) will  
appear again after you have run through all the setting  
menus. Pressing the è or ÿ button displays the  
next or previous system.  
5 “SPEEDOMETER” – the unit set is displayed in the  
multifunction display  
To return menu “INSTRUMENT CLUSTER” (4 to 6) to  
its factory setting:  
For setting clock, see separate COMAND  
operator’s manual.  
Call up menu (4 to 6).  
6 “TEXT” – sets the language used in the  
multifunction display  
Press the J button in the instrument cluster for  
approximately 3 seconds. Display (7) will appear.  
7 Returning the setting menu “INSTRUMENT  
CLUSTER” to the factory setting.  
Press the J button once more. The menu  
“INSTR. CLUSTER” is reset to factory settings,  
acknowledged by display (8).  
8 Acknowledgment  
Press the è or ÿ button repeatedly until the  
individual setting preliminary display (1) appears.  
The individual setting display “SETTINGS” (2) will  
appear if you do not press the J button within  
about 5 seconds. The setting menus will not be  
reset.  
Press the j or k button until the setting menu  
“SETTINGS” (2) is displayed.  
Multifunction steering wheel, multifunction display  
141  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
142  
Car care  
Index  
Multifunction steering wheel, multifunction display  
“LIGHTING”  
R
7
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
1 Preliminary display of the individual settings  
Press button æ or ç until the menu “LIGHTING”  
is selected by the selection marker (3).  
2 “SETTINGS” – the menu “LIGHTING” can be called  
Press the j or k button until the required  
display (4 to 7) is displayed. Pressing the æ or ç  
button controls the selection marker. The settings made  
are stored and applied immediately.  
up in this option menu.  
3 Selection marker  
Pressing button æ or ç on the multifunction  
steering wheel controls the selection marker.  
The individual setting preliminary display (1) will  
appear again after you have run through all the setting  
menus. Pressing the è or ÿ button displays the  
next or previous system.  
4 “LIGHT CIRCUIT HEADLAMP MODE”1, see  
page 157.  
5 “LOCATOR LIGHTING”, see page 159.  
6 “HEADLAMPS DELAYED SWITCH-OFF”, see “Night  
To return menu “LIGHTING” (4 to 7) to its factory  
setting:  
security illumination” on page 158.  
7 “INT. ILLUMINATION DELAYED SWITCH-OFF”, see  
Call up menu (4 to 7).  
“Interior lighting” on page 184.  
Press the J button in the instrument cluster for  
8 Returning the setting menu “LIGHTING” to the  
approximately 3 seconds. Display (8) will appear.  
factory setting.  
Press the J button once more. The menu  
“LIGHTING” is reset to factory settings,  
acknowledged by display (9).  
9 Acknowledgment  
1
Except Canada  
The individual setting display “SETTINGS” (2) will  
appear if you do not press the J button within  
about 5 seconds. The setting menus will not be  
reset.  
Press the è or ÿ button repeatedly until the  
individual setting preliminary display (1) appears.  
Press the j or k button until the setting menu  
“SETTINGS” (2) is displayed.  
Multifunction steering wheel, multifunction display  
143  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
144  
Car care  
Index  
Multifunction steering wheel, multifunction display  
“VEHICLE” (audio and central locking system)  
R
5
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
1 Preliminary display of the individual settings  
Press button æ or ç until the menu “VEHICLE” is  
selected by the selection marker (3).  
2 “SETTINGS” – the menu “VEHICLE” can be called  
Press the j or k button until the required  
display (4 or 5) is displayed. Pressing the æ or ç  
button controls the selection marker. The settings made  
are stored and applied immediately.  
up in this option menu.  
3 Selection marker  
Pressing button æ or ç on the multifunction  
steering wheel controls the selection marker.  
The individual setting preliminary display (1) will  
appear again after you have run through all the setting  
menus. Pressing the è or ÿ button displays the  
next or previous system.  
4 “STATION SEARCH USING”  
– radio adjustment “FREQUENCY”: use the j  
or k button to select a frequency.  
– radio adjustment “MEMORY”: use the j  
or k button to select a stored station (preset  
memory).  
To return menu “VEHICLE” (4 and 5) to its factory  
setting:  
5 “AUTOMATIC DOOR LOCK”, see automatic central  
Call up menu (4 or 5).  
locking on page 52.  
Press the J button in the instrument cluster for  
6 Returning the setting menu “VEHICLE” to the  
approximately 3 seconds. Display (6) will appear.  
factory setting.  
Press the J button once more. The menu  
“VEHICLE” is reset to factory settings,  
acknowledged by display (7).  
7 Acknowledgment  
Press the è or ÿ button repeatedly until the  
The individual setting display “SETTINGS” (2) will  
appear if you do not press the J button within  
about 5 seconds. The setting menus will not be  
reset.  
individual setting preliminary display (1) appears.  
Press the j or k button until the setting menu  
“SETTINGS” (2) is displayed.  
Multifunction steering wheel, multifunction display  
145  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
146  
Car care  
Index  
Multifunction steering wheel, multifunction display  
Setting the audio volume  
Setting button:  
You can only adjust the volume of the system currently  
in use. The volume setting for each system (audio,  
telephone, navigation and voice recognition system) is  
stored separately.  
æ increases the volume.  
ç reduces the volume.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Flexible service system (FSS)  
(service indicator)  
The message is displayed for approx. 10 seconds when  
turning the electronic key in starter switch to position 2,  
or while driving when reaching the service warning  
threshold.  
The symbols and messages indicate the type of service  
to be performed:  
9 Service A  
½ Service B  
One of the following messages will appear in the display  
(e.g. Service A):  
“SERVICE A – IN xx DAYS”  
“SERVICE A – IN xx MILES” (Canada: KM)  
“SERVICE A – EXCEEDED BY xx DAYS”  
“SERVICE A – EXCEEDED BY xx MILES” (Canada: KM)  
“SERVICE A – PERFORM SERVICE”  
P54.30-2768-26  
The FSS permits a flexible service schedule that is  
directly related to the operating conditions of the  
vehicle.  
The next service due date is displayed either in days or  
in miles, depending on your driving style.  
The symbol 9 or ½ appears together with a  
message in the multifunction indicator prior to the next  
suggested service. Depending on operating conditions  
throughout the year, the next service is calculated and  
displayed in days or distance remaining.  
Once the suggested service term has passed, the symbol  
and message appear for approx. 30 seconds and a signal  
sounds every time when turning the electronic key in  
starter switch to position 2.  
Flexible service system  
147  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
   
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
148  
Car care  
Index  
Flexible service system  
The service indicator disappears automatically after  
30 seconds or if button J on the instrument cluster  
is pressed.  
Note:  
When disconnecting vehicle battery for one or more  
days at a time, such days will not be counted. Any such  
days not counted by the FSS can be added by your  
Mercedes-Benz Center.  
Calling up service indicator manually:  
Turn the electronic key in starter switch to position 1.  
The interval between services is determined by the type  
of driving for which the vehicle is used. For example,  
driving at extreme speeds, and cold starts combined  
with short distance driving in which the engine does not  
reach operating normal temperature, reduce the interval  
between services.  
Call up the trip odometer and main odometer by  
pressing button è or ÿ on the multifunction  
steering wheel until the display appears. See page 124.  
Press button j or k until the FSS indicator  
appears.  
The next or previous system is displayed by pressing  
button è or ÿ.  
Important!  
The FSS indicator is not an engine oil level indicator.  
See page 154 for engine oil level indicator.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Following a completed A or B service the Mercedes-Benz  
Center sets the counter mileage to 10 000 miles  
(Canada: 15 000 km) and 365 days.  
The multifunction display will show the question:  
“DO YOU WANT TO RESET SERVICE INTERVAL? –  
CONFIRM BY PRESSING R”  
The counter can also be set by any individual. To do so:  
Turn the electronic key in starter switch to position 1.  
Press button J on the instrument cluster again to  
reset the service indicator.  
The new service indicator is displayed with the reset  
distance of 10 000 miles (Canada 15 000 km).  
To call up the trip odometer and main odometer, press  
button è or ÿ on the multifunction steering  
wheel until the display appears. See page 124.  
If the FSS counter was inadvertently reset, have a  
Mercedes-Benz Center correct it.  
Press button j or k until the FSS indicator  
appears.  
However you choose to set your reference numbers, the  
scheduled services as posted in the Service Booklet  
must be followed to properly care for your vehicle.  
Press button J on the instrument cluster for  
approximately 2 seconds.  
Flexible service system  
149  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
150  
Car care  
Index  
Tire inflation pressure monitor  
Tire inflation pressure monitor  
Inquiry of present tire inflation pressure  
The tire inflation pressure, as selected by the driver, is  
monitored in all four wheels on the ground. A warning  
is issued to the driver in the case of a decrease in the  
inflation pressure in one or more of the tires.  
Warning!  
The tire inflation pressure monitor does not  
indicate a warning for wrongly selected inflation  
pressures. Always adjust tire inflation pressure  
according to the label affixed on the fuel filler flap.  
See page 345 for tire inflation pressure.  
The tire inflation pressure monitor is not able to  
issue a warning due to a sudden loss of pressure  
(e.g. tire puncture caused by a foreign object). In  
this case bring vehicle to a halt by carefully  
applying the service brakes and avoiding abrupt  
steering maneuvers.  
Turn electronic key in starter switch to position 1 or 2.  
Press è or ÿ button on the multifunction  
steering wheel until the display for trip and main  
odometer appears, see page 124.  
Press the j or k button repeatedly until the tire  
inflation pressure monitor is displayed.  
The present tire inflation pressure for each wheel is  
displayed in multifunction display.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Notes:  
Activation of tire inflation pressure monitor  
Following a tire inflation pressure reactivation process  
the real tire inflation pressures are displayed only after  
a few minutes travel time.  
Activation of tire inflation pressure monitor is  
necessary if tire inflation pressure is being changed,  
wheels or tires are replaced, or new wheels are installed  
on the vehicle.  
Possible differences between readings of a tire pressure  
gauge of an air hose, e.g. gas station equipment, and the  
vehicle’s multifunction display can occur. The vehicle’s  
multifunction display of the tire inflation pressure  
monitor is a more precise reading.  
Tire inflation pressure should be checked and corrected  
according to the label affixed inside the fuel filler flap.  
For a detailed description, refer to page 345.  
Turn electronic key in starter switch to position 2 (the  
engine must not be running).  
Notes:  
When checking the tire inflation pressure of the road  
wheels, also check the spare tire.  
The tire inflation pressure of the spare wheel, mounted  
or not mounted, is not monitored by the tire inflation  
pressure monitor.  
See page 335 for location of the spare wheel, and  
page 345 for tire inflation pressure.  
Tire inflation pressure monitor  
151  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
 
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
152  
Car care  
Index  
Tire inflation pressure monitor  
Press and hold button J on the instrument cluster  
again until the message “TIRE PRESS. CONTROL –  
ACTIVATED!” appears.  
The tire inflation pressure monitor is now activated and  
monitors the presently selected tire pressure for all four  
wheels on the ground.  
Repeat above steps if the multifunction display shows  
the message “TIRE PRESS. CONTROL – REACTIVATE!”.  
A multifunction display showing the message  
“TIRE PRESSURE – CHECK TIRES!” indicates a much  
too low tire inflation pressure. Check and correct tire  
inflation pressure again on all wheels, and repeat the  
tire inflation pressure monitor activation steps listed  
above.  
Press è or ÿ button on the multifunction  
steering wheel until the display for trip and main  
odometer appears, see page 124.  
Press the j or k button repeatedly until the tire  
inflation pressure monitor appears.  
Press and hold button J on the instrument cluster  
until the message “MONITOR CURRENT TIRE  
PRESSURES?” appears. Release button J.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Notes:  
Transporting a deflated road wheel in the vehicle, e.g.  
after having a flat, the tire inflation pressure monitor  
should only be activated once the flat tire and rim are  
removed from the vehicle. Otherwise the monitor  
displays the message “TIRE PRESS. CONTROL –  
CURRENTLY INACTIVE”.  
To ensure proper functioning of the tire inflation  
pressure monitor, the tire inflation pressure should be  
checked and corrected according to the label affixed  
inside the fuel filler flap. For a detailed description,  
refer to page 345.  
To prevent possible damage to the electronic sensors,  
have tire changes only performed at an authorized  
Mercedes-Benz Center.  
The message “TIRE PRESS. CONTROL – REACTIVATE”  
appears if the tire inflation pressure shows an increase  
of 4.4 psi (0.3 bar) or more. Reactivate the tire inflation  
pressure monitor.  
For malfunction and warning messages, see page 312.  
The tire inflation pressure monitor only functions on  
wheels equipped with the proper electronic sensors.  
Inquire at your authorized Mercedes-Benz Center about  
retrofitting other than original Mercedes-Benz wheels  
with electronic sensors.  
Tire inflation pressure monitor  
153  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
154  
Car care  
Index  
Engine oil level indicator  
Engine oil level indicator  
with engine not at operational temperature up to  
approx. 30 minutes.  
The engine oil level check can be repeated after a short  
time.  
Turn the electronic key in starter switch to position 2.  
To call up the trip odometer and main odometer, press  
button è or ÿ on the multifunction steering  
wheel until the display appears. See page 124.  
Press button j or k on the multifunction  
steering wheel repeatedly until the “WHEN  
MEASURING – CAR MUST BE LEVEL” engine oil level  
indicator appears. This indicator is only a reminder.  
Measurement can be cancelled by pressing button j  
or k if the vehicle is not parked on level ground. An  
incorrect reading will be recorded if you do not cancel  
the measurement. Move the vehicle to level ground and  
measure again.  
To check the engine oil level, park vehicle on level  
ground, with engine at normal operational temperature.  
Check oil level approximately 5 minutes after stopping  
the engine, allowing for the oil to return to the oil pan.  
The electronic key in starter switch is not in position 2 if  
the “ENGINE OIL LEVEL – SWITCH ON IGNITION”  
message appears.  
The message “PERF. SERV. ON TIME” (perform service  
[engine oil level check] on time) will be displayed if the  
required waiting period has not been observed after  
stopping the engine:  
The “ENGINE OIL LEVEL – MEASURING NOW”  
message is displayed after approximately 3 seconds.  
with engine at operational temperature approx.  
5 minutes.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
One of the following messages will subsequently appear  
on the indicator:  
CL 500 and CL 55 AMG only:  
Perform the engine oil level check with the dipstick, if it  
cannot be completed via the multifunction display.  
See “Checking engine oil level”, page 331.  
In this case we recommend that you have the system  
checked at a Mercedes-Benz Center.  
“ENGINE OIL LEVEL – O.K.”  
No oil needs to be added.  
“ENGINE OIL LEVEL – ADD 1.0 QUART”  
(Canada: 1.0 L)  
Notes:  
“ENGINE OIL LEVEL – ADD 1.5 QUART”  
(Canada: 1.5 L)  
See malfunction and warning messages on page 297  
and page 314 if an engine oil level indicator appears on  
the multifunction display when the engine is running.  
“ENGINE OIL LEVEL – ADD 2.0 QUART”  
(Canada: 2.0 L)  
The engine oil level cannot be checked while the engine  
is running. The “ENGINE OIL LEVEL – NOT WHEN  
ENGINE ON” message will appear.  
See “Checking engine oil level”, on page 331 for  
instructions on adding engine oil.  
“ENGINE OIL LEVEL – REDUCE OIL LEVEL”  
Do not overfill the engine.  
Excessive oil must be siphoned or drained off. It could  
cause damage to the engine and catalytic converter not  
covered by the Mercedes-Benz Limited Warranty.  
Engine oil consumption  
Engine oil consumption checks should only be made  
after the break-in period. During the break-in period,  
higher oil consumption may be noticed and is normal.  
Frequent driving at high engine speeds results in  
increased consumption.  
The “MEASURING NOT POSSIBLE” message will be  
displayed if a proper oil level check cannot be  
performed. The engine oil level check can be repeated  
after a short while.  
Engine oil level indicator  
155  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
 
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
156  
Car care  
Index  
Exterior lamp switch  
Exterior lamp switch  
ˆ Standing lamps, right (turn left one stop)  
Standing lamps, left (turn left two stops)  
Front fog lamps (pull out one stop) with parking  
lamps and/or low beam headlamps on. Green  
indicator in lamp switch comes on.  
Rear fog lamp (pull out to second detent) in  
addition to the front fog lamps. Yellow indicator in  
lamp switch comes on.  
Note:  
With the electronic key removed and the driver’s door  
open, a warning sounds if the vehicle’s exterior lamps  
(except standing lamps) are not switched off.  
P54.25-2390-26  
Fog lamps will operate with the parking lamps and/or  
the low beam headlamps on. Fog lamps should only be  
used in conjunction with low beam headlamps. Consult  
your State or Province Motor Vehicle Regulations  
regarding allowable lamp operation.  
M Off  
U Automatic headlamp mode, see below.  
C Parking lamps (also side marker lamps, taillamps,  
licence plate lamps, instrument panel lamps)  
Canada only: When the engine is running, the low  
beam is additionally switched on.  
Fog lamps are automatically switched off when the  
exterior lamp switch is turned to position M or U.  
B Parking lamps plus low beam or high beam  
headlamps (combination switch pushed forward).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Headlamp mode (HEADLAMPS)  
Automatic operation:  
(USA only)  
With electronic key in starter switch in position 1 turn  
The headlamps can be switched on and off manually or  
automatically, or switched to daytime running lamp  
mode.  
exterior lamp switch to position U.  
The parking lamps switch on and off automatically  
depending on the brightness of the ambient light.  
Manual operation:  
With the engine running and exterior lamp switch in  
position U:  
The low beam headlamps, parking lamps and license  
plate lamps can be switched on and off with the exterior  
lamp switch. For exterior lamp switch, see above.  
The low beam headlamps, parking lamps and license  
plate lamps are switched on and off automatically  
depending on the brightness of the ambient light.  
Warning!  
The low beam headlamps, parking lamps and license  
plate lamps can still be switched on and off manually  
using the exterior lamp switch.  
The driver is responsible for the operation of the  
vehicle’s lights at all times. The automatic  
headlamp feature is only an aid to the driver.  
Switch on the vehicle lights by hand when driving  
or traffic conditions require you to do so.  
Note:  
The headlamps will not be automatically switched on  
under foggy conditions.  
Exterior lamp switch  
157  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
   
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
158  
Car care  
Index  
Exterior lamp switch  
Daytime running lamp mode  
Night security illumination  
Turn exterior lamp switch to position M.  
When turning off the engine, the exterior lamps switch  
on for added illumination, if they were previously  
switched on (except in daytime running mode). After  
the last door has been closed the lamp-on time period  
commences.  
When the engine is running, the low beam headlamps  
(includes parking lamps and license plate lamps) are  
automatically switched on.  
Canada only:  
The lamp-on time period for night security illumination  
can be set at several different timed levels from 0 (off) to  
60 seconds.  
When shifting from a driving position to position “N”  
or “P”, the low beam switches off (3 minutes delay).  
For nighttime driving the exterior lamp switch should  
be turned to position B to permit activation of the  
high beam headlamps.  
Notes:  
Within 10 minutes after closing the last door the night  
security illumination can be reactivated by opening a  
door.  
USA only:  
The high beam headlamps can also be activated when  
driving with the daytime running lamp mode activated  
and exterior lamp switch in position M.  
See “Individual settings” – “LIGHTING” on page 142 for  
instructions on how to activate the function.  
See page 156 for notes on the exterior lamp switch.  
Deactivating night security illumination temporarily:  
To activate the daytime running lamp mode, see  
“Individual settings” – “LIGHTING” on page 142.  
Turn the electronic key in starter switch to position 0  
then to position 2 and back to position 0 again before  
getting out of the vehicle. The night security  
illumination will not be activated when the door is  
opened.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Locator lighting  
Headlamp cleaning system  
After unlocking the vehicle with the electronic main key  
during darkness, the fog lamps, parking lamps,  
taillamps and license plate lamps switch on for a  
approx. 40 seconds.  
The exterior lamps will be switched off when opening  
the driver’s door.  
See “Individual settings” – “LIGHTING” on page 142 for  
instructions on how to activate the function.  
1
P54.25-2391-26  
Turn the electronic key in starter switch to position 1  
or 2.  
The headlamps will be cleaned with a high-pressure  
water jet when you press the headlamp washer  
button (1).  
See page 334 for instructions on filling up the  
windshield/headlamp washer reservoir.  
Exterior lamp switch  
159  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
   
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
160  
Car care  
Index  
Combination switch  
Combination switch  
3 High beam flasher (high beam available  
independent of exterior lamp switch position)  
4
4 Turn signals, right  
4
5 Turn signals, left  
To signal minor directional changes, such as changing  
lanes on a highway, move combination switch briefly to  
the point of resistance only and release. The turn  
signals blink three times.  
2
1
3
To operate the turn signals continuously, move the  
combination switch past the point of resistance (up or  
down). The switch is automatically canceled when the  
steering wheel is turned to a large enough degree.  
5
5
P54.25-2388-26  
Turn signal failure  
1 Low beam  
(exterior lamp switch position B)  
If one of the turn signals fails, the turn signal indicator  
system flashes and sounds at a faster than normal rate.  
2 High beam  
(exterior lamp switch position B)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
0
I
Off  
Intermittent wiping  
7
One initial wipe, pauses between wipes are  
automatically controlled by a rain sensor  
monitoring the wetness of the windshield. This  
will not occur with a front door open.  
Notes:  
With switch in this position, one wipe occurs  
when turning the electronic key in starter switch  
from position 0. This will not occur with a front  
door open.  
6
P54.25-2389-26  
Do not leave in intermittent setting when vehicle  
is taken to an automatic car wash or during  
windshield cleaning. Wipers will operate in  
presence of water spray at windshield, and  
wipers may be damaged as a result.  
6 Press switch briefly:  
Single wipe without washer fluid  
(select only if windshield is wet).  
Push switch past resistance point:  
Windshield washer system, windshield wipers.  
II Normal wiper speed  
III Fast wiper speed  
See page 334 for instructions on filling the  
windshield/headlamp washer reservoir.  
7 Windshield wipers  
Combination switch  
161  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
 
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
162  
Car care  
Index  
Combination switch  
Blocked windshield wipers  
Windshield wipers smear  
If the windshield wipers become blocked (for example,  
due to snow), switch off the wipers.  
If the windshield wipers smear the windshield, even  
during rain, activate the washer system as often as  
necessary. The fluid in the washer reservoir should be  
mixed in the correct ratio.  
For safety reasons before removing ice or snow, remove  
electronic key from starter switch. Remove blockage.  
See page 334 for instructions on filling up the  
windshield/headlamp washer reservoir.  
Activate combination switch again (electronic key in  
starter switch position 1).  
Windshield and headlamp washer fluid mixing ratio  
Emergency operation of windshield wipers  
For temperatures above freezing:  
MB windshield washer concentrate “S” and water.  
In case of windshield wiper malfunction in switch  
positions I or III, turn combination switch to wiper  
setting II. Have the system checked at your authorized  
Mercedes-Benz Center as soon as possible.  
1 part “S” to 100 parts water  
(40 ml “S” to 1 gallon water).  
For temperature below freezing:  
MB windshield washer concentrate “S” and  
commercially available premixed windshield washer  
solvent/antifreeze.  
1 part “S” to 100 parts solvent  
(40 ml “S” to 1 gallon solvent).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Hazard warning flasher switch  
Note:  
With the hazard warning flasher activated, the  
combination switch in position for either left or right  
turn, and the electronic key in starter switch position 1  
or 2, only the respective left or right side turn signals  
will operate.  
The hazard warning flasher can be activated either  
manually via the switch located in the dashboard, or it  
is activated automatically at the time an airbag is  
deployed.  
To activate hazard warning flasher, press switch once.  
To deactivate, press switch again.  
If hazard warning flasher was activated automatically,  
press switch twice to deactivate.  
Hazard warning flasher  
163  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
 
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
164  
Car care  
Index  
Automatic climate control  
Automatic climate control  
8
7
2
9
11  
6
10  
1
5
4
3
12  
P83.40-2266-29  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
1 Center air outlet, left, adjustable  
2 Fixed air outlet, left  
6 Center air outlet, right, adjustable  
7 Fixed air outlet, right  
3 Air volume control for left center air outlet  
To open: Turn the thumbwheel upward.  
8 Side defroster outlet, left and right, fixed  
9 Side air outlet, left and right, adjustable  
10 Air volume control for side air outlets  
To open: Turn thumbwheel outwards  
:  
The left center air outlet is fully open.  
■■: The left center and fixed air outlets are  
opened.  
:  
The side air outlet is fully opened.  
4 Air temperature control for center air outlets  
■■: The side and door air outlets are opened.  
11 Door air outlet, left and right  
To lower temperature: Turn thumbwheel towards  
the blue marking.  
12 Display and controls  
Automatic mode: Turn thumbwheel to position A.  
The indicator lamp above the thumbwheel will  
illuminate. The airflow and temperature for the  
center air outlets are regulated automatically.  
Note:  
We recommend that the sliders for the air  
outlets (1, 6, 9) be clicked to the automatic position to  
provide practically draft free ventilation.  
5 Air volume control for right center air outlet.  
To open: Turn the thumbwheel upward  
:  
The right center air outlet is fully open.  
■■: The right center and fixed air outlets are  
opened.  
Automatic climate control  
165  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
 
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
166  
Car care  
Index  
Automatic climate control  
Display and controls  
8 Air volume (automatic, manual)  
9 Display  
Depending on the ambient light conditions, the  
figures on the display will be shown as dark figures  
on a bright background (in daylight), or as bright  
figures on a dark background (at night).  
1
2
3
6
9
8
5
12  
10 Temperature control, left  
13  
11 10  
7
4
11 Air recirculation, see page 171  
12 Air distribution, left (automatic, manual operation)  
13 Activated charcoal filter  
P83.40-2116-26  
Important!  
This vehicle is equipped with an air conditioning  
system that uses R-134a (HFC: hydrofluorocarbon) as a  
refrigerant. Repairs should always be performed by a  
qualified technician, and refrigerant should be collected  
in a recovery system for recycling.  
1 Defrosting  
2 Rear window defroster, see page 176  
3 Residual engine heat utilization, see page 174  
4 Automatic climate control on/off  
5 Air distribution, right (automatic, manual operation)  
6 Economy mode, see page 173  
7 Temperature control, right  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Automatic climate control  
Notes:  
Do not obstruct the air flow by placing objects on the air  
flow-through exhaust slots below the rear window.  
The system is always at operational readiness, except  
when manually switched off.  
Also keep the air intake grill in front of the windshield  
free of snow and debris.  
The automatic climate control only operates with the  
engine running.  
The storage compartment between the front seats can be  
ventilated. See page 175 for notes on ventilating the  
storage space under the armrest in the center console.  
The temperature selector should be left at the desired  
temperature setting. The temperature selected is  
reached as quickly as possible.  
The air conditioner switches itself off for its own  
protection if refrigerant is lost. No cooling will then take  
place. Economy mode S cannot be switched off. Have  
the air conditioner checked by a Mercedes-Benz Center  
should this happen.  
The system will not heat or cool any quicker by setting a  
higher or lower temperature.  
The desired interior temperature and air distribution  
can be selected separately for the left and right side of  
the passenger compartment.  
The automatic climate control removes considerable  
moisture from the air during operation in the cooling  
mode. It is normal for water to drip on the ground  
through ducts in the underbody.  
Dust filter  
Nearly all dust particles and pollen are filtered out  
before outside air enters the passenger compartment  
through the air distribution system.  
The air conditioning will not engage (no cooling) if the  
economy mode S is selected, see page 173.  
Automatic climate control  
167  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
 
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
168  
Car care  
Index  
Automatic climate control  
Basic setting – automatic mode  
Air volume and distribution are controlled  
automatically.  
Set the temperature switches on the left and right to  
72°F (22°C). This provides for comfortable conditions in  
the vehicle.  
Automatic airflow regulation:  
Press the A on the air volume switch. The display  
shows “AUTO”.  
There are three basic settings for the automatic mode:  
Automatic air volume control  
Automatic air distribution:  
Automatic air outlet control, left and right  
Automatic air outlet control, center, see page 165  
Press on both U knobs until they click in. The h,  
j and k symbols will no longer be visible.  
The economy mode and air recirculation functions will  
be switched off. The automatic blower will be activated  
at the same time.  
We recommend these settings to be used all year round.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Special settings  
Air volume, manual  
(use only for short duration)  
P83.40-2257-21  
Air distribution, manual:  
Press the air volume switch up or down. Seven blower  
speeds can be selected.  
Press U button. The button pops out, the h, j  
and k symbols are visible. Turn the button to select  
the air distribution desired.  
h Air from the center, side and door air outlets.  
j Air from the center, side, door and windshield air  
outlets.  
k Air from the center, side, door and footwell air  
outlets.  
To return to automatic mode:  
Press the U button until it clicks in. The h, j  
and k symbols will no longer be visible.  
Automatic climate control  
169  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
     
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
170  
Car care  
Index  
Automatic climate control  
Defrosting  
Windows fogged on the inside  
Switch off the economy mode, if selected: Press  
button S. The indicator lamp in the button will go  
out.  
Switch off air recirculation, if selected: Press  
button O. The indicator lamp in the button will go  
out.  
Adjust left and right air outlets upwards.  
Set blower to the maximum blower speed.  
Increase temperature setting.  
P83.40-2009-21  
Press the P button. The display shows P.  
The fan is set to a higher speed and the warm air is  
directed to the defroster and windshield air outlets.  
Open the side air outlets and direct them onto the side  
windows.  
Pressing the switch again returns the system to the  
previous setting.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Windshield fogged on the outside  
The system automatically switches from air  
recirculation to fresh air:  
Switch on the windshield wiper.  
after 30 minutes if the outside temperature is above  
Press on both U buttons until they click in.  
The h, j and k symbols will no longer be  
visible.  
about 40°F (5°C),  
after 5 minutes if the outside temperature is below  
about 40°F (5°C),  
Air recirculation  
after 5 minutes if economy mode S is selected.  
Select air recirculation:  
The system switches automatically to air recirculation at  
high outside temperatures. A quantity of outside air is  
added after about 30 minutes.  
The indicator lamp in the O button is off.  
Press button O briefly. The indicator lamp in the  
button illuminates.  
Important!  
To switch off the air recirculation:  
If the windows should fog up from the inside, switch  
from recirculated air back to fresh air.  
The indicator lamp in the O button is on.  
Press button O briefly. The indicator lamp in the  
button will go out.  
Automatic climate control  
171  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
     
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
172  
Car care  
Index  
Automatic climate control  
Activated charcoal filter  
The system switches automatically to the air  
recirculation mode, if the carbon monoxide (CO) or  
nitrogen oxides (NOX) concentration of the outside air  
increases beyond a predetermined level.  
An activated charcoal filter markedly reduces bad odors  
and removes pollutants from air entering the passenger  
compartment.  
The automatic air recirculation mode does not function  
if economy mode S is selected or if the outside  
temperature has fallen below 40°F (5°C).  
To select, press e button. The indicator lamp in the  
button illuminates.  
To cancel, press e button. The indicator lamp in the  
button goes out.  
The activated charcoal filter should be switched off  
when windows fog up on the inside, or if the passenger  
compartment needs to be quickly heated or cooled  
down.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Economy mode  
Press S button to activate. The indicator lamp in the  
button illuminates.  
The function of this setting corresponds to the  
automatic mode. However, because the air conditioning  
compressor will not engage (fuel savings), it is not  
possible to air condition in this setting.  
Press S button once again to return to the previous  
setting.  
Important!  
In the S mode the windows could fog up on the  
inside. Switch off S mode.  
Automatic climate control  
173  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
   
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
174  
Car care  
Index  
Automatic climate control  
Residual engine heat utilization  
The function switches off automatically:  
if the electronic key in starter switch is turned to  
position 2,  
after approximately 30 minutes,  
if the battery voltage drops.  
Note:  
The battery symbol # will appear in the automatic  
climate control display some time before the residual  
engine heat utilization is switched off if the battery  
voltage drops.  
With the engine switched off, it is possible to continue  
to heat or ventilate the interior for a short while. Air  
volume and distribution are controlled automatically.  
To select:  
Turn the electronic key in starter switch to position 1  
or 0 or remove it altogether.  
Press button T. The display shows “REST”.  
This function selection will not activate if the battery  
level is insufficient.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Switching the automatic climate control on and off  
Front center console storage compartment  
ventilation  
The front center console compartment has its own air  
outlet.  
To open: Slide the lever up.  
To close: Slide the lever down.  
The air volume is dependent on the setting of:  
air distribution control,  
To switch off:  
Press button 0. The display shows “0”.  
air volume control,  
air outlets in the dashboard.  
The fresh air supply to the vehicle interior is shut off.  
While driving, use this setting only temporarily,  
otherwise the windshield could fog up.  
The air temperature is about the same as that of the  
dashboard air outlets. It cannot be regulated separately.  
To switch on:  
Press button 0 or P or at least one of the U  
buttons so that it pops out and then click it back in.  
Notes:  
The compartment can get very warm due to its confined  
space. When storing heat sensitive objects in the  
compartment, close the air outlet while heating the  
passenger compartment.  
Do not allow articles to obstruct the air outlet in the  
storage compartment.  
Automatic climate control  
175  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
     
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
176  
Car care  
Index  
Automatic climate control  
Rear window defroster  
The rear window defroster uses a large amount of power.  
To keep the battery drain to a minimum, turn off the  
defroster as soon as the rear window is clear.  
Turn the electronic key in starter switch to position 2.  
To select:  
The defroster is automatically turned off after  
approximately 6–17 minutes of operation depending on  
the outside temperature and vehicle speed.  
Press the F button in the control panel of the  
automatic air conditioner. The indicator lamp in the  
button illuminates.  
If several power consumers are turned on  
To cancel:  
simultaneously, or the battery is only partially charged,  
it is possible that the defroster will automatically turn  
itself off. When this happens, the indicator lamp inside  
the switch starts blinking.  
Press the F button in the control panel of the  
automatic air conditioner. The indicator lamp in the  
button goes out.  
As soon as the battery has sufficient voltage, the  
defroster automatically turns itself back on.  
Notes:  
Heavy accumulation of snow and ice should be removed  
before activating the defroster.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Rear passenger compartment adjustable air outlets  
1 Center air outlet, left  
2 Center air outlet, right  
3 Air volume control for center air outlets  
To open: Turn the wheel to the left.  
1
2
3
P83.00-2014-26  
Automatic climate control  
177  
Instruments  
Operation  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Index  
and controls  
 
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
178  
Car care  
Index  
Interior equipment  
Power windows  
Control panel on rear center console.  
The control panel is located on the driver’s door.  
Switches for:  
Turn electronic key in starter switch to position 1 or 2.  
Opening the side windows:  
Press k on the switch to resistance point.  
1 left, front  
2 right, front  
Closing the side windows:  
Press j on the switch to resistance point.  
3 left, rear  
Release switch when window is in desired position.  
4 right, rear  
5 Switch for rear door window override  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Express opening and closing of windows  
Warning!  
Press k or j on the switch past resistance point  
and release – window opens or closes completely.  
When closing the windows, be sure that there is no  
danger of anyone being harmed by the closing  
procedure.  
To interrupt procedure, briefly press j or k.  
In case of obstruction, the automatic reversal will  
not operate if a door window is being closed by  
pressing the switch to its resistance point and  
holding it there, or when using the electronic main  
key.  
If the upward movement of the window is blocked  
during the closing procedure, the window will stop  
during the last few inches before closure and open  
slightly.  
When pressing and holding the switch j to close the  
window, and upward movement of the window is  
blocked during the last few inches before closure, it will  
stop but not open slightly.  
The closing procedure of door windows can be  
immediately reversed by either pressing the switch  
or pressing button Œ on the electronic main key  
and holding it, or (vehicle with KEYLESS-GO) when  
carrying the KEYLESS-GO-card, pull and hold a  
door handle.  
Notes:  
When leaving the vehicle, always remove the  
electronic key from starter switch, take the  
KEYLESS-GO-card (if so equipped) with you, and  
lock your vehicle. Do not leave children unattended  
in the vehicle, or with access to an unlocked  
vehicle. Unsupervised use of vehicle equipment  
can cause serious personal injury.  
The power windows can also be opened and closed  
using the summer opening/convenience feature, see  
page 45.  
When opening a door window, the rear side window  
opens slightly. The rear side window will close again  
when the closing procedure of the door window is  
completed.  
Interior equipment  
179  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
 
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
180  
Car care  
Index  
Interior equipment  
Blocking of rear side window operation  
Synchronizing power windows  
If no operation of the rear side windows by switch (for  
instance by children) is desired, slide override  
switch (5) to the right; the N symbol becomes  
visible.  
If the power supply was interrupted, (battery  
disconnected or low), the windows cannot be opened or  
closed by the express feature.  
To resynchronize the express feature, press j side of  
power window switch until the window is completely  
closed and hold down for approximately 1 second.  
Repeat procedure for each window.  
Operation of the rear side windows with the switches  
located in the driver’s door is still possible.  
The automatic full opening and closing procedure of the  
windows should now be restored.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Sliding/pop-up roof  
Turn the electronic key in starter switch to position 1  
or 2.  
To open, close, raise or lower the sliding/pop-up roof:  
Move the switch to resistance point in the required  
direction.  
3
1
2
Release the switch when the roof has reached the  
required position.  
4
Warning!  
When closing the sliding/pop-up roof, be sure that  
there is no danger of anyone being harmed by the  
closing procedure.  
P77.00-2024-26  
When leaving the vehicle, always remove the  
electronic key from starter switch, take the  
KEYLESS-GO-card (if so equipped) with you, and  
lock your vehicle. Do not leave children unattended  
in the vehicle, or with access to an unlocked  
vehicle. Unsupervised use of vehicle equipment  
can cause serious personal injury.  
1 to slide roof open  
2 to slide roof closed  
3 to raise roof at rear  
4 to lower roof at rear  
Interior equipment  
181  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Index  
data  
 
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
182  
Car care  
Index  
Interior equipment  
Express opening and closing of sliding/pop-up roof  
Warning!  
To select a sunroof opening position, press the switch to  
resistance point and release it when the sunroof has  
reached the required position.  
When closing the sliding/pop-up roof, be sure that  
there is no danger of anyone being harmed by the  
closing procedure.  
In case of obstruction, the automatic reversal will  
not operate if the sliding/pop-up roof is being  
closed by moving the switch to its resistance point  
and holding it there, or when using the electronic  
main key or the lock button at each door handle  
(vehicles with KEYLESS-GO).  
The sliding/pop-up roof now opens to the position set if  
the switch is pressed past resistance point in the “open”  
direction.  
If you wish to change the opening position of the  
sunroof, move the switch to resistance point in the  
direction you require.  
The closing procedure of the sliding/pop-up roof  
can be immediately reversed by either moving the  
switch in any direction, or pressing button Œ on  
the electronic main key and holding it; or (vehicles  
with KEYLESS-GO) when carrying the KEYLESS-  
GO-card, pull and hold a door handle.  
Stopping the sliding/pop-up roof:  
Move the switch in any direction.  
If the movement of the sliding/pop-up roof is blocked  
during the closing procedure, the sunroof will stop and  
reopen slightly.  
When leaving the vehicle, always remove the  
electronic key from starter switch and take the  
KEYLESS-GO-card (if so equipped) with you, and  
lock your vehicle. Do not leave children unattended  
in the vehicle, or with access to an unlocked  
vehicle. Unsupervised use of vehicle equipment  
can cause serious personal injury.  
Note:  
Opening the sliding/pop-up roof automatically almost  
fully (less approximately 1 inch [3 cm]), the sunroof  
must have been opened first by pressing the switch to  
resistance point and releasing it when the sunroof has  
reached an almost fully open position.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Notes:  
The sliding/pop-up roof can also be opened and closed  
using the summer opening/convenience feature, see  
page 45.  
To avoid damaging the seals, do not transport any  
objects with sharp edges which can stick out of the  
sliding/pop-up roof.  
The sliding/pop-up roof can be opened or closed  
manually should an electrical malfunction occur, see  
page 369.  
P77.00-2048-26  
Synchronizing the sliding/pop-up roof  
With the roof closed or tilted open, a screen can be slid  
into the roof opening to guard against sun rays. When  
sliding the roof open, the screen will also retract.  
The sliding/pop-up roof must be resynchronized if the  
power supply has been interrupted (battery  
disconnected or low), the sliding/pop-up roof has been  
closed manually or the sliding/pop-up roof does not  
open smoothly or malfunctions.  
Move the switch in the “raise” (3) direction, wait  
until the sliding/pop-up roof is fully raised at rear  
and hold the switch for approximately 1 second.  
Interior equipment  
183  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
 
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
184  
Car care  
Index  
Interior equipment  
Interior lighting  
3 Right front reading lamp  
Press the button to switch the right reading lamp (8)  
on or off. The right reading lamp in the rear view  
mirror will be switched on or off.  
2
1
3
4
6
5
4 Door contact switch:  
Press the rocker switch.  
The interior lighting remains switched off, even  
when centrally unlocking or opening a door or the  
electronic key is removed from the starter switch.  
5 To select automatic function:  
Press the rocker switch to the center position.  
8
7
Interior lamps are switched on, and off (soft fade)  
delayed, when unlocking or locking the vehicle, or  
when opening or closing a door. However, there will  
be no (soft fade) delay when the electronic key is in  
starter switch position 2.  
P68.00-2151-26  
1 Left front reading lamp  
Press the button to switch the left reading lamp (7)  
on or off. The left reading lamp in the interior rear  
view mirror will be switched on or off.  
Note:  
2 Rear interior lights  
The time delay for the interior light to switch off after  
the electronic key is removed from the starter switch  
can be adjusted in “Individual settings” – “LIGHTING”,  
see page 142.  
Press the button to switch the rear passenger  
compartment lights on/off.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
To prevent the vehicle battery from being discharged  
with doors open, all interior lamps switch off after  
approximately 5 minutes.  
Footwell lighting  
With exterior lamps on, the driver and front passenger  
footwell is illuminated.  
6 Interior lamps, front:  
Press rocker switch in to switch front interior and  
reading lamps on. The front interior lighting stays  
on while the rocker switch is pressed in.  
Center console lighting  
Turn the electronic key in the starter switch to  
position 1. The center console is illuminated from the  
rear-view mirror.  
Switching off the front interior lighting:  
Press rocker switch to position (4) or (5).  
Door entry lamps  
Courtesy lighting  
The appropriate entry lamp switches on if a door is  
opened in darkness and if the interior lighting is  
switched to automatic function.  
The interior of your vehicle is equipped with various  
different lighting installations to help you to orient  
yourself better in the dark.  
The entry lamp switches off automatically when the  
door is closed.  
Entrance lamps, exit lamps  
With exterior lamps on or electronic key in starter  
switch position 1, the lamps in the door trays illuminate.  
The lights will remain on for approximately 5 minutes if  
the electronic key is in starter switch position 0 and  
exterior lamps are switched off.  
Interior equipment  
185  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
         
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
186  
Car care  
Index  
Interior equipment  
Rear window sunshade (optional)  
Always raise the sunshade fully for its support against  
the window frame.  
Warning!  
When operating the rear window sunshade, be sure  
that there is no danger of anyone being harmed by  
the raising or lowering procedure.  
The raising or lowering procedure can be  
immediately halted by briefly pressing the upper or  
lower half of the switch.  
Briefly press upper or lower half of the switch  
again to raise or lower the rear window sunshade  
completely.  
When leaving the vehicle, always remove the  
electronic key from starter switch, and lock your  
vehicle. Do not leave children unattended in the  
vehicle, or with access to an unlocked vehicle.  
Unsupervised use of vehicle equipment can cause  
serious personal injury.  
The switch is located in the center console.  
Turn the electronic key in starter switch to position 1  
or 2.  
Press the switch briefly:  
1 to raise  
2 to lower  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Sun visors  
Vanity mirrors  
4
1
2
3
2
1
P68.60-2009-26  
P68.00-2150-26  
1 Illuminated vanity mirror  
Swing sun visors (2) down to protect against sun glare.  
If sunlight enters through a side window, disengage sun  
visor from the inner mounting (1) and pivot to the side,  
and slide it to the desired position.  
With the visor engaged in its inner mounting (2),  
the lamp (4) can be switched on by opening the  
cover (3). Slide the mirror to the left or right for a  
normal or magnified image.  
Fold the cover (3) down to close the vanity mirror.  
Warning!  
Do not use the vanity mirror while driving.  
Interior equipment  
187  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
   
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
188  
Car care  
Index  
Interior equipment  
Interior  
Storage compartments and armrests  
Warning!  
Warning!  
To help avoid personal injury during a collision or  
sudden maneuver, exercise care when stowing  
things. Put luggage or cargo in the trunk if  
possible. Do not pile luggage or cargo higher than  
the seat backs. Do not place anything on the shelf  
below the rear window.  
Keep compartment lids closed. This will help to  
prevent stored objects from being thrown about  
and injuring vehicle occupants during an accident.  
Luggage nets cannot secure hard or heavy objects.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Glove box  
1 Unlocked position  
2 Locked position  
3 Press to open  
4 The glove box lid is equipped with a container (4)  
for coins and small accessories.  
To open, press the marking on the cover.  
The glove box can be locked and unlocked with the  
mechanical key. See page 29 for instructions on how to  
remove the mechanical key from the electronic main  
key (e.g. for valet parking service).  
Interior equipment  
189  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
   
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
190  
Car care  
Index  
Interior equipment  
Storage compartment in front of armrest  
Storage compartment below the front armrest  
5 Storage compartment in front of armrest  
A coin holder is also located in the storage compartment  
below the armrest.  
To open:  
Touch the top of the cover lightly.  
Storage tray in the armrest  
To close:  
To open: Press button (6) and raise the armrest.  
To close: Lower the armrest until it engages in lock.  
Lightly push the cover up until it engages in lock.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Storage space below the armrest  
Storage compartment under the front seats  
To open: Press button (7) and raise the armrest.  
To close: Lower the armrest until it engages in lock.  
Notes:  
The storage compartment can be heated or cooled, see  
page 175.  
The compartment can get very warm due to its confined  
space. When storing heat sensitive objects in the  
compartment, close the air outlet while heating the  
passenger compartment.  
Do not obstruct the air outlet in the storage  
compartment.  
8 Storage compartment under the front seats  
The storage space below the armrest is illuminated with  
the exterior lamps switched on.  
Maximum permissible weight of contents:  
3.3 lbs. (1.5 kg)  
To open:  
Press buttons (9) together and fold the lid down.  
To close:  
Close lid until both buttons (9) of lock engage.  
Interior equipment  
191  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
192  
Car care  
Index  
Interior equipment  
Storage compartments in the  
Coat hooks  
rear passenger compartment  
1
P68.70-2002-26  
Opening the storage space:  
Coat hooks (1) are located on the headliner above the  
rear windows.  
Slide the cover (10) back to open, forward to close.  
To open:  
Briefly press indentation on coat hook – the coat hook  
folds down.  
To close:  
Push coat hook into headliner.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Cup holder  
Press button (2) to open the second cup holder. The cup  
holder opens automatically.  
1 Cup holder in front seat armrest  
Open the storage compartment in front of the armrest,  
see page 190.  
Warning!  
To open:  
Keep the cup holder closed while traveling. Place  
only containers that fit into the cup holder to  
prevent spills. Do not fill containers to a height  
where the contents could spill during vehicle  
maneuvers, especially hot liquids.  
Briefly press button (1). The cup holder opens  
automatically.  
Interior equipment  
193  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
 
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
194  
Car care  
Index  
Interior equipment  
4
To close:  
Press button (4) to unlock cup holder and fold into the  
storage compartment until it engages.  
Fold second cup holder in direction of arrow (3) until it  
engages.  
Close the storage compartment.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
To open:  
Push front of sliding compartment – the cup holder  
slides out.  
To close:  
Push the sliding compartment back until it engages.  
Warning!  
Keep the cup holder closed while traveling. Place  
only containers that fit into the cup holder to  
prevent spills. Do not fill containers to a height  
where the contents could spill during vehicle  
maneuvers, especially hot liquids.  
5
P91.27-2014-26  
5 Cup holder in rear seat armrest  
Interior equipment  
195  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Index  
data  
 
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
196  
Car care  
Index  
Interior equipment  
Ashtrays  
Center console  
To open:  
Briefly touch the mark on the cover, the ashtray opens  
automatically.  
To remove ashtray insert from center console:  
1
Warning!  
Remove front ashtray only with vehicle standing  
still. With the gear selector lever in position “N”,  
turn off the engine and set the parking brake.  
Otherwise the vehicle might move as a result of  
unintended contact with the gear selector lever.  
P68.20-2070-26  
Press sliding knob (1) toward the right to eject the  
insert.  
To replace insert:  
Prior to removing the ashtray insert, move the gear  
selector lever to position “N”.  
Install insert into ashtray frame and push down to  
engage into place.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Rear seats  
To open:  
Briefly touch the top of the cover, the ashtray opens  
automatically.  
To remove the insert:  
Push down on catch (2) and pull out the ashtray insert.  
To install the insert:  
Position the insert and close the cover.  
2
Interior equipment  
Instruments  
197  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
and controls  
cluster display  
data  
 
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
198  
Car care  
Index  
Interior equipment  
Lighter  
Turn the electronic key in starter switch to position 1  
or 2.  
Push in lighter (1); it will pop out automatically when  
hot.  
Warning!  
Never touch the heating element or sides of the  
lighter, they are extremely hot, hold at knob only.  
1
When leaving the vehicle always remove the  
electronic key from the starter switch. Do not leave  
children unattended in the vehicle, or with access  
to an unlocked vehicle. Unsupervised use of vehicle  
equipment may cause serious personal injury.  
P68.20-2069-26  
Note:  
1 Center console lighter  
The lighter socket can be used to accommodate  
electrical accessories up to a maximum 100 W.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Parcel net in trunk  
There are hooks (1) on the left and right inside the  
trunk from which the parcel net is suspended.  
The tab (arrow) must point down into the trunk.  
The parcel net and hooks are only designed to take light  
loads in normal driving conditions. They are unable to  
secure a load in the event of an accident. Observe the  
weight limit on the tab (arrow).  
1
P68.00-2147-26  
Interior equipment  
199  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Index  
data  
 
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
200  
Car care  
Index  
Interior equipment  
Cargo tie-down hooks  
Parcel net in front passenger footwell  
A small convenience parcel net is located in the front  
passenger footwell. It is for small and light items, such  
as road maps, mail, etc..  
Warning!  
Do not place heavy or fragile objects, or objects  
having sharp edges, in the parcel net.  
In an accident, during hard braking or sudden  
maneuvers, they could be thrown around inside  
the vehicle, and cause injury to vehicle occupants.  
P68.00-2416-26  
Note:  
With large objects stored in the parcel net do not slide  
the seat fully forward, it could damage them.  
Inside the trunk are six cargo tie-down hooks. Secure  
cargo by applying even load on the hooks using a cargo  
net.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Telephone, general  
Warning!  
Bear in mind that at a speed of just 30 mph  
(approximately 50 km/h), your vehicle is covering  
a distance of approximately 50 feet (approximately  
14 m) every second.  
A driver’s attention to the road must always be his/  
her primary focus when driving. For your safety  
and the safety of others, we recommend that you  
pull over to a safe location and stop before placing  
or taking a telephone call. If you choose to use the  
telephone while driving, please use the hands-free  
device and only use the telephone when road and  
traffic conditions permit.  
Never operate radio transmitters equipped with a  
built-in or attached antenna (i.e. without being  
connected to an external antenna) from inside the  
vehicle while the engine is running. Doing so could  
lead to a malfunction of the vehicle’s electronic  
system, possibly resulting in an accident and  
personal injury.  
Some jurisdictions prohibit the driver from using a  
cellular telephone while driving a vehicle.  
See separate instruction manual for instructions on how  
to operate the telephone.  
Interior equipment  
201  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
 
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
202  
Car care  
Index  
Garage door opener  
Garage door opener  
The built-in remote control is capable of operating up to  
three separately controlled objects.  
Warning!  
When programming a garage door opener, the door  
moves up or down.  
When programming or operating the remote  
control make sure there is no possibility of anyone  
being harmed by the moving door.  
Note:  
Certain types of garage door openers are incompatible  
with the integrated opener. If you should experience  
difficulties with programming the transmitter, contact  
your authorized Mercedes-Benz Center, or call  
Mercedes-Benz Client Assistance Center (in the USA  
only) at 1-800-FOR-MERCedes, or Customer Service (in  
Canada) at 1-800-387-0100.  
3
1 Signal transmitter keys  
2 Indicator lamp  
3 Portable remote control transmitter  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
For operation in the USA only: This device complies  
with Part 15, Subpart C, Section 209 of the FCC Rules.  
Operation is subject to the following two conditions:  
3. Using both hands, simultaneously push the hand-  
held transmitter button and the desired integrated  
remote control button. Do not release the buttons  
until completing step 4.  
(1) This device may not cause harmful interference, and  
4. The indicator lamp on the integrated remote control  
will flash, first slowly and then rapidly. When the  
indicator lamp flashes rapidly, both buttons may be  
released (the rapid flashing lamp indicates  
successful programming of the new frequency  
signal). To program the remaining two buttons,  
follow steps 1 through 4.  
(2) this device must accept any interference received,  
including interference that may cause undesired  
operation.  
WARNING: Changes or modification not expressly  
approved by party responsible for compliance could void  
the user’s authority to operate the equipment.  
Programming or reprogramming the integrated  
remote control:  
Note:  
If, after repeated attempts, you do not successfully  
program the integrated remote control device to learn  
the signal of the hand-held transmitter, the garage door  
opener could be equipped with the “rolling code  
feature”.  
1. Turn electronic key in starter switch to position 1  
or 2.  
2. Hold the end of the hand-held transmitter of the  
device you wish to train approximately 2 to 5 inches  
(5 cm to 12 cm) away from the surface of the  
integrated remote control located on the inside rear  
view mirror, keeping the indicator lamp in view.  
Garage door opener  
203  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
204  
Car care  
Index  
Garage door opener  
Rolling code programming:  
3. Firmly press and release the programmed  
integrated remote control transmit button. Press  
and release same button a second time to complete  
the training process. (Some garage door openers  
may require you to do this procedure a third time to  
complete the training.)  
To train a garage door opener (or other rolling code  
devices) with the rolling code feature, follow these  
instructions after completing the “Programming”  
portion of this text. (A second person may make the  
following training procedures quicker and easier.)  
4. Confirm the garage door operation by pressing the  
programmed button on the integrated remote  
control transmitter.  
1. Locate training button on the garage door opener  
motor head unit. Exact location and color of the  
button may vary by garage door opener brand. If  
there is difficulty locating the transmitting button,  
reference to garage door opener operator’s manual.  
Canadian programming:  
During programming, your hand-held transmitter may  
automatically stop transmitting. Continue to press and  
hold the integrated remote control transmitter button  
(note steps 2 through 4 in the “Programming” portion)  
while you press and re-press (“cycle”) your hand-held  
transmitter every two seconds until the frequency  
signal has been learned. The indicator lamp will flash  
slowly and then rapidly after several seconds upon  
successful training.  
2. Press “training” button on the garage door opener  
motor head unit (which activated the “training  
light”).  
Note:  
Following step 2, there are 30 seconds to initiate  
step 3.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Operation of remote control:  
Erasing the remote control memory:  
1. Turn electronic key in starter switch to position 1  
or 2.  
1. Turn electronic key in starter switch to position 1  
or 2.  
2. Select and press the appropriate button to activate  
the remote controlled device. The integrated remote  
control transmitter continues to send the signal as  
long as the button is pressed – up to 20 seconds.  
2. Simultaneously holding down the left and right side  
buttons for approximately 20 seconds, or until the  
control lamp blinks rapidly, will erase the codes of  
all three channels.  
Garage door opener  
205  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
206  
Car care  
Index  
Infrared reflecting windshield  
Infrared reflecting windshield  
Your vehicle is equipped with infrared reflecting glass  
which reduces the amount of radiated heat entering the  
interior through the windows.  
1
1
2
The infrared reflecting glass also prevents the  
transmission of signals through the glass by in-vehicle  
electronic devices (e.g. electronic toll collection  
devices).  
3
4
5
To allow the use of these devices in the vehicle, two  
infrared transparent areas (1 and 2) are placed in the  
windshield.  
1 Mounting location for electronic toll collection  
devices (infrared transparent)  
2 Infrared transparent area (pass-through for  
electronic signals)  
3 31.5 in (80 cm)  
4 19.0 in (48 cm)  
5 1.75 in (4.5 cm)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Infrared reflecting windshield  
207  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Infrared reflecting windshield  
208  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driving instructions ......................239 Distronic (DTR) ..............................253  
Drive sensibly – save fuel ........239 Brake assist system  
Driving  
Control and operation of radio  
transmitters ...............................208  
The first 1 000 miles  
(BAS) ...........................................268  
Drinking and driving ................239  
Pedals ..........................................240  
Power assistance ........................ 240  
Brakes ..........................................240  
Driving off ................................... 241  
Parking ........................................ 242  
Tires ............................................. 243  
Snow chains ............................... 245  
Deep water ..................................248  
Passenger compartment ...........248  
Traveling abroad ........................ 249  
Cruise control ................................250  
Antilock brake system  
(ABS) ...........................................269  
Electronic stability program  
(1 500 km) .................................209  
Maintenance ...................................209  
Tele Aid ........................................... 210  
Catalytic converter ........................220  
Emission control ............................221  
Starter switch .................................222  
Starter switch – KEYLESS-GO ......224  
Starting and turning off  
the engine ..................................227  
Automatic transmission ...............229  
Parking brake .................................238  
(ESP) ...........................................271  
Active body control (ABC) ............275  
Level control system ...................... 276  
Parking assist (Parktronic) ..........279  
What you should know  
at the gas station .......................284  
Check regularly  
and before a long trip ...............287  
Contents - Driving  
207  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Index  
data  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Control and operation of radio transmitters  
Control and operation of radio transmitters  
208  
COMAND, radio and telephone  
Telephones and two-way radio  
Warning!  
Warning!  
Please do not forget that your primary  
Never operate radio transmitters equipped with a  
built-in or attached antenna (i.e. without being  
connected to an external antenna) from inside the  
vehicle while the engine is running. Doing so could  
lead to a malfunction of the vehicle’s electronic  
system, possibly resulting in an accident and  
personal injury.  
responsibility is to drive the vehicle. Only operate  
the COMAND (Cockpit Management and Data  
System), radio or telephone1 if road and traffic  
conditions permit.  
Bear in mind that at a speed of just 30 mph  
(approximately 50 km/h), your vehicle is covering  
a distance of approximately 50 feet (approximately  
14 m) every second.  
Radio transmitters, such as a portable telephone or a  
citizens band unit should only be used inside the  
vehicle if they are connected to an antenna that is  
installed on the outside of the vehicle.  
1
Observe all legal requirements.  
Refer to the radio transmitter operation instructions  
regarding use of an external antenna.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
The first 1 000 miles (1 500 km)  
Maintenance  
The more cautiously you treat your vehicle during the  
break-in period, the more satisfied you will be with its  
performance later on. Therefore, drive your vehicle  
during the first 1 000 miles (1 500 km) at moderate  
vehicle and engine speeds.  
Approximately 30 days or 2000 miles (2000 km) prior  
to the next recommended service, the remaining  
distance or days are displayed in the multifunction  
indicator. See Flexible service system (FSS) on page 147.  
We strongly recommend that you have your vehicle  
serviced by your authorized Mercedes-Benz Center, in  
accordance with the Service Booklet at the times called  
for by the FSS.  
During this period, avoid heavy loads (full throttle  
driving) and excessive engine speeds.  
Avoid accelerating by kickdown. It is not recommended  
to brake the vehicle by manually shifting to a lower gear.  
We recommend that you select positions “3”, “2” or “1”  
only at moderate speeds (for hill driving).  
Failure to have the vehicle maintained in accordance  
with the Service Booklet at the designated times/  
mileage may result in vehicle damage not covered by  
the Mercedes-Benz Limited Warranty.  
After 1 000 miles (1 500 km) speeds may be gradually  
increased to the permissible maximum.  
The first 1 000 miles  
209  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
   
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Tele Aid  
210  
Tele Aid  
Important!  
The speaker volume of a Tele Aid call can be adjusted  
when using the volume control on the multifunction  
steering wheel, for raising press button æ and for  
lowering press button ç.  
The initial activation of the Tele Aid system may only be  
performed by completing the subscriber agreement and  
placing an acquaintance call using the “SOS” button.  
Failure to complete either of these steps will result in a  
system that is not activated. If the system is not  
activated the indicator lamp in the “SOS” button stays  
on after turning electronic key in starter switch to  
position 2 (vehicles with KEYLESS-GO:  
To activate, press the “SOS” button, the Roadside  
Assistance button or the Information button ¡,  
depending on the type of response required.  
Shortly after the completion of your Acquaintance Call,  
you will receive a user ID and password via first call  
mail. By visiting www.mbusa.com and selecting  
“Tele Aid” (USA only), you will have access to account  
information, remote door unlock, Info Services* profile  
and more.  
operating position, see page 224) and the message  
“TELE AID – NOT ACTIVATED” will be shown in the  
multifunction display for approx. 10 seconds.  
* Optional  
If you have any questions regarding activation, please  
call the Response Center at 1-800-756-9018 (in the USA)  
or 1-888-923-8367 (in Canada).  
System self-check  
Initially, after turning the electronic key in starter  
switch to position 2, malfunctions are detected and  
indicated (the indicator lamps in the “SOS” button, the  
Roadside Assistance button and the Information  
button ¡ stay on longer than 10 seconds or do not  
come on). The message “TELE AID – VISIT  
(Telematic Alarm Identification on Demand)  
The Tele Aid system consists of three types of response;  
automatic and manual emergency, roadside assistance  
and information.  
The Tele Aid system is operational providing that the  
vehicle’s battery is charged, properly connected, not  
damaged and cellular and GPS coverage is available.  
WORKSHOP” appears for approx. 10 seconds in the  
multifunction display.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Important!  
Once the emergency call is in progress, the indicator  
lamp in the “SOS” button will begin to flash. The  
message “EMERGENCY CALL – CONNECTING CALL”  
appears in the multifunction display. When the  
connection is established, the message “EMERGENCY  
CALL – CALL CONNECTED” appears in the  
multifunction display. All information relevant to the  
emergency, such as the location of the vehicle  
(determined by the GPS satellite location system),  
vehicle model, identification number and color are  
generated.  
Always make sure that the indicator lamps in the  
“SOS” button, in the “Roadside Assistance” button and  
in the “Information” button do not remain illuminated  
constantly in red and the message “TELE AID – VISIT  
WORKSHOP” is not displayed in the multifunction  
display after the system self check.  
If a malfunction is indicated as outlined above, have the  
system checked at the nearest Mercedes-Benz Center as  
soon as possible.  
A voice connection between the Response Center and  
the occupants of the vehicle will be established  
automatically soon after the emergency call has been  
initiated. When a voice connection is established the  
audio system mutes and the message “TELE AID –  
EMERGENCY CALL ACTIVE” appears in the  
Emergency calls  
An emergency call is initiated automatically:  
following an accident in which the Emergency  
Tensioning Retractors (ETR’s) or airbags deploy,  
multifunction display. The Response Center will attempt  
to determine more precisely the nature of the accident  
provided they can speak to an occupant of the vehicle.  
if the antitheft alarm or the tow away alarm stays on  
for more than 20 seconds, see pages 62 and 64.  
An emergency call can also be initiated manually by  
opening the cover next to the inside rear view mirror  
labeled “SOS”, then pressing the button (for longer than  
2 seconds) located under the cover. See below for  
instructions on initiating an emergency call manually.  
Tele Aid  
211  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Index  
data  
 
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Tele Aid  
212  
The Tele Aid system is available if:  
Warning!  
it has been activated and is operational. Activation  
requires a subscription for monitoring services and  
cellular air time  
If the indicator lamp in the “SOS” button is  
illuminated continuously and there was no voice  
connection to the Response Center established,  
then the Tele Aid system could not initiate an  
emergency call (e.g. the relevant cellular phone  
network is not available). The message  
the relevant cellular phone network and GPS signals  
are available and pass the information on to the  
response center.  
“EMERGENCY CALL – CALL FAILED” appears in  
the multifunction display for approx. 10 seconds.  
Note:  
Should this occur, assistance must be summoned  
by other means.  
Location of the vehicle on a map is possible if the  
vehicle is able to receive signals from the GPS satellite  
network and pass the information on to the response  
center.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Initiating an emergency call manually  
1
2
P82.95-2186-26  
P82.95-2187-26  
Briefly press on cover (1) – the cover will open.  
Press the SOS button (2) briefly (for longer than  
2 seconds). The indicator lamp in the SOS button (2)  
will flash until the emergency call is concluded. Wait for  
a voice connection to the Response Center.  
Close the cover (1) after the emergency call is  
concluded.  
Tele Aid  
213  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
 
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Tele Aid  
214  
A voice connection between the Roadside Assistance  
dispatcher and the occupants of the vehicle will be  
established. When a voice connection is established the  
audio system mutes and the message “TELE AID -  
ROADSIDE ASSISTANCE CALL ACTIVE” appears in the  
multifunction display. The nature of the need for  
assistance can then be described. The Mercedes-Benz  
Roadside assistance dispatcher will either dispatch a  
qualified Mercedes-Benz technician or arrange to tow  
your vehicle to the nearest Mercedes-Benz Center. For  
services such as labor and/or towing charges may apply.  
Refer to the Roadside Assistance manual for more  
information.  
Warning!  
If you feel at any way in jeopardy when in the  
vehicle (e.g. smoke or fire in the vehicle, vehicle in  
a dangerous road location), please do not wait for  
voice contact after you have pressed the emergency  
button. Carefully leave the vehicle and move to a  
safe location. The Response Center will  
automatically contact local emergency officials  
with the vehicle’s approximate location if they  
receive an automatic “SOS” signal and cannot make  
voice contact with the vehicle occupants.  
Roadside Assistance button •  
Located below the center armrest cover is the Roadside  
Assistance button . Pressing and holding the  
button (for longer than 2 seconds) will initiate a call to a  
Mercedes-Benz Roadside Assistance dispatcher. The  
button will flash while the call is in progress. The  
message “ROADSIDE ASSISTANCE – CONNECTING  
CALL” will appear in the multifunction display. When  
the connection is established, the message “ROADSIDE  
ASSISTANCE – CALL CONNECTED” appears in the  
multifunction display. The Tele Aid system will transmit  
data generating the vehicle identification number,  
model, color and location (subject to availability of  
cellular and GPS signals).  
These programs are only available in the USA:  
Sign and Drive services: Services such as jump start,  
a few gallons of fuel or the replacement of a flat tire  
with the vehicle spare tire are obtainable,  
Remote Vehicle Diagnostics: This function permits  
the Mercedes-Benz Roadside Assistance dispatcher  
to download malfunction codes and actual vehicle  
data.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Notes:  
Information button ¡  
The indicator lamp in the Roadside Assistance  
button remains illuminated in red for approx.  
10 seconds during the system self-check after turning  
electronic key in starter switch to position 2 (together  
with the “SOS” button and the Information  
button ¡).  
Located below the center armrest cover is the  
Information button ¡. Pressing and holding the  
button (for longer than 2 seconds) will initiate a call to  
the Client Assistance Center. The button will flash while  
the call is in progress. The message “INFO –  
CONNECTING CALL” will appear in the multifunction  
display. When the connection is established, the  
message “INFO – CALL CONNECTED” appears in the  
multifunction display. The Tele Aid system will transmit  
data generating the vehicle identification number,  
model, color and location (subject to availability of  
cellular and GPS signals).  
See system self-check on page 210 when the indicator  
lamp does not light up in red or stays on longer than  
approximately 10 seconds.  
If the indicator lamp in the Roadside Assistance  
button is illuminated continuously and there was  
no voice connection to the Response Center established,  
then the Tele Aid system could not initiate an Roadside  
Assistance call (e.g. the relevant cellular phone network  
is not available). The message “ROADSIDE  
A voice connection between the Client Assistance  
Center representative and the occupants of the vehicle  
will be established. When a voice connection is  
established the audio system mutes and the message  
“TELE AID – INFO CALL ACTIVE” appears in the  
multifunction display. Information regarding the  
operation of your vehicle, the nearest Mercedes-Benz  
Center or Mercedes-Benz USA products and services is  
available to you.  
ASSISTANCE – CALL FAILED” appears in the  
multifunction display.  
Roadside Assistance calls can be terminated using the  
ì button on the multifunction steering wheel.  
For more details concerning Tele Aid, please visit  
www.mbusa.com and use your ID and password, sent to  
you separately, to learn more (USA only).  
Tele Aid  
215  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Index  
data  
 
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Tele Aid  
216  
Notes:  
Important!  
The indicator lamp in the Information button ¡  
remains illuminated in red for approx. 10 seconds  
during the system self-check after turning electronic  
key in starter switch to position 2 (together with the  
“SOS” button and the Roadside Assistance button ).  
If the indicator lamps do not start flashing after  
pressing one of the buttons or remain illuminated (in  
red) at any time, the Tele Aid system has detected a fault  
or the service is not currently active, and may not  
initiate a call. Visit your Mercedes-Benz Center and  
have the system checked or contact the Response Center  
at 1-800-756-9018 (in the USA) or 1-888-923-8367 (in  
Canada) as soon as possible.  
See system self-check on page 210 when the indicator  
lamp does not light up in red or stays on longer than  
approximately 10 seconds.  
If the indicator lamp in the Information button ¡ is  
illuminated continuously and there was no voice  
connection to the Response Center established, then the  
Tele Aid system could not initiate an Information call  
(e.g. the relevant cellular phone network is not  
available). The message “info – CALL FAILED” appears  
in the multifunction display.  
Upgrade Signals  
Tele Aid system processes calls using the following  
priority.  
Automatic emergency – First priority  
Manual emergency – Second priority  
Roadside assistance – Third priority  
Information – Fourth priority  
Information calls can be terminated using the  
ì button on the multifunction steering wheel.  
Should a higher priority call be initiated while you are  
connected, an upgrade (alternating) tone will be heard,  
and the appropriate indicator lamp will flash. If certain  
information such as vehicle identification number or  
client information is not available, the operator may  
need to retransmit.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
During this time you will hear a chirp and voice contact  
will be interrupted. Voice contact will resume once the  
retransmission is completed. Once a call is concluded, a  
chirp will be heard and the appropriate indicator lamp  
will stop flashing. The COMAND system operation will  
resume.  
Notes:  
The indicator lamp in the respective button flashes until  
the call is concluded. Calls can only be terminated by a  
Response Center or Client Assistance Center  
representative except Roadside Assistance and  
Information calls, which can also be terminated by  
pressing ì button on the multifunction steering  
wheel.  
Important!  
If the indicator lamp continues to flash or the system  
does not reset, contact the Response Center at  
1-800-756-9018 (in the USA) or 1-888-923-8367 (in  
Canada), or Mercedes-Benz Client Assistance at  
1-800-FOR-MERCedes (1-800-367-6372) in the USA or  
Customer Service at 1-800-387-0100 in Canada.  
When a Tele Aid call has been initiated, the COMAND  
system audio is muted and the selected mode (radio,  
tape or CD) pauses. The optional cellular phone (if  
installed) switches off. If you must use this phone, the  
vehicle must be parked. Disconnect the coiled cord and  
place the call. The navigation system (if engaged) will  
continue to run. The display in the instrument cluster is  
available for use and spoken commands are only  
available by pressing the RPT button on the COMAND  
unit. A pop-up window will appear in the COMAND  
display to indicate that a Tele Aid call is in progress.  
Tele Aid  
217  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Index  
data  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Tele Aid  
218  
Remote door unlock  
Notes:  
The remote door unlock feature is available if the  
relevant cellular phone network is available.  
In the case you have your vehicle locked unintentionally  
(e.g. key inside vehicle), and the reserve key is not  
handy, contact the Mercedes-Benz Response Center at  
1-800-756-9018 (in the USA) or 1-888-923-8367 (in  
Canada). You will be asked to provide your password  
which you provided when you completed the subscriber  
agreement.  
The “SOS” button will flash and the message  
“EMERGENCY CALL – CALL CONNECTED” will appear  
in the multifunction display to indicate receipt of the  
door unlock command.  
Once the vehicle is unlocked, a Response Center  
specialist will attempt to establish voice contact with the  
vehicle occupants.  
Then return to your vehicle and press trunk lock for  
minimum of 20 seconds until the “SOS” button is  
flashing. The message “EMERGENCY CALL – CALL  
CONNECTED” appears in the multifunction display.  
If the trunk button was pressed for more than  
20 seconds before door unlock authorization was  
received by the Response Center, you must wait  
15 minutes before pressing the trunk button again.  
As an alternative, you may unlock the vehicle via  
Internet using the ID and password sent to you shortly  
after the completion of your Acquaintance Call.  
The Response Center will then unlock your vehicle with  
the remote door unlocking feature.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Stolen vehicle tracking services  
Once information is available, the message “NEW INFO  
RECEIVED – READ LATER WHEN STOPPED?” will  
appear. Select “Yes”. With the vehicle stopped in a safe  
location press SVC, then select “View Info Service of  
mm.dd.yyyy hh.mm”. Messages will be retained for  
30 minutes once the ignition is switched off.  
In the event your vehicle was stolen, report the incident  
to the police who will issue a numbered incident report.  
Pass this number on to the Mercedes-Benz Response  
Center.  
The Response Center will then attempt to covertly  
contact the vehicle’s Tele Aid system. Once the vehicle  
is located, the Response Center will contact the local  
Law Enforcement and you. The vehicle’s location will  
only be provided to Law Enforcement.  
Important!  
Tele Aid utilizes the cellular network for  
communication and the GPS (Global Positioning  
System) satellites for vehicle location. If either of these  
signals are unavailable, the Tele Aid system may not  
function and if this occurs, assistance must be  
summoned by other means.  
Info Services (optional, except Canada)  
Info Services categories include news, sports, stocks,  
weather and calendar reminders. Choices can be  
selected via www.mbusa.com or by calling 1-800-FOR-  
MERcedes.  
Warning!  
If the indicator lamp in the “SOS” button does not  
illuminate during or remains illuminated after the  
system self-check or if the message “TELE AID –  
VISIT WORKSHOP” appears in the multifunction  
display, have the system checked at the nearest  
Mercedes-Benz Center as soon as possible.  
To request Info Services, press the SVC button on the  
COMAND system, then select “SEND NEW REQUEST  
FOR INFO SERVICE”. “NEW INFO SERVICE REQUEST  
TRANSMITTED” will appear in the COMAND display  
and call status messages will appear in the  
multifunction display.  
Tele Aid  
219  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Index  
data  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Catalytic converter  
Catalytic converter  
220  
Warning!  
Your Mercedes-Benz is equipped with monolithic type  
catalytic converters, an important element in  
conjunction with the oxygen sensors to achieve  
substantial control of the pollutants in the exhaust  
emissions. Keep your vehicle in proper operating  
condition by following our recommended maintenance  
instructions as outlined in your Service Booklet.  
As with any vehicle, do not idle, park or operate  
this vehicle in areas where combustible materials  
such as grass, hay or leaves can come into contact  
with the hot exhaust system, as these materials  
could be ignited and cause a vehicle fire.  
Caution!  
To prevent damage to the catalytic converters, use only  
premium unleaded gasoline in this vehicle.  
Any noticeable irregularities in engine operation should  
be repaired promptly. Otherwise, excessive unburned  
fuel may reach the catalytic converter causing it to  
overheat, which could start a fire.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Emission control  
Warning!  
Certain systems of the engine serve to keep the toxic  
components of the exhaust gases within permissible  
limits required by law.  
Inhalation of exhaust gas is hazardous to your  
health. All exhaust gas contains carbon monoxide,  
and inhaling it can cause unconsciousness and  
lead to death.  
These systems, of course, will function properly only  
when maintained strictly according to factory  
specifications. Any adjustments on the engine should,  
therefore, be carried out only by qualified Mercedes-  
Benz Center authorized technicians. Engine  
adjustments should not be altered in any way. Moreover,  
the specified service jobs must be carried out regularly  
according to Mercedes-Benz servicing requirements.  
For details refer to the Service Booklet.  
Do not run the engine in confined areas (such as a  
garage) which are not properly ventilated. If you  
think that exhaust gas fumes are entering the  
vehicle while driving, have the cause determined  
and corrected immediately. If you must drive under  
these conditions, drive only with at least one  
window fully open.  
Emission control  
221  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
 
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Starter switch  
222  
Starter switch  
1 Most electrical consumers can be operated. For  
detailed information see respective subjects.  
2 Driving position.  
Gear selector lever is unlocked.  
3 Starting position.  
See page 227 for instructions on starting and turning off  
the engine.  
See page 44 for instructions on the simultaneous use of  
the electronic key and the KEYLESS-GO-function.  
Warning!  
When leaving the vehicle always remove the  
electronic key from the starter switch, take the  
KEYLESS-GO-card (if so equipped) with you and  
lock the vehicle. Do not leave children unattended  
in the vehicle, or with access to an unlocked  
vehicle. Unsupervised use of vehicle equipment  
may cause serious personal injury.  
0 The electronic key can be withdrawn in this position  
only. The electronic key can be removed only with  
the selector lever in position “P”. After removing the  
electronic key or with the electronic key in starter  
switch position 0 or 1 the selector lever is locked in  
position “P”.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Important!  
Notes:  
A warning sounds when the driver’s door is opened  
with the electronic key in starter switch position 1 or 0.  
If the electronic key is left in the starter switch  
position 0 for an extended period of time, it can no  
longer be turned in the lock. In this case, remove  
electronic key from starter switch and reinsert.  
With the engine at idle speed, the charging rate of the  
alternator (output) is limited.  
It is therefore recommended that you turn off  
unnecessary electrical consumers while driving in stop-  
and-go traffic. This precaution helps to avoid draining of  
the battery.  
Caution!  
To prevent accelerated battery discharge and a possible  
dead battery, always remove the electronic key from the  
starter switch. Do not leave the electronic key in starter  
switch position 0.  
Unnecessary strain on the battery and charging system  
may be minimized by turning off the following power  
consumers, for example:  
Heated seats, rear window defroster. In addition, the  
automatic climate air volume control should be set to  
the lowest position.  
Starter switch  
223  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Starter switch — KEYLESS-GO  
224  
Start-/Stop button (vehicles with KEYLESS-GO)  
Warning!  
When leaving the vehicle always take the electronic  
key and the KEYLESS-GO-card with you, and lock  
the vehicle. Do not leave children unattended in the  
vehicle, or with access to an unlocked vehicle.  
Unsupervised use of vehicle equipment may cause  
serious personal injury.  
Pressing the start-/stop button (1) on the gear selector  
lever without depressing the brake pedal will  
sequentially activate the starter switch positions 1 (on)  
and 2 (operation) and 0 (off).  
The engine can be started with the starter switch in any  
position (on, operation or off), as long as the gear  
selector lever is in position “P” or “N” and the brake  
pedal depressed.  
See page 227 for instructions on starting and turning off  
the engine.  
See page 44 for instructions on the simultaneous use of  
the electronic key and the KEYLESS-GO-function.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
“On” position (starter switch position 1, see page 222).  
Most electrical consumers can be operated. For detailed  
information see respective subjects.  
Important!  
For the KEYLESS-GO-system to function properly, the  
operator should observe the following:  
If the KEYLESS-GO-card is positioned farther away  
from the vehicle (e.g. inside clothing or a briefcase),  
the vehicle cannot be locked (see page 40) or started  
with the start-/stop button (see page 227).  
Operation/driving position (starter switch position 2,  
see page 222).  
All electrical consumers can be operated. Gear selector  
is unlocked.  
If the KEYLESS-GO-card is removed from the vehicle  
while the engine is running, or by placing the card  
in front of the center armrest (see page 190), the  
message “CHIP-CARD – NOT RECOGNIZED!” will  
appear repeatedly while driving in the  
“Off” position (electronic key removable from starter  
switch).  
Most electrical consumers cannot be operated.  
The selector lever is locked in position “P”.  
multifunction display, see page 38.  
Notes:  
For improved recognition of the KEYLESS-GO-card the  
doors should be closed when pressing the start-/stop  
button.  
The gear selector lever can only be moved with the  
vehicle battery charged and connected, and the starter  
switch in the Operation position. With the gear selector  
lever in position “P”, the brake pedal must also be  
depressed.  
Starter switch — KEYLESS-GO  
225  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Starter switch — KEYLESS-GO  
226  
Do not forget, the engine can be started by anyone if  
Notes:  
a KEYLESS-GO-card is left inside the vehicle.  
With the engine at idle speed, the charging rate of the  
alternator (output) is limited.  
To be able to operate the vehicle in the case of a  
malfunction in the KEYLESS-GO-system (e.g. strong  
radio frequency disturbance), we recommend that  
you carry the electronic key plus mechanical key  
with you and keep them in a safe place so that they  
are always handy. Never leave the electronic key in  
the vehicle.  
It is therefore recommended that you turn off  
unnecessary electrical consumers while driving in stop-  
and-go traffic. This precaution helps to avoid draining of  
the battery.  
Unnecessary strain on the battery and charging system  
may be minimized by turning off the following power  
consumers, for example:  
To avoid radio transmission interference, never store  
the KEYLESS-GO-card together with other electronic  
items (e.g. cellular telephones, other KEYLESS-GO-  
cards) or metallic objects (e.g. coins, metal foil).  
Heated seats, rear window defroster. In addition, the  
automatic climate air volume control should be set to  
the lowest position.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Starting and turning off the engine  
Before starting  
After several unsuccessful attempts, have the system  
checked at the nearest authorized Mercedes-Benz  
Center.  
Ensure that parking brake is engaged and that selector  
lever is in position “P” or “N”.  
Important!  
Due to the installed starter non-repeat feature, the  
electronic key must be turned completely to the left  
before attempting to start the engine again.  
Starting  
Important!  
Starting the engine with KEYLESS-GO:  
Note:  
In areas where temperatures frequently drop below -4°F  
(-20°C) we recommend that an engine block heater be  
installed. Your authorized Mercedes-Benz Center will  
advise you on this subject.  
For improved recognition of the chip card the doors  
should be closed when pressing the start-/stop button.  
Depress brake pedal during the starting procedure.  
Starting the engine with electronic key:  
Do not depress accelerator.  
Briefly press start-/stop button on gear selector lever.  
The starter will engage until the engine is running.  
Turn electronic key in starter switch to position 2.  
Briefly turn electronic key in starter switch clockwise to  
the stop and release. The starter will engage until the  
engine is running.  
If engine will not run, and the starting procedure stops,  
press start-/stop button on gear selector lever and repeat  
starting the engine.  
After several unsuccessful attempts, have the system  
checked at the nearest authorized Mercedes-Benz  
Center.  
If engine will not run, and the starting procedure stops,  
turn electronic key completely to the left and repeat  
starting the engine.  
Starting and turning off the engine  
227  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
         
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Starting and turning off the engine  
Turning off  
228  
Note:  
The engine can only be turned off with selector lever in  
position “P”. If attempting to turn off the engine while  
the selector lever is in any other position than “P” a  
signal sounds and the message “SELECTOR LEVER  
TO P” appears in the multifunction display as a  
reminder to move the selector to position “P”.  
Turning off the engine with electronic key:  
Put the selector lever in position “P” and turn the  
electronic key in the starter switch to position 0 to stop  
the engine.  
The electronic key can only be removed with the  
selector lever in position “P”.  
Turning off the engine with KEYLESS-GO:  
Stop the vehicle and put the selector lever in  
position “P”.  
Press start-/stop button on the selector lever until the  
engine stops. With the driver’s door closed the starter  
switch is set to the “On” position (starter switch  
position 1). With the driver’s door opened the starter  
switch is set to the “Off” position (starter switch  
position 0, same as electronic key removed from starter  
switch).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Automatic transmission  
The automatic transmission selects individual gears  
automatically, dependent upon  
Selector lever position, see page 232  
Program mode selector, see page 236  
Accelerator position  
Vehicle speed  
The gear shifting process is continuously adapted,  
dependent on the driving style, the driving situation  
and the road characteristics.  
Important!  
When parking the vehicle or before working on the  
vehicle with the engine running, firmly depress the  
parking brake pedal and shift the selector lever into “P”.  
Automatic transmission  
229  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
 
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Automatic transmission  
Driving  
230  
Important!  
The selector lever is automatically locked while in  
position “P”. To move the selector lever out of  
position “P”, the service brake pedal must be firmly  
depressed before the shift lock will release.  
After selecting any driving position from “N” or “P”,  
wait a moment to allow the gear to fully engage before  
accelerating, especially when the engine is cold.  
Shift selector lever to the desired position only when the  
engine is idling normally and the service brake is  
applied. Do not release the brake until ready to drive.  
The vehicle may otherwise start creeping when the  
selector lever is in drive or reverse position.  
Accelerator position  
Partial throttle = early upshifting = normal acceleration  
Full throttle = later upshifting = rapid acceleration  
Kickdown (depressing the accelerator beyond full  
throttle) = downshifting to a lower gear = maximum  
acceleration. Once the desired speed is attained, ease up  
on the accelerator — the transmission shifts up again.  
Warning!  
It is dangerous to shift the selector lever out of “P”  
or “N” if the engine speed is higher than idle speed.  
If your foot is not firmly on the brake pedal, the  
vehicle could accelerate quickly forward on in  
reverse. You could lose control of the vehicle and  
hit someone or something. Only shift into gear  
when the engine is idling normally and when your  
right foot is firmly on the brake pedal.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Stopping  
Rocking a vehicle free in this manner may cause the  
ABS or traction system malfunction indicator lamp to  
come on. Turn off and restart the engine to clear the  
malfunction indication.  
For brief stops, e.g. at traffic lights, leave the  
transmission in gear and hold vehicle with the service  
brake.  
For longer stops with the engine idling, shift into “N”  
or “P” and hold the vehicle with the service brake.  
Warning!  
Getting out of your vehicle with the selector lever  
not fully engaged in position “P” is dangerous.  
Also, when parked on an incline, position “P” alone  
may not prevent your vehicle from moving,  
possibly hitting people or objects.  
When stopping the vehicle on an uphill gradient, do not  
hold it with the accelerator, use the brake. This avoids  
unnecessary transmission heat build up.  
Always set the parking brake in addition to shifting  
to position “P”, see page 238 for parking brake.  
Maneuvering  
To maneuver in tight areas, e.g. when pulling into a  
parking space, control the vehicle speed by gradually  
releasing the brakes. Accelerate gently and never  
abruptly step on the accelerator.  
When parked on an incline, also turn front wheel  
against curb.  
Warning!  
To rock a vehicle out of soft ground (mud or snow),  
alternately shift from forward to reverse, while applying  
slight partial throttle.  
When leaving the vehicle always remove the  
electronic key from the starter switch, take the  
KEYLESS-GO-card (if so equipped) with you and  
lock the vehicle. Do not leave children unattended  
in the vehicle, or with access to an unlocked  
vehicle. Children could move the gear selector lever  
from position “P”, which could result in an  
accident or serious injury.  
Automatic transmission  
231  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Automatic transmission  
Selector lever position  
232  
Park position  
The park position is to be used when parking the  
vehicle. Engage only with the vehicle stopped.  
The park position is not intended to serve as a  
brake when the vehicle is parked. Rather, the  
driver should always use the parking brake in  
addition to placing the selector lever in park to  
secure the vehicle.  
Note:  
The electronic key can only be removed from the  
starter switch with the selector lever in  
position “P”. With the electronic key removed, the  
selector lever is locked in position “P”.  
Reverse gear  
The current selector lever position is indicated in the  
gear range indicator display. The automatic gear  
shifting process can be adapted to specific operating  
conditions using the selector lever.  
Shift to reverse gear only with the vehicle  
stopped.  
Dependent on the program mode selector switch  
position “S” or “W” the maximum speed in the  
reverse gear is different. However, it is not  
possible to change the program mode while in  
reverse.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Neutral  
Gear selection for special circumstances  
No power is transmitted from the engine to the  
drive axle. When the brakes are released, the  
vehicle can be moved freely (pushed or towed). Do  
not engage “N” while driving except to coast  
when the vehicle is in danger of skidding (e.g. on  
icy roads, see page 246 for winter driving  
instructions).  
The transmission gear ranges for special circumstances  
can be selected by pressing the selector lever to the  
right or the left with the selector lever in position “D”.  
The gear range currently selected is indicated in the  
instrument cluster display.  
Briefly press selector lever in the ç direction:  
The transmission downshifts, one gear at a time, in the  
order “4”, “3”, “2”, “1”.  
Important!  
Coasting the vehicle, or driving for any other  
reason with selector lever in “N” can result in  
transmission damage that is not covered by the  
Mercedes-Benz Limited Warranty.  
Press and hold selector lever in the ç direction:  
The selector lever position display will switch to the  
gear range currently selected by the automatic  
transmission.  
The transmission automatically upshifts through  
5th gear. Position “D” provides optimum driving  
characteristics under all normal operating  
conditions.  
The transmission will only shift down one gear if the  
gear range currently selected has already shifted to its  
highest possible gear.  
Briefly press selector lever in the æ direction:  
The transmission will shift from the current gear range  
to the next higher gear range. If the transmission is  
already in gear range “D”, an additional upshift of one  
gear is possible.  
Automatic transmission  
233  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Automatic transmission  
234  
Press and hold selector lever in the æ direction:  
The transmission will shift from the current gear  
directly to gear range “D”.  
The delayed upshift is effective with vehicle speeds  
below 31 mph (50 km/h) at partial throttle and engine  
temperatures below 95°F (35°C).  
To avoid overrevving the engine when the selector lever  
is moved to a lower gear range, the transmission will not  
shift to a lower gear, if the engine’s revolutions per  
minute limit would be exceeded. In this case there will  
be no downshift, even when the vehicle speed reaches  
the engine’s rpm limit of that gear, e.g. by applying the  
service brakes.  
Warning!  
On slippery road surfaces, never downshift in order  
to obtain braking action. This could result in drive  
wheel slip and reduced vehicle control. Your  
vehicle’s ABS will not prevent this type of loss of  
control.  
To prevent the engine from laboring at low RPM when  
driving uphill gradients or with your vehicle heavily  
loaded, the automatic transmission will downshift when  
necessary to maintain engine RPM within the best  
torque range.  
Important!  
With transmission in gear range “D”, “4” or “3”,  
upshifting from 1st to 2nd to 3rd gear is delayed  
depending on vehicle speed and engine temperature.  
This allows the catalytic converter to heat up more  
quickly to operating temperatures.  
During the brief warm-up period this delayed upshift  
and increased engine noise might be perceived as a  
malfunction. However, neither the engine nor  
transmission are negatively affected by this mode of  
operation.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Gear ranges:  
Upshift through 4th gear only. Suitable for  
Upshift through 2nd gear only. For driving in  
mountainous regions or under extreme operating  
conditions. This gear selection will allow use of  
the engine’s braking power when descending  
steep grades.  
performance driving.  
Upshift through 3rd gear only. Suitable for  
moderately steep hills. Since the transmission  
does not shift higher than 3rd gear, this gear  
selection will allow use of the engine’s braking  
power downhill.  
Use this position, which makes maximum use of  
the engine’s braking effect, while descending  
very steep or lengthy downgrades and only at  
speeds below 40 mph (60 km/h).  
Automatic transmission  
235  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Automatic transmission  
Program mode selector switch  
236  
S
Standard mode  
Press switch on symbol “S”. Use this mode for all  
regular driving.  
The vehicle starts out in 1st gear.  
Accelerator Operation:  
Fast on = depressing the accelerator pedal quickly  
(not into kickdown position) while driving  
continuously, rather than depressing the  
accelerator pedal in the usual manner, will cause  
the automatic transmission to shift down into a  
lower gear. This gear shifting process is  
dependent on the current vehicle speed.  
Fast off = there will be no upshift when releasing  
the accelerator pedal quickly, e.g. using the  
engine’s braking power during performance  
driving.  
The transmission is provided with a selector switch (1)  
for Standard “S” and Winter/Wet (snow and ice) “W”  
program modes.  
The program mode currently selected is indicated in the  
gear range indicator display.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
W
Winter/Wet (snow and ice) mode  
Emergency operation  
(Limp home mode)  
Press switch on symbol “W”. The vehicle starts  
out in 2nd gear, except with selector lever in 1st  
gear, or with accelerator pedal in kick-down  
position.  
If vehicle acceleration worsens or the transmission no  
longer shifts, the transmission is most likely operating  
in Limp Home Mode which engages when there is a  
malfunction of the transmission. This condition may be  
accompanied by the “CHECK ENGINE” malfunction  
indicator lamp in the instrument cluster coming on.  
The “W” mode helps to improve traction and  
driving stability of the vehicle.  
The gear shifting process occurs at lower vehicle  
and engine speeds than in the “S” program mode.  
In this mode only the 2nd gear or reverse gear can be  
activated.  
Caution!  
To engage 2nd gear or reverse:  
Never change the program mode when the selector lever  
is out of position “P”. It could result in a change of  
driving characteristics for which you may not be  
prepared.  
1. Stop the vehicle.  
2. Move selector lever to position “P”.  
3. Turn off the engine.  
4. Wait approx. 10 seconds.  
5. Restart the engine.  
Important!  
Always be certain of the program mode selected since  
the vehicle driving characteristics change with the  
selection of the program mode.  
6. Move selector lever to position “D” (for 2nd gear), or  
move selector lever to position “R” (for reverse gear).  
Dependent on the program mode selector switch  
position “S” or “W” and the gear selector lever in  
position “R”, the ratio of power transmission changes.  
Have the transmission checked at your authorized  
Mercedes-Benz Center as soon as possible.  
Automatic transmission  
237  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
 
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Parking brake  
238  
Parking brake  
To engage, firmly depress parking brake pedal. When  
the electronic key is in starter switch position 2, the  
brake warning lamp in the instrument cluster should  
come on brightly.  
To release the parking brake, pull handle on instrument  
panel. The brake warning lamp in the instrument  
cluster should go out.  
A warning sounds and the parking brake warning  
message (see page 302) appears in the multifunction  
display, if you start to drive without having released the  
parking brake.  
Also see brake warning lamp on page 292.  
Warning!  
When leaving the vehicle always remove the  
electronic key from the starter switch, take the  
KEYLESS-GO-card (if so equipped) with you and  
lock the vehicle. Do not leave children unattended  
in the vehicle, or with access to an unlocked  
vehicle. Children could release the parking brake,  
which could result in an accident or serious injury.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Driving instructions  
Drinking and driving  
Warning!  
Drive sensibly – save fuel  
Drinking or taking drugs and driving can be a very  
dangerous combination. Even a small amount of  
alcohol or drugs can affect your reflexes,  
perceptions and judgement.  
Fuel consumption, to a great extent, depends on driving  
habits and operating conditions.  
To save fuel you should:  
The possibility of a serious or even fatal accident is  
sharply increased when you drink or take drugs  
and drive.  
keep tires at the recommended inflation pressures.  
remove unnecessary loads,  
remove roof rack when not in use,  
allow engine to warm up under low load use,  
avoid frequent acceleration and deceleration,  
Please don’t drink or take drugs and drive or allow  
anyone to drive after drinking or taking drugs.  
have all maintenance work performed at regular  
intervals by an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center.  
Fuel consumption is also increased by driving in cold  
weather, in stop-and-go traffic, on short trips and in hilly  
country.  
Driving instructions  
239  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
     
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Driving instructions  
Pedals  
240  
Brakes  
Warning!  
Warning!  
Keep driver’s foot area clear at all times. Objects  
stored in this area may impair pedal movement.  
After driving in heavy rain for some time without  
applying the brakes or through water deep enough  
to wet brake components, the first braking action  
may be somewhat reduced and increased pedal  
pressure may be necessary to obtain expected  
braking effect. Be sure to maintain a safe distance  
from vehicles in front.  
Power assistance  
Warning!  
When the engine is not running, the brake and  
steering systems are without power assistance.  
Under these circumstances, a much greater effort is  
necessary to stop or steer the vehicle.  
Resting your foot on the brake pedal will cause  
excessive and premature wear of the brake pads.  
It can also result in the brakes overheating thereby  
significantly reducing their effectiveness. It may  
not be possible to stop the vehicle in sufficient time  
to avoid an accident.  
The condition of the parking brake system is checked  
each time the vehicle is in the shop for the required  
maintenance service.  
If the parking brake is released and the brake warning  
lamp in the instrument cluster stays on, the brake fluid  
level in the reservoir is too low.  
Brake pad wear or a leak in the system may be the  
reason for low brake fluid in the reservoir.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Have the brake system inspected at an authorized  
Mercedes-Benz Center immediately.  
Caution!  
When driving down long and steep grades, relieve the  
load on the brakes by shifting into a lower gear to use  
the engine’s braking power. This helps prevent  
All checks and service work on the brake system should  
be carried out by an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center.  
overheating of the brakes and reduces brake pad wear.  
Install only brake pads and brake fluid recommended by  
Mercedes-Benz.  
After hard braking, it is advisable to drive on for some  
time, rather than immediately parking, so the air stream  
will cool down the brakes faster.  
Warning!  
If other than recommended brake pads are  
installed, or other than recommended brake fluid  
is used, the braking properties of the vehicle can be  
degraded to an extent that safe braking is  
substantially impaired. This could result in an  
accident.  
Driving off  
Apply the service brakes to test them briefly after  
driving off. Perform this procedure only when the road  
is clear of other traffic.  
Warm up the engine smoothly. Do not place full load on  
the engine until the operating temperature has been  
reached.  
When starting off on a slippery surface, do not allow one  
drive wheel to spin for an extended period with the ESP  
switched off. Doing so may cause serious damage to the  
drive train which is not covered by the Mercedes-Benz  
Limited Warranty.  
Driving instructions  
241  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
 
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Driving instructions  
Parking  
242  
Important!  
It is advisable to set the parking brake whenever  
parking or leaving the vehicle. In addition, move  
selector lever to position “P”.  
Warning!  
To reduce the risk of personal injury as a result of  
vehicle movement, before turning off the engine  
and leaving the vehicle always:  
When parking on hills, always set the parking brake.  
1. Keep right foot on service brake pedal.  
2. Firmly depress parking brake pedal.  
3. Move the selector lever to position “P”.  
4. Slowly release service brake pedal.  
5. Turn front wheels towards the road curb.  
6. Turn the electronic key to starter switch  
position 0 and remove, or press start-/stop  
button (vehicles with KEYLESS-GO).  
7. Take the electronic key and the KEYLESS-GO-  
card (vehicles with KEYLESS-GO) and lock  
vehicle when leaving.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Tires  
Warning!  
Do not allow your tires to wear down too far. As  
tread depth approaches 1/16 in (1.5 mm), the  
adhesion properties on a wet road are sharply  
reduced.  
Warning!  
If you feel a sudden significant vibration or ride  
disturbance, or you suspect that possible damage to  
your vehicle has occurred, you should turn on the  
hazard warning flashers, carefully slow down, and  
drive with caution to an area which is a safe  
distance from the roadway.  
Depending upon the weather and/or road surface  
(conditions), the tire traction varies widely.  
Specified tire pressures must be maintained. This  
applies particularly if the tires are subjected to high  
loads (e.g. high speeds, heavy loads, high ambient  
temperatures).  
Inspect the tires and under the vehicle for possible  
damage. If the vehicle or tires appear unsafe, have  
it towed to the nearest Mercedes-Benz Center or  
tire dealer for repairs.  
Warning!  
Tread wear indicators (TWI) are required by law. These  
indicators are located in six places on the tread  
circumference and become visible at a tread depth of  
approximately 1/16 in (1.5 mm), at which point the tire is  
considered worn and should be replaced.  
Do not drive with a flat tire. A flat tire affects the  
ability to steer or brake the vehicle. You may lose  
control of the vehicle. Continued driving with a flat  
tire or driving at high speed with a flat tire will  
cause excessive heat build-up and possibly a fire.  
The tread wear indicator appears as a solid band across  
the tread.  
Driving instructions  
243  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
 
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Driving instructions  
Aquaplaning  
244  
Warning!  
Depending on the depth of the water layer on the road,  
aquaplaning may occur, even at low speeds and with  
new tires. Reduce vehicle speed, avoid track grooves in  
the road and apply brakes cautiously in the rain.  
If ice has formed on the road, tire traction will be  
substantially reduced. Under such weather  
conditions, drive, steer and brake with extreme  
caution.  
Tire traction  
We recommend M+S rated radial-ply tires for the winter  
season for all four wheels to insure normal balanced  
handling characteristics. On packed snow, they can  
reduce your stopping distance as compared with  
summer tires. Stopping distance, however, is still  
considerably greater than when the road is not snow or  
ice covered.  
The safe speed on a wet, snow covered or icy road is  
always lower than on a dry road.  
You should pay particular attention to the condition of  
the road whenever the outside temperatures are close to  
the freezing point.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Tire speed rating  
Exceeding the maximum speed for which tires are  
rated can lead to sudden tire failure causing loss of  
vehicle control and resulting in personal injury  
and possible death.  
CL 500 and CL 600:  
Your vehicle is factory equipped with “H”-rated tires,  
which have a speed rating of 130 mph (210 km/h).  
Vehicles with Sport Package:  
Your vehicle is factory equipped with “Y”-rated tires,  
which have a speed rating of 188 mph (300 km/h).  
Snow chains  
Use only snow chains that are tested and recommended  
by Mercedes-Benz. Your authorized Mercedes-Benz  
Center will be glad to advise you on this subject.  
An electronic speed limiter prevents your vehicle from  
exceeding a speed of 130 mph (210 km/h).  
Chains should only be used on the rear wheels. Follow  
the manufacturer’s mounting instructions.  
CL 55 AMG:  
Always select option I or II of the level control system  
when driving with snow chains, see page 276.  
Your vehicle is factory equipped with “Y”-rated tires,  
which have a speed rating of 188 mph (300 km/h).  
Snow chains should only be driven on snow covered  
roads at speeds not to exceed 30 mph (50 km/h).  
Remove chains as soon as possible when driving on  
roads without snow.  
An electronic speed limiter prevents your vehicle from  
exceeding a speed of 155 mph (250 km/h).  
Despite the tire rating, local speed limits should be  
obeyed. Use prudent driving speeds appropriate to  
prevailing conditions.  
When driving with snow chains, press the ESP control  
switch to OFF, refer to page 273.  
Warning!  
Important!  
Even when permitted by law, never operate a  
vehicle at speeds greater than the maximum speed  
rating of the tires.  
Use of snow chains is not permissible with tire sizes  
245/45 R18 or 275/40 R18.  
Driving instructions  
245  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
   
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Driving instructions  
Winter driving instructions  
246  
If the vehicle is parked after being driven on salt treated  
roads, the braking efficiency should be tested as soon as  
possible after driving is resumed while observing the  
safety rules in the previous paragraph.  
The most important rule for slippery or icy roads is to  
drive sensibly and to avoid abrupt acceleration, braking  
and steering maneuvers. Do not use the cruise control  
system under such conditions.  
Warning!  
When the vehicle is in danger of skidding, move  
selector lever to position “N”. Try to keep the vehicle  
under control by corrective steering action.  
If the vehicle becomes stuck in snow, make sure  
that snow is kept clear of the exhaust pipe and  
from around the vehicle with engine running.  
Otherwise, deadly carbon monoxide (CO) gases may  
enter vehicle interior resulting in unconsciousness  
and death.  
Road salts and chemicals can adversely affect braking  
efficiency. Increased pedal force may become necessary  
to produce the normal brake effect. We therefore  
recommend depressing the brake pedal periodically  
when traveling at length on salt-strewn roads. This can  
bring road salt impaired braking efficiency back to  
normal. A prerequisite is, however, that this be done  
without endangering other drivers on the road.  
To assure sufficient fresh air ventilation, open a  
window slightly on the side of the vehicle not  
facing the wind.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Winter driving  
Test battery: Battery capacity drops with decreasing  
ambient temperature. A well charged battery helps  
to ensure that the engine can be started, even at low  
ambient temperatures.  
Have your vehicle winterized at your authorized  
Mercedes-Benz Center before the onset of winter.  
Change the engine oil if the engine contains an oil  
which is not approved for winter operation. For  
viscosity (SAE/CCMC class) and filling quantity,  
see page 395.  
Tires: We recommend M+S rated radial-ply tires on  
all four wheels for the winter season. Observe  
permissible maximum speed for M+S rated  
radial-ply tires and the legal speed limit.  
Check engine coolant anticorrosion/antifreeze  
concentration.  
In winter operation, the maximum effectiveness of the  
ABS and ESP can only be achieved with M+S rated  
radial-ply tires and/or snow chains recommended by  
Mercedes-Benz. Snow chains maximize performance.  
Additive for the windshield washer and headlamp  
cleaning system: Add MB Concentrate “S” to a  
premixed windshield washer solvent/antifreeze  
which is formulated for below freezing  
temperatures, see page 334.  
Driving instructions  
247  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
     
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Driving instructions  
Deep water  
248  
Passenger compartment  
Warning!  
Caution!  
Always fasten items being carried as securely as  
possible.  
Do not drive through flooded areas or water of unknown  
depth.  
In an accident, during hard braking or sudden  
maneuvers, loose items will be thrown around  
inside the vehicle, and cause injury to vehicle  
occupants unless the items are securely fastened in  
the vehicle.  
If you must drive through deep water, drive slowly to  
prevent water from entering the engine compartment or  
passenger compartment, being ingested by the air  
intake, possibly causing damage to electrical  
components or wiring, to engine or transmission that is  
not covered by the Mercedes-Benz Limited Warranty.  
The trunk is the preferred place to carry objects.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Block heater (Canada only)  
Traveling abroad  
Abroad, there is a widely-spread Mercedes-Benz service  
network at your disposal. If you plan to travel into areas  
which are not listed in the index of your Mercedes-Benz  
Center directory, you should request pertinent  
information from your authorized Mercedes-Benz  
Center.  
The engine is equipped with a block heater.  
The electrical cable may be installed at your authorized  
Mercedes-Benz Center.  
Driving in countries with left-hand traffic requires the  
headlamps to be switched over accordingly, see  
page 362.  
Driving instructions  
249  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
   
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Driving systems  
250  
Cruise control  
2 Decelerate and set:  
Depress lever briefly to set speed.  
Hold lever down to decelerate.  
1
Normally the vehicle is accelerated to the desired  
speed with the accelerator.  
Speed is set by briefly pushing the lever to  
position 1 or 2. The accelerator can then be  
released.  
3
The selected speed is shown for approx. 5 seconds  
in the multifunction display, and the corresponding  
speedometer segments from the selected speed to  
the vehicle maximum speed are illuminated.  
4
2
The speed can be increased (e.g. for passing) by  
using the accelerator. After the accelerator is  
released, the previously set speed will be resumed  
automatically.  
The cruise control allows you to drive in a more relaxed  
manner, for example over long distances, as it  
automatically maintains the set speed by actively  
regulating the throttle setting.  
If a set speed is to be increased or decreased  
slightly, e.g. to adapt to the traffic flow, hold lever in  
position 1 or 2 until the desired speed is reached, or  
briefly tip the lever in the appropriate direction for  
increases or decreases in 0.6 mph (1 km/h)  
increments. When the lever is released, the newly  
set speed remains.  
Any given speed above approximately 25 mph  
(40 km/h) can be maintained with the cruise control by  
operating the lever.  
1 Accelerate and set:  
Lift lever briefly to set speed. Hold lever up to  
accelerate.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
3 Canceling  
4 Resume  
If the lever is briefly pushed to position 4 when  
To cancel the cruise control, briefly push lever to  
position 3.  
driving at a speed exceeding approx. 25 mph  
(40 km/h), the vehicle resumes the speed which  
was set prior to the cancellation of the cruise  
control.  
When you step on the brake pedal or the vehicle  
speed drops below approx. 25 mph (40 km/h), for  
example when driving upgrade, the cruise control  
will be canceled.  
The selected speed is shown for approx. 5 seconds  
in the multifunction display, and the corresponding  
speedometer segments from the selected speed to  
the vehicle maximum speed are illuminated.  
If the illuminated speedometer segments begin to  
blink (e.g. when aquaplaning or when moving the  
gear selector lever to position “N” while driving), the  
cruise control is automatically switched off.  
The last memorized speed is canceled when the  
electronic key in the starter switch is turned to  
position 1 or 0.  
If the cruise control cancels by itself and remains  
inoperative until the engine is restarted, have the  
system checked at your authorized Mercedes-Benz  
Center as soon as possible.  
Important!  
Moving gear selector lever to position “N” switches the  
cruise control off.  
Driving systems  
251  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Driving systems  
252  
Notes:  
Warning!  
If the engine does not brake the vehicle sufficiently  
while driving on a downgrade, the speed you set on the  
cruise control may be exceeded. In this case the  
automatic transmission shifts down (max. to 3rd gear)  
to maintain the set cruise control speed by using the  
engine’s braking power.  
Only use the cruise control if the traffic and  
weather conditions make it advisable to travel at a  
steady speed.  
• The use of cruise control can be dangerous on  
winding roads or in heavy traffic because  
conditions do not allow safe driving at a steady  
speed.  
As soon as the grade eases, the automatic transmission  
shifts up again dependent on the selector lever position.  
• The use of cruise control can be dangerous on  
slippery roads. Rapid changes in tire adhesion  
can result in wheel spin and loss of control.  
Nevertheless, in some cases you may have to step on the  
brake pedal to slow down. In this case the cruise control  
is switched off.  
The “Resume” function should only be operated if  
the driver is fully aware of the previously set speed  
and wishes to resume this particular preset speed.  
Use the lever to resume the previously set speed.  
The “CRUISE CONTROL - - -” message is displayed on  
the multifunction display when any attempt is made to  
store speeds below 25 mph (40 km/h) or when an  
attempt is made to recall a speed when no speed has  
been stored – the cruise control remains switched off.  
See malfunction and warning messages on page 297 if  
the cruise control has a malfunction.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Distronic (DTR)  
(optional)  
Any given speed between 25 mph (Canada: 30 km/h)  
and 110 mph (Canada: 180 km/h) can be maintained  
with the Distronic by operating the control lever on the  
steering column.  
When activated the Distronic system increases driving  
convenience, for example over long distances, as it  
automatically maintains a speed set by the driver by  
actively regulating the throttle setting. It also maintains  
within certain limitations a preset distance to a vehicle  
ahead.  
Warning!  
Distronic is a convenience system, its speed  
adjustment reduction capability is intended to  
make cruise control more effective and usable  
when traffic speeds vary. It is not, however,  
intended to nor does it replace the need for extreme  
care. The responsibility for the vehicle speed and  
the distance to the vehicle ahead, including most  
importantly brake operation to assure safe stopping  
distance, rests always with the driver.  
With Distronic switched off, the multifunction display  
continues to show the distance to the vehicle ahead, if  
so selected, see page 266.  
The distance notification function can be activated  
separately, see page 264.  
In Distronic mode, if the distance sensor detects a  
slower moving vehicle directly ahead, your vehicle  
speed will be reduced to the extent permitted by  
reduced throttle and up to 20% of vehicle braking power,  
so that you follow that vehicle at a preset distance, see  
page 265.  
Warning!  
Distronic requires familiarity with its operational  
characteristics. We strongly recommend that you  
review the following information carefully before  
operating the system.  
Maximum range of detection is approximately 500 ft.  
(150 m).  
Driving systems  
253  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
   
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Driving systems  
254  
Note:  
Warning!  
For operation in the USA only: This device complies  
with Part 15, Subpart C, Section 209 of the FCC Rules.  
Operation is subject to the following two conditions:  
Only use Distronic if the traffic and weather  
conditions make it advisable to travel at a steady  
speed.  
(1) This device may not cause harmful interference, and  
Use of Distronic can be dangerous on winding  
roads or in heavy traffic because conditions do not  
allow safe driving at a steady speed.  
(2) this device must accept any interference received,  
including interference that may cause undesired  
operation.  
Use of Distronic can be dangerous on slippery  
roads. Rapid changes in tire adhesion can result in  
wheel spin and loss of control.  
Any unauthorized modification to this device could void  
the user’s authority to operate the equipment  
Distronic does not act upon adverse sight distance  
conditions. Do not use Distronic during conditions  
of fog and heavy rain, snow or sleet.  
The “Resume” function should only be operated if  
the driver is fully aware of the previously set speed  
and wishes to resume this particular preset speed.  
Distronic does not recognize accordingly and will  
not react to stationary objects. It is designed and  
intended only to maintain a set speed and keep a  
set distance from moving objects in front of it.  
.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3 Canceling  
1
To cancel Distronic, briefly push lever to position 3.  
The last set speed remains stored in memory.  
4 Resume  
3
If the lever is briefly pulled to position 4 when  
driving at a speed above approx. 25 mph  
(Canada: 30 km/h), the vehicle resumes the  
speed which was selected prior to the  
cancellation of Distronic.  
4
For minor increases of speeds in increments of  
1 mph (Canada: 1 km/h) – briefly pull lever to  
position 4.  
2
The speed stored in memory is displayed in the  
multifunction display, and one or two segments around  
the stored speed light up in the speedometer dial, see  
page 267.  
The last memorized speed is canceled when the  
electronic key in the starter switch is turned to  
position 1 or 0.  
1 Accelerate and set:  
To increase the speed by 5 mph (Canada: 10 km/h) –  
briefly lift lever up.  
2 Decelerate and set:  
To reduce the speed by 5 mph (Canada: 10 km/h) –  
briefly depress lever.  
Driving systems  
255  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Driving systems  
256  
Activation of Distronic  
Speed is set by briefly moving the control lever to  
position 1 or 2.  
The stored speed is displayed in the multifunction  
display for approx. 5 seconds (see also page 266),  
and one or two segments around the stored speed  
light up on the speedometer dial (see also  
page 267).  
Remove foot from the accelerator.  
When briefly lifting the control lever to position 1,  
the vehicle speed will increase in increments of  
5 mph (Canada: 10 km/h).  
The stored speed is displayed in the multifunction  
display for approx. 5 seconds (see also page 266),  
and one or two segments around the stored speed  
light up on the speedometer dial (see also  
page 267).  
P54.70-2154-26  
Any given speed above approximately 25 mph  
(Canada: 30 km/h) can be maintained:  
Normally the vehicle is accelerated to the desired  
When briefly lowering the control lever to  
position 2, the vehicle speed will decrease in  
increments of 5 mph (Canada: 10 km/h).  
speed with the accelerator.  
The stored speed is displayed in the multifunction  
display for approx. 5 seconds (see also page 266),  
and one or two segments around the stored speed  
light up on the speedometer dial (see also  
page 267).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
For a more precise setting the speed can be  
increased in increments of 1 mph (Canada: 1 km/h)  
by briefly pulling the control lever in direction (4).  
Invalid attempts to activate  
The multifunction display will show “–––” during  
invalid attempts to activate Distronic:  
below a speed of approx. 25 mph  
Caution!  
(Canada: 30 km/h),  
If the driver’s foot is not fully removed from the  
accelerator pedal, the Distronic control system will be  
overridden and it will not regulate the preset vehicle  
speed and following distance. The vehicle speed and  
following distance will be determined only by the  
accelerator pedal position.  
while the electronic stability program (ESP) is  
switched off – ESP warning lamp v in  
speedometer dial is illuminated, see page 114,  
by moving the distronic control lever in “RESUME”  
direction (4) when no speed is stored in memory,  
during the initialization and self-test phase after the  
Warning!  
engine is started – this can take up to 2 minutes,  
Distronic brakes (up to 20% of vehicle braking  
power) the vehicle to restore the preset distance or  
to maintain the speed. The brake pedal is  
automatically retracted as this happens.  
while depressing the service brake pedal,  
while the parking brake is set – check ; warning  
lamp (Canada: !) in instrument cluster, see  
page 114,  
Keep driver’s foot area clear at all times, including  
the area under the brake pedal. Objects stored in  
this area may impair pedal movement which could  
interfere with the braking ability of the Distronic  
system.  
with the gear selector lever in position “P”, “R”  
or “N” – check gear range indicator display in  
instrument cluster, see page 114.  
Do not place your foot under the brake pedal – your  
foot could become caught.  
Driving systems  
257  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
 
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Driving systems  
258  
Deactivation of Distronic  
the gear selector lever is moved to position “N”,  
Briefly move the distronic control lever in “OFF”  
direction (3) – the stored speed remains in the memory  
until the electronic key in the starter switch is turned to  
position 1 or 0.  
the electronic stability program (ESP) is active,  
the electronic stability program (ESP) is switched off  
manually,  
Model CL 55 AMG only:  
Distronic is also deactivated if:  
the vehicle speed exceeds approximately 160 mph  
(260 km/h).  
the service brake pedal is depressed,  
the parking brake is activated,  
Note:  
the vehicle decelerates to less than approximately  
25 mph (Canada: 30 km/h), e.g. while maintaining  
the distance to the vehicle ahead.  
A signal sounds and the message “DTR OFF” appears  
for 5 seconds in the multifunction display everytime  
Distronic is deactivated.  
Warning!  
The Distronic switches off and releases the brakes  
when the vehicle decelerates below the minimum  
speed of 25 mph (Canada: 30 km/h) by operation of  
the system. At that time, the driver must apply the  
brakes in order to reduce vehicle speed further or  
bring it to a stop.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driving with Distronic activated  
from the speed of the vehicle in front up to your  
vehicle’s selected speed. See also page 266 for notes on  
the multifunction displays.  
Warning!  
Distronic brakes (up to 20% of vehicle braking  
power) the vehicle to restore the preset distance or  
to maintain the speed. The brake pedal is  
automatically retracted as this happens.  
Keep driver’s foot area clear at all times, including  
the area under the brake pedal. Objects stored in  
this area may impair pedal movement which could  
interfere with the braking ability of the Distronic  
system.  
Do not place your foot under the brake pedal – your  
foot could become caught.  
With the electronic key in starter switch position 2, the  
distance warning lamp l in the speedometer dial comes  
on and goes out with the engine running.  
If the distance sensor detects a slower vehicle moving in  
front, your vehicle speed will be reduced by  
deceleration and braking of up to 20% of the vehicle  
braking capacity, so that you follow the vehicle ahead at  
the preset distance, see page 265. Segments in the  
speedometer illuminate to indicate the speed range  
Driving systems  
259  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
 
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Driving systems  
260  
Caution!  
Warning!  
If the driver’s foot is not fully removed from the  
accelerator pedal, the Distronic control system will be  
overridden and it will not regulate the preset vehicle  
speed and following distance. The vehicle speed and  
following distance is determined only by the accelerator  
pedal position.  
A continuous warning sounds and the distance  
warning lamp in the speedometer dial is  
illuminated if the Distronic system calculates that  
the distance to the vehicle ahead and your vehicle’s  
current speed indicate that Distronic will not be  
capable of slowing the vehicle sufficiently to  
maintain the preset following distance, which  
creates a danger of a collision.  
Distronic works on steep uphill and downhill gradients  
by downshifting gears and applying the brakes to  
maintain the speed selected by the driver. The  
transmission will upshift again once the gradient evens  
out.  
Immediately brake the vehicle to increase the  
distance to the vehicle in front of you. The warning  
sound is intended as a final caution that you have  
not interceded with your own braking inputs to  
avoid a potentially dangerous situation. Do not wait  
for the operation of the warning signal to intercede  
with your own braking as that will result in  
The speed can be increased (e.g. for passing) by using  
the accelerator. After the accelerator is released, the  
previously set speed will be resumed automatically.  
potentially dangerous emergency braking which  
will not always result an impact being avoided.  
Distronic is deactivated if a vehicle in front causes your  
vehicle to slow down to less than approx. 25 mph  
(Canada: 30 km/h). A signal sounds and the message  
“DTR OFF” appears for 5 seconds in the multifunction  
display.  
Tailgating increases the risk of an accident.  
The distance warning sound continues until the driver  
activates the brake pedal, or the preset distance is  
obtained. As soon as the preset distance is obtained, the  
distance warning lamp goes out.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Additional driving hints  
Warning!  
The driver must always be on the alert and observe  
all traffic and intercede with steering and braking  
inputs as necessary.  
Distronic works to maintain the speed selected by  
the driver unless a moving obstacle proceeding  
directly ahead of it in the same travel direction is  
detected (e.g. following another vehicle ahead at a  
distance set by Distronic). This means that:  
Important!  
When starting the engine, Distronic goes through an  
initialization and self-test phase.  
The most likely cause for a malfunctioning system is  
caused by a dirty sensor (located behind the hood  
grille), especially at times of snow and ice or heavy rain.  
In such a case, Distronic will switch off, and the  
message “DISTRONIC – CLEAN SENSOR!” appears in  
the multifunction display.  
• your vehicle can pass another vehicle after you  
change lanes,  
• while in a sharp turn or if the vehicle in front  
is in a sharp turn, Distronic could lose sight of  
a vehicle traveling in front of it, then your  
vehicle could accelerate to the previously  
selected speed.  
Warning!  
Distronic regulates only the distance between your  
vehicle and those directly ahead, but does not  
register stationary objects in the roadway, e.g.:  
Distronic should not be used in snowy or icy road  
conditions.  
• a stopped vehicle in a traffic jam.  
• a disabled vehicle.  
For cleaning and care of the Distronic sensor see  
page 378.  
The following are some sample situations which may  
influence the functions of Distronic.  
• an oncoming vehicle.  
Driving systems  
261  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
   
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Driving systems  
262  
Traveling through turns or bends in the roadway may  
result in Distronic detecting a moving vehicle traveling  
in front but not in your lane of travel, causing your  
vehicle to brake late or unexpectedly. You must be  
prepared to intercede with accelerator or brake  
application as necessary.  
The Distronic system’s detection zone is relatively  
narrow at the start and becomes broader as it senses  
further from the vehicle. Thus, Distronic may not  
recognize another vehicle coming into your path close  
to the front of your vehicle. You must be prepared to  
intercede with braking or steering as necessary.  
A vehicle not traveling directly in front of you could  
cause detection problems, the actual distance to that  
vehicle really being much shorter.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
A vehicle changing lanes at close range is only  
recognized when entering the area scanned by  
Distronic. You must apply the service brakes to gain  
sufficient distance to the vehicle ahead.  
A narrow vehicle (e.g. a motorcycle) is only recognized  
when entering the area scanned by Distronic. You must  
apply the service brakes to gain sufficient distance to  
the vehicle ahead.  
Driving systems  
263  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Driving systems  
264  
Distance notification function  
Important!  
Even if Distronic is deactivated, the distance to the  
vehicle ahead continues to be measured, see page 266  
for multifunction display.  
With the Distronic switched off, only the distance  
notification function operates, meaning the vehicle does  
not slow down.  
The Distronic lamp in the speedometer dial illuminates  
to advise the driver of a situation which under normal  
braking conditions and dry surfaces should have been  
addressed by the driver.  
Warning!  
If the distance warning lamp in the speedometer  
dial lights up while driving and a continuous  
warning sounds, immediate attention on the part of  
the driver is required.  
The distance notification function can be activated  
separately, see page 265. It operates when driving at  
speeds above approx. 25 mph (Canada: 30 km/h).  
As required by the traffic situation, apply the  
service brakes and navigate around a possible  
obstacle. However, do not drive by relying on the  
distance notification function as that will result in  
an emergency braking application which,  
especially depending on road surface conditions  
and driver reaction, will not always be able to avoid  
a collision.  
When recognizing a stationary obstacle or a slower  
vehicle moving in the vehicle’s path and the danger of a  
collision exists, the distance warning lamp in the  
speedometer dial lights up and simultaneously a  
continuous warning sounds.  
Note:  
Important!  
Model CL 55 AMG only:  
Distance notification function is deactivated if the  
vehicle speed exceeds approximately 160 mph  
(260 km/h).  
Complex driving situations are not always fully  
recognized by Distronic, which could result in wrong or  
missing distance warnings.  
See page 261 for additional driving hints.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Distronic settings  
Decrease distance – turn thumbwheel (2)  
towards ®.  
Warning!  
It is up to the driver to exercise discretion to select  
the appropriate setting given road conditions,  
traffic, driver’s preferred driving style and  
applicable laws and driving recommendations for  
safe following distance.  
To switch the distance notification function on or off:  
To switch on – press upper half of switch (1).  
The indicator lamp in the switch lights up.  
To switch off – press lower half of the switch (1).  
The indicator lamp in the switch goes out.  
1 Switch – for distance notification function  
For distance notification function see page 264.  
Notes:  
2 Thumbwheel – for setting distance  
Distronic provides a safe following distance range to the  
vehicle in front. The medium setting is noticeable by a  
detent in the center position of the thumbwheel (2).  
If you want to:  
With the distance notification function activated, you  
will still be advised by a continuous audible warning if a  
potential emergency braking circumstance has been  
detected, even if Distronic has been deactivated.  
Increase distance – turn thumbwheel (2)  
The last selected notification function mode (on/off) will  
be stored in memory, even when removing the  
electronic key from the starter switch.  
towards ¯.  
Driving systems  
265  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
   
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Driving systems  
266  
Multifunction displays  
1 Distronic is deactivated. The actual distance (5) and  
the should-be distance (6) to the vehicle ahead (4)  
are displayed.  
2 Distronic is activated. The display shows the  
selected speed for approx. 5 seconds.  
4
3 Distronic is activated. The message “DTR OFF”  
appears for approx. 5 seconds when Distronic is  
being deactivated.  
7
5
6
4 Vehicle ahead.  
Only appears if a vehicle is detected ahead.  
5 Actual distance to vehicle ahead.  
6 Should-be distance to vehicle ahead (as calculated  
by Distronic).  
7 Own vehicle.  
To call up Distronic display:  
Press button è or ÿ on the multifunction  
steering wheel repeatedly until the display (1 or 3)  
appears.  
P54.30-3759-27  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Displays in the speedometer dial  
When Distronic system is activated, one or two  
segments around the speed stored in memory light up  
in the speedometer dial.  
If a vehicle is detected ahead, those segments in the  
speedometer dial light up that indicate the speed range  
from the speed of the vehicle in front up to the Distronic  
stored speed.  
When the vehicle in front can no longer be detected,  
only the segments around the stored speed light up. The  
vehicle is accelerated to the stored speed.  
Driving systems  
267  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
   
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Driving systems  
268  
Brake assist system (BAS)  
Applying the brakes very quickly results in maximum  
BAS assistance.  
Warning!  
To receive the benefit of the system you must apply  
continuous full braking power during the stopping  
sequence. Do not reduce brake pedal pressure.  
BAS cannot prevent the natural laws of physics  
from acting on the vehicle, nor can it increase  
braking efficiency beyond that afforded by the  
condition of the vehicle brakes and tires or the  
traction afforded. The BAS cannot prevent  
accidents, including those resulting from excessive  
speed in turns, following another vehicle too  
closely, or aquaplaning. Only a safe, attentive, and  
skillful driver can prevent accidents. The  
capabilities of a BAS equipped vehicle must never  
be exploited in a reckless or dangerous manner  
which could jeopardize the user’s safety or the  
safety of others.  
Once the brake pedal is released, the BAS is deactivated.  
If the BAS warning message is displayed, a malfunction  
has been detected in the system. The brake system  
functions in the usual manner, but without BAS.  
With the ABS malfunctioning, the BAS is also switched  
off.  
If a BAS warning message is displayed, have the BAS  
checked at your authorized Mercedes-Benz Center as  
soon as possible.  
The BAS is designed to maximize the vehicle’s braking  
capability during emergency braking maneuvers by  
having maximum power boost applied to the brakes  
more quickly in emergency braking conditions than  
might otherwise be afforded solely by the driver’s  
braking style. This can help reduce braking distances  
over what ordinary driving and braking style might do.  
The BAS complements the antilock brake system (ABS).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Antilock brake system (ABS)  
Warning!  
At the instant one of the wheels is about to lock up, a  
slight pulsation can be felt in the brake pedal,  
indicating that the ABS is in the regulating mode. Keep  
firm and steady pressure on the brake pedal while  
experiencing the pulsation.  
Do not pump the brake pedal, rather use firm,  
steady brake pedal pressure. Pumping the brake  
pedal defeats the purpose for ABS and significantly  
reduces braking effectiveness.  
Continuous steady brake pedal pressure results in  
applying the advantages of the ABS, namely braking  
power and ability to steer the vehicle.  
Important!  
In the case of an emergency brake maneuver keep  
continuous full pressure on the brake pedal. In this  
manner only can the ABS be most effective.  
The ABS improves steering control of the vehicle during  
hard braking maneuvers.  
On slippery road surfaces, the ABS will respond even  
with light brake pedal pressure because of the  
increased likelihood of locking wheels. The pulsating  
brake pedal can be an indication of hazardous road  
conditions and functions as a reminder to take extra  
care while driving.  
The ABS prevents the wheels from locking up above a  
vehicle speed of approximately 5 mph (8 km/h)  
independent of road surface conditions.  
Driving systems  
269  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
 
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Driving systems  
ABS control  
If the ABS malfunction indicator lamp stays illuminated,  
have the system checked at your authorized  
Mercedes-Benz Center as soon as possible.  
The ABS malfunction indicator lamp - in the  
instrument cluster comes on with the electronic key in  
starter switch position 2 and should go out with the  
engine running.  
Warning!  
ABS cannot prevent the natural laws of physics  
from acting on the vehicle, nor can it increase  
braking or steering efficiency beyond that afforded  
by the condition of the vehicle brakes and tires or  
the traction afforded. The ABS cannot prevent  
accidents, including those resulting from excessive  
speed in turns, following another vehicle too  
closely, or aquaplaning. Only a safe, attentive, and  
skillful driver can prevent accidents. The  
capabilities of a ABS equipped vehicle must never  
be exploited in a reckless or dangerous manner  
which could jeopardize the user’s safety or the  
safety of others.  
When the ABS malfunction indicator lamp in the  
instrument cluster comes on while the engine is  
running, it indicates that the ABS has detected a  
malfunction and has switched off. In this case, the brake  
system functions in the usual manner, but without  
antilock assistance.  
For ABS malfunction indicator lamp, see page 294.  
With the ABS malfunctioning, the BAS and ESP are also  
switched off. Both malfunction indicator lamps come on  
with the engine running.  
If the charging voltage falls below 10 volts, the  
malfunction indicator lamp comes on and the ABS is  
switched off. When the voltage is above this value again,  
the malfunction indicator lamp should go out and the  
ABS is operational.  
Note:  
To alert following vehicles to slippery road conditions  
you discover, operate your hazard warning flashers as  
appropriate.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Electronic stability program (ESP)  
Warning!  
Important!  
If the ESP warning lamp v flashes:  
During take-off apply as little throttle as possible.  
While driving ease up on the accelerator.  
ESP cannot prevent the natural laws of physics  
from acting on the vehicle, nor can it increase the  
traction afforded. The ESP cannot prevent  
accidents, including those resulting from excessive  
speed in turns, or aquaplaning. Only a safe,  
attentive, and skillful driver can prevent accidents.  
The capabilities of an ESP equipped vehicle must  
never be exploited in a reckless or dangerous  
manner which could jeopardize the user’s safety or  
the safety of others.  
Adapt your speed and driving to the prevailing road  
conditions.  
Do not switch off the ESP.  
Caution!  
If the vehicle is towed with the front axle raised (see  
page 351, towing the vehicle), the engine must be shut  
off (electronic key in starter switch position 0 or 1).  
Otherwise, the ESP will immediately be engaged and  
will apply the rear wheel brakes.  
The ESP enhances directional control and reduces  
driving wheel spin of the vehicle under various driving  
conditions.  
Over/understeering of the vehicle is counteracted by  
applying brakes to the appropriate wheel to create a  
countervailing vehicle movement. Engine torque is also  
limited. The ESP warning lamp, located in the  
speedometer dial, starts to flash when ESP is in  
operation.  
Driving systems  
271  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
 
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Driving systems  
272  
Notes:  
When testing the parking brake on a brake test  
dynamometer, the engine must be shut off. Otherwise,  
the ESP will immediately be engaged and will apply the  
rear wheel brakes.  
The yellow ESP warning lamp v in the speedometer  
dial comes on with the electronic key in starter switch  
position 2. It should go out with the engine running.  
In winter operation, the maximum effectiveness of the  
ESP is only achieved with Mercedes-Benz recommended  
M+S rated radial-ply tires and/or snow chains.  
If the ESP warning message is displayed, a malfunction  
has been detected in the system. Only partial engine  
output will be available.  
Have the ESP checked at your authorized  
Mercedes-Benz Center as soon as possible.  
Synchronizing ESP  
If the power supply was interrupted (battery  
disconnected or empty), the ESP warning message may  
be displayed with the engine running.  
For ESP warning message, see page 303.  
With the ABS malfunctioning, the ESP is also switched  
off.  
Turn steering wheel completely to the left and then to  
the right. The ESP warning message should go out.  
Driving the vehicle with varied size tires will cause the  
wheels to rotate at different speeds, therefore the ESP  
may activate (yellow ESP warning lamp in speedometer  
dial comes on). For this reason, all wheels, including the  
spare wheel, must have the same tire size.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ESP control switch  
To improve the vehicle’s traction when driving with  
snow chains, or starting off in deep snow, sand or gravel,  
switch off ESP by pressing the upper half (1) of the ESP  
switch. The ESP warning lamp v, located in the  
speedometer dial, is continuously illuminated.  
Warning!  
When the ESP warning lamp is illuminated  
continuously, the ESP is switched off.  
Adapt your speed and driving to the prevailing road  
conditions.  
With the ESP system switched off, the engine torque  
reduction feature is cancelled. Therefore, the enhanced  
vehicle stability offered by ESP is unavailable.  
ESP control switch located on center console.  
Adapt your speed and driving to the prevailing road  
conditions.  
1 Press to switch ESP off  
ESP warning lamp v, located in speedometer  
dial, comes on.  
A portion of the ESP system remains active, even with  
the switch in the OFF position.  
If one drive wheel loses traction and begins to spin, the  
brake is applied until the wheel regains sufficient  
traction. The traction control engages at vehicle speeds  
up to approximately 24 mph (40 km/h), and switches off  
at 50 mph (80 km/h).  
2 Press to switch ESP on  
ESP warning lamp v, located in speedometer  
dial, goes out.  
Driving systems  
273  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
   
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Driving systems  
274  
Notes:  
Vehicles with Distronic (DTR):  
With the ESP switched off, the Distronic could not be  
switched on. See page 253 for activation of Distronic.  
Avoid spinning of one drive wheel. This may cause  
serious damage to the drive train which is not covered  
by the Mercedes-Benz Limited Warranty.  
Warning!  
The ESP warning lamp, located in the speedometer dial,  
starts to flash at any vehicle speed as soon as the tires  
lose traction and the wheels begin to spin.  
ESP should not be switched off during normal  
driving other than in circumstances described  
above. Disabling of the system will reduce vehicle  
stability in standard driving maneuvers.  
To return to the enhanced vehicle stability offered by  
ESP: press lower half (2) of the switch (the ESP warning  
lamp in the speedometer dial goes out).  
Important!  
If the ESP warning lamp flashes:  
during take-off, apply as little throttle as possible,  
while driving, ease up on the accelerator.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Active body control (ABC)  
The maximum suspension range is selected  
automatically according to the selected ABC  
mode (1 or 2), road condition, and driving style.  
The selected suspension style is stored in memory, even  
with the electronic key removed from the starter switch.  
Suspension for regular driving style  
This is the setting for general driving.  
The system is set to regular driving mode when the  
indicator lamp (3) is not illuminated.  
Press lower half of switch (2) to change from suspension  
style for sporty driving to regular driving style.  
Suspension for sporty driving style  
The switch is located on the center console  
Press the switch when the engine is running:  
This is the setting for sporty driving.  
Press upper half of switch (1) to select suspension style  
for sporty driving. The indicator lamp (3) comes on.  
1 Suspension for sporty driving style  
2 Suspension for regular driving style  
3 Indicator lamp for sporty driving style  
Note:  
See “ACTIVE BODY CONTROL” on page 310 for  
malfunction and warning messages.  
Driving systems  
275  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
 
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Driving systems  
276  
Level control system  
The vehicle chassis ride height is raised or lowered  
automatically according to the selected setting and to  
the vehicle speed. This helps to increase vehicle  
handling safety and lowers fuel consumption.  
The selected setting is stored in memory, even with the  
electronic key removed from the starter switch.  
Warning!  
To help avoid personal injury, keep hands and feet  
away from wheel housing area, and stay away from  
under the vehicle when lowering the vehicle  
chassis.  
Note:  
See “ACTIVE BODY CONTROL” on page 310 for  
malfunction and warning messages.  
The switch is located on the center console.  
Press the switch when the engine is running:  
1 Raise vehicle chassis  
2 Lower vehicle chassis  
3 Indicator lamp  
4 Indicator lamp  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Level control switch positions  
Normal level  
Normal level – indicator lamps (3, 4) are not  
Used for normal operation of the vehicle.  
illuminated. To change from raised level options I or II,  
press lower half of switch (2) once respectively twice.  
Speed dependent lowering of vehicle chassis  
(approximate values):  
Raise level, option I – indicator lamp (3) is illuminated.  
To change from normal level, press upper half (1) of  
switch.  
To change from raised level, option II, press lower  
half (2) of switch.  
between 0 mph (0 km/h) and 35 mph (60 km/h)  
– none  
between 35 mph (60 km/h) and 85 mph (140 km/h)  
– lowered progressively by approx. 7/16 inch (11 mm)  
Raised level, option 2 – indicator lamps (3, 4) are  
illuminated.  
To change from normal level or raised level, option I,  
press upper half (1) of switch once respectively twice.  
Driving systems  
277  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Driving systems  
278  
Raised level, option I  
Raised level, option II  
This setting should be used when road surface  
conditions are rough and must be used when driving  
with snow chains mounted.  
This setting should be used when road surface  
conditions are very rough for increased ground  
clearance.  
Speed dependent lowering of vehicle chassis  
(approximate values):  
Important!  
Driving with snow chains requires increased space  
between tire and wheel housing. Refer to page 245 for  
driving with snow chains.  
at standstill - raised by approx. one inch (24 mm)  
between 0 mph (0 km/h) and 35 mph (6o km/h) -  
lowered progressively by approx. 3/8 inch (10 mm)  
Speed dependent lowering of vehicle chassis  
(approximate values):  
between 35 mph (60 km/h) and 100 mph  
(160 km/h) – lowered progressively by additional  
approx. one half inch (14 mm)  
at standstill – raised by approx. one half inch  
(14 mm)  
between 35 mph (60 km/h) and 100 mph  
(160 km/h) – lowered progressively by approx.  
one half inch (14 mm)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Parking assist (Parktronic)  
Warning!  
The Parktronic system assists the driver during parking  
maneuvers. It visually and audibly indicates the relative  
distance between the vehicle and an obstacle.  
Parktronic is a supplemental system. It is not  
intended to nor does it replace the need for extreme  
care. The responsibility during parking and other  
critical maneuvers rests always with the driver.  
The front area of the vehicle is monitored when driving  
forward. When reversing or with the gear selector lever  
in position “N”, the front as well as the rear areas are  
monitored.  
Special attention must be paid to objects having  
smooth surfaces or low silhouettes (e.g. trailer  
couplings, painted posts, or street curbs). Such  
objects may not be detected by the system and can  
damage the vehicle.  
With the electronic key in starter switch position 2,  
Parktronic engages automatically at speeds up to  
approximately 10 mph (15 km/h) and deactivates during  
higher speeds.  
The operational function of the Parktronic can be  
affected by dirty sensors, especially at times of  
snow and ice. See page 378 for notes on cleaning  
the parktronic system sensors.  
Parktronic can be switched off by a control switch  
located in the center console. It engages automatically  
again when starting the engine.  
Interference caused by other ultrasonic signals  
(e.g. working jackhammers or the air brakes of  
trucks) can cause the system to send erratic  
indications, and should be taken into  
consideration.  
See page 283 for parktronic switch.  
Parking system  
279  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
 
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Parking system  
280  
Sensors  
A total of 10 sensors (1) monitor the vehicle’s front and  
rear areas. Six sensors are located in the front bumper,  
four sensors in the rear bumper.  
For proper operation of the Parktronic always keep the  
sensors clean, especially at times of snow and ice.  
See page 378 for instructions on cleaning the sensors in  
the bumpers.  
1
1
1
1 Sensors located in bumpers  
(front bumper shown)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Warning indicators  
Visual and audible signals indicate to the driver the  
relative distance between the vehicle and an obstacle.  
Warning indicators for the front area are located above  
the left and center air outlets in the dashboard.  
Warning indicators for the rear area are integrated in  
the rear headliner.  
1
2
The frames (1) are illuminated when the Parktronic is  
engaged.  
Each warning indicator has 6 yellow and 2 red  
segments.  
As soon as the sensors detect an obstacle, one or more  
segments light up, depending on the distance. An  
intermittent acoustic warning will also sound as the  
seventh segment lights up and a constant acoustic  
warning lasting a maximum of 3 seconds will sound for  
the eighth segment.  
P54.65-2043-26  
1 Frame  
2 Segments  
Parking system  
281  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Index  
data  
 
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Parking system  
282  
Monitoring reach of sensors  
Front bumper:  
The first yellow segment lights up at these distances.  
Additional segments light up as the vehicle comes  
closer to the obstacle.  
Center  
Corner  
approx. 40 in (100 cm)  
approx. 24 in (60 cm)  
Minimum distance between vehicle and obstacle at  
which the system stops indicating:  
Rear bumper:  
Front corners  
approx. 6 in (15 cm)  
approx. 8 in (20 cm)  
Front center and rear  
Center  
Corner  
approx. 48 in (120 cm)  
approx. 32 in (80 cm)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The obstacle may not be recognized if outside the  
shaded sensor field, and no longer be indicated when  
approaching it any closer (warning indicators go out).  
Parktronic switch  
Parktronic malfunction  
All red segments of the warning indicators light up, and  
a warning sounds for 3 seconds, if Parktronic does not  
function properly. The indicator lamp in the switch  
lights up and the system switches off automatically!  
3
A dirty sensor could be the reason. See page 378 for  
instructions on cleaning the sensors in the bumpers.  
After cleaning the sensors, turn electronic key in starter  
switch to position 2. If the defect continues to be  
displayed, have the system checked at your authorized  
Mercedes-Benz Center.  
The switch is located on the center console.  
1 Parktronic switched off  
2 Parktronic switched on  
3 Indicator lamp – comes on when Parktronic is  
switched off  
The parktronic system is switched on again when  
turning the electronic key in starter switch position 2.  
Parking system  
283  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
 
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
What you should know at the gas station  
What you should know at the gas station  
Fuel supply  
284  
Open flap by briefly pushing near rear (arrow) and  
folding up. Turn fuel cap to the left and hold on to it  
until possible pressure in tank has been released, then  
remove cap. Failure to remove slowly could result in  
personal injury.  
To close the fuel filler flap, fold flap down and press past  
the point of resistance.  
See page 368 for manual release of fuel filler flap.  
Fuel  
To prevent fuel vapors from escaping into open air, fully  
insert filler nozzle unit.  
Only fill fuel tank until the filler nozzle unit cuts out  
— do not top up or overfill.  
P88.00-2027-26  
Warning!  
Warning!  
Overfilling of fuel tank may result in creating  
pressure in the system which could cause a gas  
discharge such as the gas spraying back out upon  
removing the filler nozzle which could cause  
personal injury.  
Gasoline is highly flammable and poisonous. It  
burns violently and can cause serious injury.  
Whenever you are around gasoline, avoid inhaling  
fumes and skin contact, extinguish all smoking  
materials. Never allow sparks, flame or smoking  
materials near gasoline!  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Leaving the engine running and the fuel cap open can  
cause the “CHECK ENGINE” lamp to illuminate, see  
page 290 for notes on the “CHECK ENGINE” lamp.  
Engine oil  
Checking oil level, see instructions on pages 154  
and 331.  
Fuel tank capacity approx. 23.2 US gal (88.0 l).  
This includes approx. 2.9 US gal (11.0 l) reserve.  
Use premium unleaded gasoline:  
CL 500 and CL 55 AMG only:  
Fill quantity between upper and lower dipstick marking  
level: 2.1 US qt (2.0 l).  
CL 500, CL 55 AMG:  
Recommended engine oils, see Approved Service  
Products sheet.  
Posted Octane Index 91 (Average of 96 RON/86 MON).  
CL 600:  
Posted Octane Index 93 (Average of 98 RON/88 MON).  
Coolant  
For normal replenishing, use water (potable water  
quality). For further information refer to page 333.  
What you should know at the gas station  
285  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
 
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
What you should know at the gas station  
Tire pressure  
286  
Bulbs  
For tire pressure, refer to tire pressure label inside the  
fuel filler flap. See page 345 for further details.  
Low beam: Xenon,  
high beam: H7 (55 W)  
fog lamps: H1 (55 W),  
Air conditioner  
turn signal lamps, front: 1156 NA bulb,  
parking and standing lamps, front: H 6W  
side marker lamps, front: W 5 W/4 cp,  
turn signal lamps, rear: 1156 NA bulb,  
tail and parking lamp: 67/4 cp,  
R-134a refrigerant and special PAG lubricant, refer to  
“Technical Data”.  
Spark plugs  
tail, parking and rear fog lamp, driver’s side: P 21/4 W,  
Approved spark plugs, refer to page 391.  
tail, parking, standing and  
side marker lamp: 67/4 cp,  
Windshield cleaning  
backup lamps: 1160/32 cp,  
license plate lamps: C 5 W/4 cp  
To prevent damage to the engine hood, the windshield  
wipers must not be folded forward in parked position.  
See page 380 for cleaning the windshield.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Check regularly and before a long trip  
1 Windshield washer and  
headlamp cleaning system  
For refilling reservoir see page 334.  
2 Coolant level,  
see “Coolant level” on page 333  
3 Engine oil level,  
see “Engine oil level, checking” on page 154 and 331  
4 Brake fluid,  
see “Brake fluid” on page 395  
Opening hood, see page 328.  
Vehicle lighting: Check function and cleanliness. For  
replacement of light bulbs, see “Exterior lamps” on  
page 354.  
P20.00-2057-26  
Exterior lamp switch, see page 156.  
Check regularly and before a long trip  
287  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Index  
data  
 
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Check regularly and before a long trip  
289  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Malfunction and indicator  
COOLANT  
Instrument cluster display  
lamp in the center console ......296  
AIRBAG OFF indicator lamp ....296  
Malfunction and  
warning messages in the  
multifunction display .............. 297  
DISPLAY DEFECTIVE  
(engine control unit) ................. 298  
DISPLAY DEFECTIVE  
(several systems) .......................298  
BATTERY /ALTERNATOR ......... 299  
ENTRANCE POSITION .............. 300  
BRAKE ASSIST ...........................300  
BRAKE LINING WEAR .............. 301  
BRAKE FLUID ............................ 301  
PARKING BRAKE .......................302  
TRUNK OPEN .............................302  
ELEC. STABIL. PROG.  
(coolant temperature) ................305  
LIGHTING SYSTEM ....................306  
LIGHT SENSOR ...........................308  
SEAT BELT SYSTEM ...................308  
TELEPHONE – FUNCTION .......309  
CRUISE CONTROL .....................309  
Malfunction and indicator  
lamps in the  
instrument cluster ....................290  
On-board diagnostic system .....290  
Check engine malfunction  
indicator lamp .............................290  
Brake warning lamp ..................292  
Supplemental restraint  
system (SRS)  
Fuel reserve warning .................293  
ABS malfunction  
indicator lamp .............................294  
Electronic stability program  
(ESP) — warning lamp ...............295  
Distronic (DTR) —  
warning lamp ..............................295  
Seat belt nonusage  
ACTIVE BODY CONTROL  
(ABC) ............................................ 310  
TIRE PRESSURE ......................... 312  
ENGINE OIL LEVEL ................... 314  
SEAT BACKREST ........................ 315  
KEY ............................................... 316  
DOOR ........................................... 316  
HOOD ........................................... 317  
TELE AID ..................................... 317  
ENGINE OIL LEVEL ................... 318  
WASHER FLUID ......................... 319  
LIGHT SENSOR ...........................320  
DISTRONIC (DTR) ......................321  
(Electronic stability  
program) .....................................303  
COOLANT (coolant level) ......... 304  
warning lamp ..............................296  
Contents - Instrument cluster display  
Instruments  
289  
Instrument  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Index  
and controls  
cluster display  
data  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Malfunction and indicator lamps  
290  
Malfunction and indicator lamps  
in the instrument cluster  
Warning!  
Inhalation of exhaust gas is hazardous to your  
health. All exhaust gas contains carbon monoxide,  
and inhaling it can cause unconsciousness and  
lead to death.  
General information:  
If a bulb in the instrument cluster fails to light up  
during the bulb self-check when turning the electronic  
key in starter switch to position 2, have it checked and  
replaced if necessary.  
Do not run the engine in confined areas (such as a  
garage) which are not properly ventilated. If you  
think that exhaust gas fumes are entering the  
vehicle while driving, have the cause determined  
and corrected immediately. If you must drive under  
these conditions, drive only with at least one  
window fully open.  
Emission control  
Certain systems of the engine serve to keep the toxic  
components of the exhaust gases within permissible  
limits required by law.  
On-board diagnostic system  
These systems, of course, will function properly only  
when maintained strictly according to factory  
Check engine malfunction indicator lamp  
specifications. Any adjustments on the engine should,  
therefore, be carried out only by authorized Mercedes-  
Benz Center qualified technicians. Engine adjustments  
should not be altered in any way. Moreover, the  
specified service jobs must be carried out regularly  
according to Mercedes-Benz servicing requirements.  
For details refer to the Service Booklet.  
Engine malfunction indicator lamp. If the  
“CHECK ENGINE” malfunction indicator  
lamp comes on when the engine is running,  
it indicates a malfunction of the fuel management  
system, emission control system, systems which impact  
emissions, or the fuel cap is not closed tight (check the  
fuel cap). If the “CHECK ENGINE” lamp is illuminated  
continuously and the vehicle is driving normally, you  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
may still drive the vehicle, however, in all cases, we  
recommend that you have the system checked at your  
authorized Mercedes-Benz Center as soon as possible.  
With some exceptions, the control module switches off  
the “CHECK ENGINE” malfunction indicator lamp if the  
condition, causing the lamp to come on, no longer exists  
during three consecutive cycles.  
If the “CHECK ENGINE” lamp comes on continuously  
and/or the vehicle is not driving normally (e.g.  
malfunction of the fuel management system or running  
out of fuel), serious damage can occur to the emission  
system. Please contact your authorized Mercedes-Benz  
Center immediately.  
An on-board diagnostic connector is located in the  
passenger compartment near to the parking brake  
pedal, allowing the accurate identification of system  
malfunctions through the readout of diagnostic trouble  
codes.  
The Sequential Multiport Fuel Injection (SFI) control  
module monitors emission control components that  
either provide input signals to or receive output signals  
from the control module. Malfunctions resulting from  
interruptions or failure of any of these components are  
indicated by the “CHECK ENGINE” malfunction  
indicator lamp in the instrument cluster and are  
simultaneously stored in the SFI control module.  
Notes:  
When running out of fuel, the “CHECK ENGINE”  
malfunction indicator lamp comes on and the engine  
possibly switches to its limp-home (emergency  
operation) mode.  
To cancel the limp-home mode, the engine may have to  
be started three or four times after refueling. The  
malfunction indicator lamp remains illuminated. Have  
the system checked at your authorized Mercedes-Benz  
Center immediately.  
If the “CHECK ENGINE” malfunction indicator lamp  
comes on, have the system checked at your authorized  
Mercedes-Benz Center as soon as possible.  
Malfunction and indicator lamps  
291  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Malfunction and indicator lamps  
Brake warning lamp  
292  
Warning!  
Driving with the brake warning lamp illuminated  
can result in an accident. Have your brake system  
checked immediately if the brake warning lamp  
stays on. Don’t add brake fluid before checking the  
brake system. Overfilling the brake fluid reservoir  
can result in spilling brake fluid on hot engine  
parts and the brake fluid catching fire. You can be  
seriously burned.  
Except Canada  
Canada only  
When the brake warning lamp and message appear  
while the engine is running, this means:  
there is insufficient brake fluid in the reservoir  
Note:  
(engine running and parking brake released), or  
If you find that the minimum mark on the brake fluid  
reservoir is reached, have the brake system checked for  
brake pad thickness and leaks.  
the parking brake is set (engine running).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Supplemental restraint system (SRS) indicator lamp  
Fuel reserve warning  
The operational readiness of the airbag  
system is verified by the indicator lamp  
“SRS” in the instrument cluster when  
turning the electronic key in starter switch to position 1  
or 2. If no fault is detected, the lamp will go out after  
approximately 4 seconds; after the lamp goes out, the  
system continues to monitor the components and  
circuitry of the airbag system and will indicate a  
malfunction by coming on again.  
1 Fuel reserve indicator  
Warning!  
When the warning lamp (1) comes on after starting the  
engine, or if it comes on while driving, it indicates that  
the fuel level is down to the reserve quantity of  
approximately 2.9 gal (11 liters).  
In the event a malfunction of the “SRS” is indicated  
as outlined above, the “SRS” may not be  
operational. For your safety, we strongly  
recommend that you visit an authorized  
Mercedes-Benz Center immediately to have the  
system checked; otherwise the “SRS” may not be  
activated when needed in an accident, which could  
result in serious or fatal injury, or it might deploy  
unexpectedly and unnecessarily which could also  
result in injury.  
See page 284 for notes on refueling the vehicle.  
See page 92 for notes on airbags, see page 91 for belt  
tensioners and page 102 for infant and child seat  
restraint.  
Malfunction and indicator lamps  
293  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
   
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Malfunction and indicator lamps  
ABS malfunction indicator lamp  
294  
With the ABS malfunctioning, the BAS and ESP are also  
switched off. The malfunction indicator lamps and  
malfunction messages in the multifunction display  
come on with the engine running.  
The ABS malfunction indicator lamp in the  
instrument cluster comes on with the  
electronic key in starter switch position 2  
ABS  
and should go out with the engine running.  
If the charging voltage falls below 10 volts, the  
malfunction indicator lamp comes on and the ABS is  
switched off. When the voltage is above this value again,  
the malfunction indicator lamp should go out and the  
ABS is operational.  
When the ABS malfunction indicator lamp symbol and  
warning in the instrument cluster remains illuminated  
while the engine is running, it indicates that the ABS  
has detected a malfunction and has switched off. In this  
case, the brake system functions in the usual manner,  
but without antilock assistance.  
Have the system checked at your authorized  
Mercedes-Benz Center as soon as possible.  
A malfunctioning ABS control unit can possibly affect  
the operation of other systems (e.g. Parktronic,  
Navigation, Automatic transmission). Be guided  
accordingly with respect to the use of those systems and  
have the system checked at your authorized  
See page 269 for notes on antilock brake system (ABS).  
Mercedes-Benz Center as soon as possible.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Electronic stability program (ESP) — warning lamp  
Distronic (DTR) – warning lamp  
With the electronic key in starter switch  
The yellow ESP warning lamp in the  
speedometer dial comes on with the  
electronic key in starter switch position 2. It  
position 2, the distance warning lamp in the  
speedometer dial comes on and goes out  
should go out with engine running.  
with the engine running.  
If the ESP malfunction indicator lamp remains  
illuminated with the engine running, a malfunction has  
been detected in the system. Pressing the accelerator  
pedal will require greater effort. Only partial engine  
output will be available.  
See Distronic (DTR) system on page 321 for possible  
malfunction messages.  
Note:  
The distance warning lamp is without a warning  
function on vehicles without distronic (DTR).  
See electronic stability program (ESP) on page 271 if the  
warning lamp lights up or flashes when the vehicle is  
moving.  
Malfunction and indicator lamps  
295  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
   
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Malfunction and indicator lamps  
Seat belt nonusage warning lamp  
With the electronic key in starter switch  
296  
Malfunction and indicator lamp in the center  
console  
position 2, the seat belt nonusage warning  
lamp comes on, and a warning sounds for a  
AIRBAG OFF indicator lamp  
short time if the driver’s seat belt is not fastened.  
The 7 indicator lamp will light up for approximately  
6 seconds when you turn the electronic key in starter  
switch to position 1 or 2.  
After starting the engine, the seat belt nonusage  
warning lamp blinks for a brief period to remind the  
driver and passengers to fasten seat belts.  
It does not light up if there is a fault in the system.  
The 7 indicator lamp stays lit as long as a  
BabySmartTM child seat is properly installed on the front  
passenger seat. It indicates that the front passenger  
airbag is switched off.  
See page 88 for BabySmartTM airbag and its deactivation  
system.  
Baby SmartTM is a trademark of Siemens Automotive Corp.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Malfunction and warning messages in the  
multifunction display  
Note:  
Certain malfunction and warning messages are  
accompanied by an audible signal.  
Malfunction and warning messages in red are always  
accompanied by an audible signal.  
Malfunction and warning messages for the following  
systems will be displayed immediately in the  
multifunction display.  
They are divided into three categories.  
Temporary messages such as “TRUNK OPEN!” will not  
be stored in the malfunction message memory.  
Category C1:  
Messages of most immediate priority.  
Warning!  
These cannot be cleared from the instrument cluster  
All categories of messages contain important  
information which should be taken note of and,  
where malfunction indicated, addressed as soon as  
possible at an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center.  
using the J button.  
Categories C2 and C3:  
Messages of less immediate priority.  
Failure to repair condition noted may cause  
damage not covered by the Mercedes-Benz Limited  
Warranty, or result in property damage or personal  
injury.  
These can be cleared from the instrument cluster using  
the J button and are then stored in the malfunction  
message memory, see page 136  
Malfunction and warning messages  
297  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
     
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Malfunction and warning messages  
DISPLAY DEFECTIVE (engine control unit)  
298  
DISPLAY DEFECTIVE (several systems)  
Line 1  
Line 2  
C*  
Line 1  
Line 2  
C*  
DISPLAY DEFECTIVE  
VISIT WORKSHOP!  
2
DISPLAY DEFECTIVE  
VISIT WORKSHOP!  
2
*
C = Category, see page 297  
*
C = Category, see page 297  
This message is displayed to indicate that the  
The displays for several systems have failed. Some  
systems themselves may also have failed.  
information being relayed by the engine control unit is  
no longer complete. The display for coolant temperature  
gauge, tachometer, or the cruise control may have failed.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
BATTERY /ALTERNATOR  
This message indicates a malfunction which must be  
repaired immediately.  
It may indicate that the poly-V-belt has broken. Should  
this condition occur, the poly-V-belt must be replaced  
before continuing to operate the vehicle. Otherwise, the  
engine will overheat due to an inoperative water pump  
which may result in damage to the engine.  
Do not continue to drive the vehicle with this message  
displayed.  
Doing so could result in serious engine damage that is  
not covered by the Mercedes-Benz Limited Warranty.  
Line 1  
Line 2  
VISIT WORKSHOP!  
C*  
BATTERY/ALTERNATOR  
2
*
C = Category, see page 297  
Malfunction and warning messages  
299  
Instruments  
Operation  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Index  
and controls  
data  
 
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Malfunction and warning messages  
ENTRANCE POSITION  
300  
BRAKE ASSIST  
Line 1  
Line 2  
C*  
Line 1  
Line 2  
VISIT WORKSHOP!  
C*  
ENTRANCE POSITION  
DO NOT DRIVE!  
1
BRAKE ASSIST  
2
*
C = Category, see page 297  
*
C = Category, see page 297  
Wait until the seat and steering wheel have moved to  
their driving positions. The display will clear when they  
have done so.  
A malfunction has been detected in the system. The  
brake system functions in the usual manner, but  
without brake assist system (BAS).  
See also page 66 for easy-entry/exit feature.  
See page 268 for notes on the brake assist system (BAS).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
BRAKE LINING WEAR  
BRAKE FLUID  
Line 1  
Line 2  
C*  
Line 1  
Line 2  
C*  
BRAKE LINING WEAR  
VISIT WORKSHOP!  
2
BRAKE FLUID  
VISIT WORKSHOP!  
2
*
C = Category, see page 297  
*
C = Category, see page 297  
When this message appears during braking, it indicates  
that the brake pads are worn down.  
Warning!  
Driving with this message displayed can result in  
an accident. Have your brake system checked  
immediately. Don’t add brake fluid before checking  
the brake system. Overfilling the brake fluid  
reservoir can result in spilling brake fluid on hot  
engine parts and the brake fluid catching fire. You  
can be seriously burned.  
Have the brake system checked at your authorized  
Mercedes-Benz Center as soon as possible.  
Malfunction and warning messages  
301  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
   
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Malfunction and warning messages  
PARKING BRAKE  
302  
TRUNK OPEN  
Line 1  
Line 2  
C*  
Line 1  
Line 2  
C*  
PARKING BRAKE  
RELEASE BRAKE!  
1
TRUNK OPEN!  
2
*
C = Category, see page 297  
*
C = Category, see page 297  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
1
2
The display or the system is malfunctioning.  
ELEC. STABIL. PROG.  
(Electronic stability program)  
A malfunction has been detected in the system. Pressing the  
accelerator pedal will require greater effort. Only partial engine  
output will be available.  
3
4
The enhanced vehicle stability offered by ESP and the torque  
reduction feature are unavailable.  
This message may be displayed if the power supply was  
interrupted (battery disconnected or empty). Synchronize ESP, see  
page 272.  
Line 1  
Line 2  
C*  
2
DISPLAY DEFECTIVE  
ELEC. STABIL. PROG.  
VISIT WORKSHOP!1  
VISIT WORKSHOP!2, 3, 4  
2
*
C = Category, see page 297  
Malfunction and warning messages  
303  
Instruments  
Operation  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
and controls  
cluster display  
data  
 
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Malfunction and warning messages  
COOLANT (coolant level)  
304  
The low engine coolant level warning should not be  
ignored. Extended driving with the symbol displayed  
may cause serious engine damage not covered by the  
Mercedes-Benz Limited Warranty.  
In cases of major or frequent minor coolant loss, have  
the cooling system checked at your authorized  
Mercedes-Benz Center as soon as possible.  
Note:  
Do not drive without coolant in the cooling system. The  
engine will overheat causing major engine damage.  
Line 1  
Line 2  
C*  
Monitor the coolant temperature gauge while driving,  
see page 117.  
COOLANT  
CHECK LEVEL!  
2
See page 333 for instructions on topping up the coolant.  
*
C = Category, see page 297  
When this message appears while driving, the coolant  
level has dropped below the required level. If no leaks  
are noticeable and the engine temperature does not  
increase, continue to drive to the nearest service station  
and have coolant added to the coolant system.  
Warning!  
Do not spill antifreeze on hot engine parts.  
Antifreeze contains ethylene glycol which may  
burn if it comes into contact with hot engine parts.  
You can be seriously burned.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
COOLANT (coolant temperature)  
During severe operating conditions and stop-and-go city  
traffic, the coolant temperature may rise close to the red  
marking.  
The engine should not be operated with the coolant  
temperature in the red zone. Doing so may cause  
serious engine damage which is not covered by the  
Mercedes-Benz Limited Warranty.  
Warning!  
Driving when your engine is badly overheated can  
cause some fluids which may have leaked into the  
engine compartment to catch fire. You could be  
seriously burned.  
Line 1  
Line 2  
C*  
1
COOLANT  
COOLANT  
STOP, ENGINE OFF!1  
VISIT WORKSHOP!2  
Steam from an overheated engine can cause serious  
burns and can occur just by opening the engine  
hood. Stay away from the engine if you see or hear  
steam coming from it.  
2
*
C = Category, see page 297  
This may indicate that the poly-V-belt has broken. Should this  
1
Turn off the engine, get out of the vehicle and do  
not stand near the vehicle until it cools down.  
condition occur, the poly-V-belt must be replaced before continuing  
to operate the vehicle. Otherwise, the engine will overheat due to  
an inoperative water pump which may result in damage to the  
engine. Do not continue to drive the vehicle with this message  
displayed. Doing so could result in serious engine damage that is  
not covered by the Mercedes-Benz Limited Warranty.  
2
The cooling fan for the coolant is faulty. Observe the coolant  
temperature gauge. See page 117  
Malfunction and warning messages  
305  
Instruments  
Operation  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
and controls  
cluster display  
data  
 
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Malfunction and warning messages  
LIGHTING SYSTEM  
306  
Line 1  
Line 2  
C*  
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
1
2
L. TURN SIG. RFLECTR  
R. TURN SIG. RFLECTR  
TURN SIGNAL F, L  
TURN SIGNAL F, R  
BRAKE LIGHT2  
CHECK LAMP!  
CHECK LAMP!  
CHECK LAMP!  
CHECK LAMP!  
VISIT WORKSHOP!  
CHECK LAMP!  
CHECK LAMP!  
CHECK LAMP!  
CHECK LAMP!  
CHECK LAMP!  
CHECK LAMP!  
CHECK LAMP!  
SWITCH OFF LIGHTS!  
CHECK LAMP!  
BRAKE LIGHT, L3  
BRAKE LIGHT, R3  
3RD BRAKE LIGHT3  
HIGH BEAM, L  
Line 1  
Line 2  
C*  
2
LOW BEAM,L  
CHECK LAMP!  
CHECK LAMP!  
LOW BEAM,R  
DISPLAY DEFECTIVE  
TURN SIGNAL, L  
TURN SIGNAL, R  
2
VISIT WORKSHOP!1  
CHECK LAMP!  
2
2
2
HIGH BEAM, R  
CHECK LAMP!  
LICENSE PLATE L, L  
LICENSE PLATE L, R  
*
C = Category, see page 297  
FRONT FOGLAMP, L  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
In the case of bulb failures in certain lamps, other lamps  
will substitute. See page 354 for instructions on  
replacing bulbs.  
Line 1  
Line 2  
C*  
2
FRONT FOGLAMP, R  
REAR FOGLAMP  
REVERSE LIGHT, L  
REVERSE LIGHT, R  
TAIL LIGHT, L  
CHECK LAMP!  
CHECK LAMP!  
CHECK LAMP!  
CHECK LAMP!  
*
1
2
C = Category, see page 297  
2
The display or the system is malfunctioning.  
2
The brake lamps are switching on after a delay or are permanently  
on – visit workshop immediately.  
2
CHECK LAMP!  
2
3
4
The brake lamps comprise several light emitting diodes. The  
warning message will only appear if all light emitting diodes have  
stopped working.  
SUBSTITUTE LAMP ON!4  
TAIL LIGHT, R  
SIDELIGHT, L  
SIDELIGHT, R  
CHECK LAMP!  
2
2
2
SUBSTITUTE LAMP ON!4  
Other bulbs will be brought into use as replacements when certain  
lamps blow.  
CHECK LAMP!  
SUBSTITUTE LAMP ON!4  
CHECK LAMP!  
SUBSTITUTE LAMP ON!4  
Malfunction and warning messages  
307  
Instruments  
Operation  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
and controls  
cluster display  
data  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Malfunction and warning messages  
LIGHT SENSOR  
308  
SEAT BELT SYSTEM  
Line 1  
Line 2  
C*  
Line 1  
Line 2  
VISIT WORKSHOP!  
C*  
LIGHT SENSOR  
VISIT WORKSHOP!  
2
SEAT BELT SYSTEM  
2
*
C = Category, see page 297  
*
C = Category, see page 297  
The headlamps will be switched on automatically if the  
light sensor malfunctions.  
The “LIGHT CIRCUIT HEADLAMP MODE” setting menu  
can be set to “MANUAL” in the individual settings, see  
page 142. It will then be possible to switch the  
headlamps on and off using the exterior lamp switch.  
See page 156 for notes on the exterior lamp switch.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
TELEPHONE – FUNCTION  
CRUISE CONTROL  
Line 1  
Line 2  
NOT AVAILABLE!  
C*  
Line 1  
Line 2  
C*  
FUNCTION  
3
CRUISE CONTROL  
VISIT WORKSHOP!1  
2
*
C = Category, see page 297  
*
1
C = Category, see page 297.  
Cruise control is malfunctioning.  
The display appears if button í or ì on the  
multifunction steering wheel is pressed and the vehicle  
is not equipped with a telephone.  
Malfunction and warning messages  
309  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
   
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Malfunction and warning messages  
ACTIVE BODY CONTROL (ABC)  
310  
2
The capability of the system is restricted.  
Important!  
When the message “ACTIVE BODY CONTROL – DRIVE  
CAREFULLY!” appears, do not exceed a speed of 50 mph  
(80 km/h). The vehicle driving characteristics are  
changed due to a noticeably softer suspension.  
In this case visit your Mercedes-Benz Center as soon as  
possible.  
Do not continue to drive if loss of hydraulic fluid or  
leaks are noticed. Doing so could result in subsequent  
damage that is not covered by the Mercedes-Benz  
Limited Warranty.  
Line 1  
Line 2  
C*  
DISPLAY DEFECTIVE  
ACTIVE BODY CONTROL  
ACTIVE BODY CONTROL  
ACTIVE BODY CONTROL  
VISIT WORKSHOP!1  
DRIVE CAREFULLY!2  
STOP, CAR TOO LOW!3  
VISIT WORKSHOP!4  
2
1
1
2
*
C = Category, see page 297  
The display or the system is malfunctioning.  
1
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
3
The ABC is defective. Stop the vehicle.  
Press upper half of level control switch, see page 276  
- system selects raised level mode.  
4
The capability of the system is restricted.  
Important!  
The vehicle chassis is raised depending on the kind of defect.  
When the message “ACTIVE BODY CONTROL – VISIT  
WORKSHOP!” appears, do not exceed a speed of 50 mph  
(80 km/h). Visit your Mercedes-Benz Center as soon as  
possible.  
Important!  
The wheels may not have sufficient clearance when the  
steering wheel is turned beyond a certain angle if the  
“ACTIVE BODY CONTROL – CAR TOO LOW!” message  
appears. The front fenders will be damaged if the  
steering wheel is turned too far. Watch and listen for  
scraping noises.  
Do not exceed a speed of 50 mph (80 km/h).  
Visit your Mercedes-Benz Center as soon as possible.  
Malfunction and warning messages  
311  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Malfunction and warning messages  
TIRE PRESSURE  
312  
TIRE PRESSURE, FL  
TIRE PRESSURE, FR  
TIRE PRESSURE, RL  
TIRE PRESSURE, RR  
TIRE PRESSURE, FL  
TIRE PRESSURE, FL  
TIRE PRESSURE, FR  
TIRE PRESSURE, FR  
TIRE PRESSURE, RL  
TIRE PRESSURE, RL  
TIRE PRESSURE, RR  
TIRE PRESSURE, RR  
CAUTION TIRE DEFECT!1  
CAUTION TIRE DEFECT!1  
CAUTION TIRE DEFECT!1  
CAUTION TIRE DEFECT!1  
CHECK TIRES!2  
1
1
1
1
1
2
1
2
1
2
1
2
CHECK TIRES!4  
CHECK TIRES!2  
Line 1  
Line 2  
C*  
CHECK TIRES!4  
TIRE PRESSURE  
TIRE PRESSURE  
TIRE PRESSURE  
TIRE PRESS. CONTROL  
TIRE PRESS. CONTROL  
CAUTION TIRE DEFECT!1  
CHECK TIRES!2, 3  
CHECK TIRES!4  
1
1
2
2
2
CHECK TIRES!2  
CHECK TIRES!4  
CHECK TIRES!2  
ACTIVATED!3  
CHECK TIRES!4  
ACTIVATION – NOT WHEN  
ENGINE ON5  
TIRE PRESS. CONTROL  
TIRE PRESS. CONTROL  
TIRE PRESS. CONTROL  
REACTIVATE!3, 6  
3
2
2
CURRENTLY INACTIVE!7  
VISIT WORKSHOP!8  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
4
5
6
Tire pressure in one or more tires is low. Check and correct tire  
pressure, see page 345.  
Warning!  
Do not drive with a flat tire. A flat tire affects the  
ability to steer or brake the vehicle. You may lose  
control of the vehicle. Continued driving with a flat  
tire will cause excessive heat build-up and possibly  
a fire.  
The tire pressure monitor cannot be activated with the engine  
running. Turn off the engine and repeat activation, see page 151.  
When the message appears after starting the engine, the tire  
inflation pressure on all road wheels should be checked and  
corrected according to the label affixed inside the fuel filler flap.  
For tire inflation pressure, see page 345.  
*
C = Category, see page 297.  
The tire inflation pressure monitor must be activated again after  
the tire inflation pressure has been corrected, see page 151.  
RL: rear left; FL: front left;  
RR: rear right; FR: front right;  
7
8
The tire inflation pressure monitor system is unable to monitor the  
tire pressure due to the presence of several wheel electronics in  
the vehicle (e.g. a deflated road wheel in the trunk), or nearby  
radio interference source, or excessive wheel sensor temperatures,  
or unrecognized wheel sensors mounted.  
1
2
3
One or more tires deflate rapidly or tire pressure is already below  
minimum value. Carefully bring the vehicle to a halt, avoiding  
abrupt steering and braking maneuvers. For reference on changing  
wheels, see page 337.  
The tire inflation pressure monitor is defective or a wheel without  
proper sensor was installed. Visit your authorized Mercedes-Benz  
Center.  
The tire pressure on one or more tires is already below minimum  
value. Carefully bring the vehicle to a halt, avoiding abrupt  
steering and braking maneuvers. For reference on changing  
wheels, see page 337.  
For tire inflation pressure monitor, see page 150.  
Malfunction and warning messages  
313  
Instruments  
Operation  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
and controls  
cluster display  
data  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Malfunction and warning messages  
ENGINE OIL LEVEL  
314  
3
4
There is a risk of damaging the engine or catalytic converter. The  
engine oil level must be checked immediately. See Engine oil level  
indicator on page 154.  
The engine oil level has dropped to a critical level.  
Check the engine oil level immediately. See Engine oil level  
indicator on page 154 and check the engine for visible leakage  
(loss of oil).  
It may be that there is water in the engine oil. Have the engine oil  
checked.  
5
The measuring system is malfunctioning.  
When the “ENGINE OIL LEVEL – CHECK LEVEL”  
message appears while the engine is running and at  
operating temperature, the engine oil level has dropped  
to approximately the minimum mark on the dipstick.  
Line 1  
Line 2  
C*  
ENGINE OIL LEVEL  
ENGINE OIL LEVEL  
ENGINE OIL LEVEL  
ENGINE OIL  
CHECK LEVEL!1  
2
STOP, ENGINE OFF!2  
REDUCE OIL LEVEL3  
VISIT WORKSHOP!4  
VISIT WORKSHOP!5  
1
2
2
2
When this occurs, the warning will first come on  
intermittently and then stay on if the oil level drops  
further.  
If no oil leaks are noted, continue to drive to the nearest  
service station where the engine oil should be topped to  
the “full” mark on the dipstick with an approved oil.  
ENGINE OIL LEVEL  
*
1
C = Category, see page 297.  
The engine oil level warnings should not be ignored.  
Extended driving with the symbol displayed could  
result in serious engine damage that is not covered by  
the Mercedes-Benz Limited Warranty.  
The engine oil level must be checked immediately. See Engine oil  
level indicator on page 154.  
2
There is no oil in the engine. There is a danger of engine damage.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
SEAT BACKREST  
Warning!  
The seat belts provide protection only with the  
backrest locked in place and, therefore, must be  
locked in place with the vehicle in motion. Do not  
drive the vehicle when the backrest is not locked in  
place. If the warning message “SEAT BACKREST,  
LEFT – LOCK!” or “SEAT BACKREST, RIGHT –  
LOCK!” is displayed in the multifunction display,  
then the respective backrest is not engaged in its  
lock. Carefully slow down, and drive with caution  
to an area which is in a safe distance from the  
roadway. Always provide sufficient room behind  
the backrest and fold the backrest all the way back  
until it locks in place.  
Line 1  
Line 2  
LOCK!  
LOCK!  
C*  
1
SEAT BEACKREST, LEFT  
SEAT BEACKREST, RIGHT  
The warning message is no longer displayed as  
soon as the backrest is locked in place. If both  
backrests are locked in place and the warning  
message is still displayed, have the system checked  
at your authorized Mercedes-Benz Center  
immediately.  
1
*
C = Category, see page 297.  
Malfunction and warning messages  
315  
Instruments  
Operation  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Index  
and controls  
data  
 
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Malfunction and warning messages  
KEY  
316  
DOOR  
P54.30-2245-21  
Line 1  
Line 2  
C*  
2
Line 1  
Line 2  
C*  
REPLACE KEY1  
AUTOM. LIGHT ON  
VISIT WORKSHOP!  
REMOVE KEY!  
DOOR OPEN!  
2
1
*
C = Category, see page 297.  
*
1
C = Category, see page 297.  
Key needs possibly to be replaced.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
HOOD  
TELE AID  
P54.30-2560-21  
Line 1  
Line 2  
C*  
Line 1  
Line 2  
C*  
ENGINE HOOD OPEN!  
2
TELE AID  
VISIT WORKSHOP!1  
1
*
C = Category, see page 297.  
1
The Tele Aid system consists of three types of response; automatic  
and manual emergency, roadside assistance and information. With  
this message displayed, one or more functions may not be  
available.  
See page 328 for hood.  
See page 210 for notes on the Tele Aid.  
If a malfunction is indicated as outlined above, have the  
system checked at the nearest Mercedes-Benz Center as  
soon as possible.  
Malfunction and warning messages  
317  
Instruments  
Operation  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
and controls  
cluster display  
data  
   
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Malfunction and warning messages  
CHIP-CARD (KEYLESS-GO)  
318  
1
2
Check battery of KEYLESS-GO-card, see page 366.  
The KEYLESS-GO-card cannot be recognized by the running  
engine (e.g. strong radio-frequency interference) or the card is not  
in the vehicle.  
Stop immediately and search for the KEYLESS-GO-card or continue  
to operate the vehicle with the electronic key, otherwise the vehicle  
cannot be centrally locked or the engine started again after the  
engine stops automatically. See page 38.  
3
The KEYLESS-GO-card was momentarily not recognized. If  
message repeats, place card in a different position or continue to  
operate the vehicle with the electronic key, see page 38.  
Line 1  
Line 2  
CHECK BATTERY!1  
C*  
4
5
A KEYLESS-GO-card left inside the vehicle has been recognized  
while locking the vehicle from the outside, see page 38.  
CHIP-CARD  
CHIP-CARD  
CHIP-CARD  
CHIP-CARD  
CHIP-CARD  
2
The message appears for a maximum 60 seconds each time the  
driver’s door is opened, as long as no electronic key is in the  
starter switch. The message appears regardless of the past  
operation method (electronic key or KEYLESS-GO-card), see  
page 38.  
NOT RECOGNIZED!2  
NOT RECOGNIZED!3  
STILL IN VEHICLE!4  
DO NOT FORGET!5  
1
2
1
1
*
C = Category, see page 297.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
SELECTOR LEVER  
(Vehicles with KEYLESS-GO only)  
Place selector lever in position “P”.  
The message appears when attempting to turn off the  
engine while the selector lever is in any other position  
than “P”, see page 228.  
Malfunction and warning messages  
319  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Malfunction and warning messages  
WASHER FLUID  
320  
When this message appears while the engine is  
running, the level of the reservoir has dropped to  
approx. 1/3 of the total volume. The reservoir should be  
refilled with the prescribed mixture of MB Windshield  
washer concentrate and water or the concentrate and  
commercially available premixed windshield washer  
solvent/antifreeze, depending on ambient temperature,  
at the next opportunity. The reservoir for the windshield  
and headlamp washer systems is located in the engine  
compartment.  
See windshield and headlamp washer system on  
page 334 for instructions on topping up the washer  
fluid.  
Line 1  
Line 2  
C*  
WASHER FLUID  
CHECK LEVEL!  
3
*
C = Category, see page 297.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
1
2
The display or the system is malfunctioning.  
DISTRONIC (DTR)  
Due to the presence of electro-magnetic radiation, the system is  
presently unavailable.  
3
4
Distronic is automatically switched off.  
Distronic sensor in hood grille needs cleaning, see page 378.  
Distronic is defective.  
Line 1  
Line 2  
C*  
2
DISPLAY DEFECTIVE  
DISTRONIC  
VISIT WORKSHOP!1  
EXTERNAL MALFUNCTION!2  
CLEAN SENSOR!3  
VISIT WORKSHOP!4  
2
DISTRONIC MALFUNCTION  
DISTRONIC  
2
2
*
C = Category, see page 297.  
Malfunction and warning messages  
321  
Instruments  
Operation  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
and controls  
cluster display  
data  
   
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Windshield and headlamp  
washer fluid mixing ratio ........334  
Spare wheel, vehicle tools,  
storage compartment ...............335  
Jack .................................................. 336  
Wheels ............................................337  
Tire Replacement .......................337  
Rotating wheels .........................338  
Exterior lamps ................................354  
Headlamp assembly ...................355  
Taillamp assemblies ..................358  
Standby bulb function ...................361  
Changing batteries  
in the electronic main key ......363  
Synchronizing  
Practical hints  
First aid kit .....................................324  
Fuses ................................................325  
Shelf below rear window ..............327  
Hood .................................................328  
Checking engine oil level .............331  
Automatic transmission  
fluid level ...................................332  
Active body control  
(ABC) fluid level ........................332  
Coolant level ...................................333  
Adding coolant ...........................333  
Windshield and headlamp  
remote control ............................365  
Spare wheel ....................................338 Changing batteries  
in the KEYLESS-GO-card .........366  
Emergency engine  
shut-down ..................................368  
Fuel filler flap,  
manual release ..........................368  
Emergency operation of  
Changing wheels ...........................340  
Tire inflation pressure ................. 345  
Battery ............................................. 346  
Jump starting ................................. 349  
Towing the vehicle ........................ 351  
washer system ...........................334  
sliding/pop-up roof ...................369  
Replacing wiper blades .................370  
Trunk lamp .....................................371  
Roof rack .........................................372  
Contents - Practical hints  
323  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwanlroacda.re  
Index  
data  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
First aid kit  
324  
First aid kit  
1
The first aid kit is located in the rear seat armrest (1).  
To open:  
Press handle (2) upwards and fold the lid (3) up.  
Remove the first aid kit.  
To close:  
Fold the lid (3) down until it engages.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Fuses  
Fuse boxes in the engine compartment  
Most of your vehicle’s electrical components are fused  
with safety fuses. With the exception of the brake lights,  
all individual lighting system components are  
electronically fused. Before replacing a blown safety  
fuse, determine the cause of the short circuit. Always  
observe amperage and color of fuse.  
The circuit for components is protected by a cycled  
circuit breaker interrupted if too much current is being  
drawn. The circuit closes automatically after a short  
time; the circuit is broken again if the malfunction  
reoccurs.  
1
3
3
Always use a new fuse for replacement. Never attempt to  
repair or bridge a blown fuse.  
P54.15-2064-26  
1 Fuse box in engine compartment, left-hand side  
A fuse chart, spare fuses and a fuse extractor are located  
in the vehicle tool kit in the luggage bowl under the  
trunk floor. See page 335 for notes on the vehicle tool  
kit.  
3 Tabs  
Fuses  
325  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwanlroacda.re  
Index  
data  
   
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Fuses  
326  
To close the fuse box:  
Ensure that the sealing rubber is properly positioned  
when you replace the cover. Press the cover down by  
hand. Slide both tabs (3) back to the symbol on the  
fuse box.  
2
Note:  
3
The fuse box cover must be properly positioned and  
both tabs pushed forward to prevent moisture entering  
the fuse box.  
3
P54.15-2065-26  
2 Fuse box in engine compartment, right-hand side  
3 Tabs  
To gain access to fuse box:  
Slide both tabs (3) on fuse box forward to the Œ  
symbol and remove the cover.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Auxiliary fuse box below rear seat  
Shelf below rear window  
Warning!  
The shelf below the rear window should not be  
used to carry objects. This will avoid such objects  
from being thrown about and injuring vehicle  
occupants during an accident or sudden maneuver.  
The trunk is the preferred place to carry objects.  
4
4 Auxiliary fuse box below right rear seat.  
To open:  
Remove the cover.  
To close:  
Press the cover on.  
Fuses  
327  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwanlroacda.re  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
 
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Engine compartment  
Hood  
328  
The engine is equipped with a transistorized  
ignition system. Because of the high voltage it is  
dangerous to touch any components (ignition coils,  
spark plug sockets, diagnostic socket) of the  
ignition system  
Warning!  
To help prevent personal injury, stay clear of  
moving parts when the hood is open and the engine  
is running. Be sure the hood is properly closed  
before driving. When closing hood, use extreme  
caution not to catch hands or fingers.  
• with the engine running,  
• while starting the engine,  
• if ignition is “on“ and the engine is turned  
manually.  
The radiator fan may continue to run for  
approximately 30 seconds or even restart after the  
engine has been turned off. Stay clear from fan  
blades.  
If you see flames or smoke coming from the engine  
compartment, or if the coolant temperature gauge  
indicates that the engine is overheated, do not open  
the hood. Move away from vehicle and do not open  
the hood until the engine has cooled. If necessary,  
call a fire department.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
To open:  
Pull handle (2) to its stop out of radiator grill and open  
hood (do not pull up on the handle).  
To unlock the hood, pull release lever (1) under the  
driver’s side of the instrument panel. At the same time a  
handle will extend out of the radiator grill.  
Note:  
To avoid damage to the windshield wipers or hood, open  
the hood only with the wipers in the parked position.  
Engine compartment  
329  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwanlroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Engine compartment  
330  
To close:  
Lower the hood and let it drop into lock from a height of  
approx. 1 ft. (30 cm), assisting with hands placed flat on  
edges of hood (3).  
3
3
To avoid hood damage, please make sure that hood is  
fully closed. If not, repeat closing procedure. Do not  
push down on hood to attempt to fully close it.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Checking engine oil level  
2
2
1
P18.40-2067-26  
P18.40-0287-26  
CL 500  
CL 600  
Model CL 500 and CL 55 AMG  
1 Dipstick  
Model CL 600:  
To check the engine oil level, park vehicle on level  
The dipstick is omitted. Engine oil level can be  
checked via the engine oil level indicator, see  
page 154.  
ground, with engine at normal operational temperature.  
Check engine oil level approximately 5 minutes after  
stopping the engine, allowing for the oil to return to the  
oil pan.  
2 Oil filler cap  
Engine compartment  
331  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwanlroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
 
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Engine compartment  
332  
The engine oil level can be checked by either the oil  
dipstick or via the multifunction display in the  
instrument cluster, see page 154.  
See malfunction and warning messages on page 297 if  
an engine oil level display appears on the multifunction  
display when the engine is running.  
Wipe the oil dipstick clean prior to checking the engine  
oil level. Fully insert dipstick in tube, and remove after  
three seconds to obtain accurate reading.  
Note:  
See page 154 for engine oil level indicator.  
The oil level must be between the lower  
mark (min) and the upper mark (max)  
on the oil dipstick.  
Automatic transmission fluid level  
The transmission has a permanent fill of automatic  
transmission fluid.  
Regular automatic transmission fluid level checks and  
changes are not required. For this reason the dipstick is  
omitted.  
Unscrew the oil filler cap and add oil carefully if you  
need to top up the oil.  
CL 500 and CL 55 AMG:  
If you notice fluid leaks or gear shifting malfunctions,  
have your authorized Mercedes-Benz Center check the  
transmission fluid level.  
Fill quantity between upper and lower dipstick marking  
level is approximately 2.1 US qt (2.0 l).  
CL 600:  
Follow the message appearing on the engine oil level  
indicator display (page 154) as to quantity to be added.  
Re-install oil filler cap.  
Active body control (ABC) fluid level  
Regular fluid level check is not required.  
Do not overfill the engine. Excessive oil must be drained  
or siphoned. It could cause damage to engine and  
catalytic converter not covered by the Mercedes-Benz  
Limited Warranty.  
If you notice fluid leaks or malfunctions, have your  
authorized Mercedes-Benz Center check the  
ABC-system.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Coolant level  
Adding coolant  
If coolant has to be added, a 50/50 mixture of water and  
MB anticorrosion/antifreeze should be added.  
Warning!  
• In order to avoid possibly serious burns:  
Use extreme caution when opening the hood if  
there are any signs of steam or coolant leaking  
from the cooling system, or if the coolant  
temperature gauge indicates that the coolant is  
overheated.  
1
• Do not remove pressure cap on coolant  
reservoir if engine temperature is above 194°F  
(90°C). Allow engine to cool down before  
removing cap. The coolant reservoir contains  
hot fluid and is under pressure.  
1 Coolant expansion tank  
To check the coolant level, the vehicle must be parked  
on level ground and the engine stopped.  
• Using a rag, slowly open cap approximately 1/2  
turn to relieve excess pressure. If opened  
immediately, scalding hot fluid and steam will  
be blown out under pressure.  
Check coolant level only when coolant is cold.  
The coolant level should reach the black top part of the  
reservoir.  
• Do not spill antifreeze on hot engine parts.  
Antifreeze contains ethylene glycol which may  
burn if it comes into contact with hot engine  
parts.  
See page 397 for antifreeze/anticorrosion mixture.  
Engine compartment  
333  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwanlroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
   
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Engine compartment  
334  
Windshield and headlamp washer system  
Warning!  
Washer solvent/antifreeze is highly flammable. Do  
not spill washer solvent/antifreeze on hot engine  
parts, because it may burn. You can be seriously  
burned.  
Windshield and headlamp washer fluid mixing ratio  
1
For temperatures above freezing:  
MB Windshield Washer Concentrate “S” and water.  
1 part “S” to 100 parts water  
(40 ml “S” to 1 gallon water).  
For temperatures below freezing:  
MB Windshield Washer Concentrate “S” and  
commercially available premixed windshield washer  
solvent/antifreeze.  
1 Windshield and headlamp washer fluid reservoir  
The reservoir should be refilled with MB Windshield  
Washer Concentrate and water (or concentrate  
commercially available premixed windshield washer  
solvent/antifreeze, depending on ambient  
temperatures).  
1 part “S” to 100 parts solvent  
(40 ml “S” to 1 gallon solvent).  
Capacity approx. 7.1 US qt (6.7 l).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Spare wheel, vehicle tools, storage compartment  
Lift trunk floor and engage handle in upper edge of  
trunk.  
Always lower trunk floor before closing trunk lid.  
To remove the spare wheel:  
Take out the vehicle tool kit tray.  
Turn the luggage bowl counterclockwise and remove the  
spare wheel.  
2
4
To store spare wheel:  
Place spare wheel in wheel well and secure it with  
luggage bowl. Turn luggage bowl clockwise to its stop.  
1
3
Place vehicle tool kit tray in luggage bowl.  
P40.10-0523-26  
1 Jack  
2 Luggage bowl with vehicle tool kit, towing eye bolt,  
fuses, fuse extractor and fuse chart  
3 Storage tray  
4 Spare wheel  
Spare wheel  
335  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwanlroacda.re  
Index  
data  
   
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Jack  
336  
Jack  
Storing the jack in the trunk:  
Retract the jack arm to the base of the jack, push the  
crank handle up and turn counterclockwise to the end  
of the stop (storage position).  
Warning!  
The jack is designed exclusively for jacking up the  
vehicle at the jack tubes built into either side of the  
vehicle. To help avoid personal injury, use the jack  
only to lift the vehicle during a wheel change.  
Never get beneath the vehicle while it is supported  
by the jack. Keep hands and feet away from the area  
under the lifted vehicle. Always firmly set parking  
brake and block wheels before raising vehicle with  
jack.  
P58.10-2001-26  
To prepare the jack for use:  
Do not disengage parking brake while the vehicle is  
raised. Be certain that the jack is always vertical  
when in use, especially on hills. Always try to use  
the jack on level surface. Be sure that the jack arm  
is fully inserted in the jack tube. Always lower the  
vehicle onto sufficient capacity jackstands before  
working under the vehicle.  
Remove the jack from the spare wheel well under the  
trunk floor, push the crank handle up and turn  
clockwise until it engages (operational position).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Wheels  
It is imperative that the wheel mounting bolts be  
fastened to a tightening torque of 110 ft.lb. (150 Nm)  
whenever wheels are mounted.  
Replace rims or tires with the same designation,  
manufacturer and type as shown on the original part.  
See your authorized Mercedes-Benz Center for further  
information.  
For rim and tire specifications, refer to “Technical Data”.  
Warning!  
See your authorized Mercedes-Benz Center for  
information on tested and recommended rims and tires  
for summer and winter operation. They can also offer  
advice concerning tire service and purchase.  
Worn, old tires can cause accidents. If the tire tread  
is badly worn, or if the tires have sustained  
damage, replace them.  
When replacing rims, use only genuine  
Mercedes-Benz wheel bolts specified for the  
particular rim type. Failure to do so can result in  
the bolts loosening and possibly an accident.  
Tire replacement  
Front and rear tires should be replaced in sets. Rims  
and tires must be of the correct size and type. For  
dimensions, see “Technical Data”.  
We recommend that you break in new tires for approx.  
60 miles (100 km) at moderate speed.  
Tires, Wheels  
337  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwanlroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
   
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Tires, Wheels  
338  
Rotating wheels  
Spare wheel  
The wheels can be rotated according to the degree of  
tire wear while retaining the same direction of travel.  
Spare wheel CL 500 and CL 600  
(except Sport Package)  
Rotating, however, should be carried out as  
Important!  
recommended by the tire manufacturer, before the  
characteristic tire wear pattern (shoulder wear on front  
wheels and tread center wear on rear wheels) becomes  
visible, as otherwise the driving properties deteriorate.  
The spare wheel rim is mounted with a full size tire of  
the same type as on the vehicle, and is fully functional.  
However, that spare wheel rim is weight optimized and  
has a limited service life of 12 000 miles (20 000 km)  
use before a standard wheel rim must replace it.  
Notes:  
Thoroughly clean the inner side of the wheels any time  
you rotate the wheels or wash the vehicle underside.  
In the case of a flat tire, you may temporarily use the  
spare wheel.  
The use of retread tires is not recommended. Retread  
tires may adversely affect the handling characteristics  
and safety of the vehicle.  
Do not operate vehicle with more than one spare wheel  
mounted.  
Warning!  
Dented or bent rims can cause tire pressure loss and  
damage to the tire beads. For this reason, check rims for  
damage at regular intervals. The rim flanges must be  
checked for wear before a tire is mounted. Remove  
burrs, if any.  
The spare wheel rim is for temporary use only. Use  
for over a total of 12 000 miles (20 000 km)  
(aggregate of all uses) may cause wheel rim failure  
leading to an accident and possible injuries.  
Check and ensure proper tire inflation pressure after  
rotating the wheels. For tire inflation pressure see  
inside of fuel filler flap and also page 345.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Spare wheel CL 55 AMG and Sport Package  
Important!  
The spare wheel rim size is 71/2 J x 17 H 2 with tire size  
225/55 R17 97H.  
For rim and tire specifications, refer to “Technical Data”.  
Warning!  
The spare wheel rim is for temporary use only. Use  
for over a total of 12 000 miles (20 000 km)  
(aggregate of all uses) may cause wheel rim failure  
leading to an accident and possible injuries.  
The spare wheel rim is weight optimized and has a  
limited service life of 12 000 miles (20 000 km) use  
before a standard wheel rim must replace it.  
The dimensions of the spare wheel are different  
from those of the road wheels. As a result, the  
vehicle handling characteristics change when  
driving with a mounted spare wheel.  
In the case of a flat tire, you may temporarily use the  
spare wheel, when observing the following restrictions:  
Do not exceed vehicle speed of 50 mph (80 km/h)  
The spare wheel should only be used temporarily,  
and replaced with a regular road wheel as quick as  
possible.  
Drive to the nearest tire repair facility to have the  
flat tire repaired or replaced as appropriate.  
Do not operate vehicle with more than one spare  
wheel mounted.  
If the arrow on tire side wall does not point in direction  
of vehicle forward movement when using the spare  
wheel, observe the following restriction:  
Unidirectional tires must always be mounted with arrow  
on tire sidewall pointing in direction of vehicle forward  
movement.  
Tires, Wheels  
339  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwanlroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Tires, Wheels  
340  
Changing wheels  
Move vehicle to a level area which is a safe distance  
from the roadway.  
Warning!  
1. Set parking brake and turn on hazard warning  
flasher.  
The jack is designed exclusively for jacking up the  
vehicle at the jack tubes built into either side of the  
vehicle. To help avoid personal injury, use the jack  
only to lift the vehicle during a wheel change.  
Never get beneath the vehicle while it is supported  
by the jack. Keep hands and feet away from the area  
under the lifted vehicle. Always firmly set parking  
brake and block wheels before raising vehicle with  
jack.  
2. Move selector lever to position “P” and turn off  
engine.  
3. Prevent vehicle from rolling away by blocking  
wheels with wheel chocks (not supplied with  
vehicle) or sizable wood block or stone. When  
changing a wheel on a hill, place chocks on the  
downhill side blocking both wheels of the other  
axle. On an level road, place one chock in front of  
and one behind the wheel that is diagonally  
opposite to the wheel being changed.  
Do not disengage parking brake while the vehicle is  
raised. Be certain that the jack is always vertical  
when in use, especially on hills. Always try to use  
the jack on level surface. Be sure that the jack arm  
is fully inserted in the jack tube. Always lower the  
vehicle onto sufficient capacity jackstands before  
working under the vehicle.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
P40.10-2177-26  
4. Remove the two-piece wheel wrench from the  
5. Remove the protective cover from the jack support  
tube opening by inserting the screwdriver (supplied  
in the tool kit) in the opening and prying it out.  
vehicle tool kit and assemble. Using the wrench,  
loosen but do not yet remove the wheel bolts.  
The tube openings are located directly behind the  
front wheel housings and in front of the rear wheel  
housings.  
Tires, Wheels  
341  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwanlroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Tires, Wheels  
342  
P40.10-2178-26  
P40.10-2179-26  
6. Insert jack arm fully into the tube hole up to the  
stop. Place jack on firm ground. Position the jack so  
that it is always vertical (plumb-line) as seen from  
the side (see arrow), even if the vehicle is parked on  
an incline.  
8. Unscrew upper-most wheel bolt and install  
alignment bolt (1) supplied in the tool kit. Remove  
the remaining bolts. Keep bolt threads protected  
from dirt and sand.  
9. Remove wheel. Grip wheel from the sides. Keep  
hands from beneath the wheels.  
7. Jack up the vehicle until the wheel is clear of the  
ground. Never start engine while vehicle is raised.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
P40.10-2264-26  
P40.10-2263-26  
10. Clean contact surfaces of wheel and wheel hub.  
11. Lower vehicle. Remove jack and insert jack tube  
cover.  
Install spare wheel on wheel hub. Insert wheel bolts  
and tighten them slightly.  
To avoid paint damage, place wheel flat against hub  
and hold it there while installing first wheel bolt.  
Unscrew the alignment bolt to install the last wheel  
bolt.  
Tires, Wheels  
343  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwanlroacda.re  
Index  
data  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Tires, Wheels  
344  
Warning!  
Always replace wheel bolts that are damaged or  
rusted.  
Never apply oil or grease to wheel bolts.  
Damaged wheel hub threads should be repaired  
immediately.  
Incorrect mounting bolts or improperly tightened  
mounting bolts can cause the wheel to come off.  
This could cause an accident. Be sure to use the  
correct mounting bolts.  
P40.10-2265-26  
Warning!  
12. Using the wrench, tighten the five bolts evenly,  
following the sequence illustrated, until all bolts are  
tight.  
The spare wheel rim is for temporary use only. Use  
for over a total of 12 000 miles (20 000 km)  
(aggregate of all uses) may cause wheel rim failure  
leading to an accident and possible injuries.  
Observe a tightening torque of 110 ft.lb. (150 Nm).  
13. Ensure proper tire pressure.  
The spare wheel should only be used temporarily,  
and replaced with a regular road wheel as quick as  
possible.  
Notes:  
CL 55 AMG and Sport Package:  
Before storing the jack, the jack arm must be lowered  
almost to the base of the jack.  
The dimensions of the spare wheel are different  
from those of the road wheels. As a result, the  
vehicle handling characteristics change when  
driving with a mounted spare wheel.  
For proper storage of vehicle jack see page 335.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tire inflation pressure  
Tire pressures listed for light loads are minimum values  
offering high driving comfort. Increased inflation  
pressures for heavy loads produce favorable handling  
characteristics with lighter loads and are perfectly  
permissible. The ride of the vehicle, however, will  
become somewhat harder.  
A table (see fuel filler flap) lists the tire inflation  
pressures specified for Mercedes-Benz recommended  
tires as well as for the varying operating conditions.  
Important!  
Tire temperature and pressure increase with the vehicle  
speed. Tire pressure should therefore only be checked  
and corrected on cold tires. Correct tire pressure in  
warm tires only if pressure has dropped below the  
pressure listed in the table and the respective operating  
conditions are taken into consideration.  
Tire pressure changes by approx. 1.5 psi (0.1 bar) per  
18°F (10°C) of air temperature change. Keep this in  
mind when checking tire pressure inside a garage –  
especially in the winter.  
Example:  
If garage temperature = approx. +68°F (+20°C) and  
ambient temperature = approx. +32°F (0°C) then the  
adjusted air pressure = specified air pressure +3 psi  
(+0.2 bar).  
An underinflated tire due to a slow leak (e.g. due to a  
nail in the tire) may cause damage such as tread  
separation, bulging etc.. Regular tire pressure checks  
(including the spare tire) at intervals of no more than  
14 days are therefore essential.  
If a tire constantly loses air, it should be inspected for  
damage.  
Tires, Wheels  
345  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwanlroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
   
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Tires, Wheels  
346  
The spare tire should be checked periodically for  
condition and inflation. Spare tire will age and become  
worn over time even if never used, and thus should be  
inspected and replaced when necessary.  
Battery  
Warning!  
Failure to follow these instructions can result in  
severe injury or death.  
Warning!  
Never lean over batteries while connecting, you  
might get injured.  
Do not overinflate tires. Overinflating tires can  
result in sudden deflation (blowout) because they  
are more likely to become punctured or damaged  
by road debris, potholes etc.. Follow recommended  
inflation pressures.  
Battery fluid contains sulfuric acid. Do not allow  
this fluid to come in contact with eyes, skin or  
clothing. In case it does, immediately flush affected  
area with water and seek medical help if necessary.  
Do not overload the tires by exceeding the specified  
vehicle capacity weight (as indicated by the label  
on the driver’s door latch post). Overloading the  
tires can overheat them, possibly causing a  
blowout.  
A battery will also produce hydrogen gas, which is  
flammable and explosive. Keep flames or sparks  
away from battery, avoid improper connection of  
jumper cables, smoking etc..  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
The service life of the battery is dependent on its  
condition of charge. The battery should always be kept  
sufficiently charged, in order to last an optimum length  
of time.  
Therefore, we strongly recommend that you have the  
battery charge checked frequently, and corrected if  
necessary, especially if you use the vehicle less than  
approximately 200 miles (300 km) per month,  
mostly for short distance trips, or if it is not used for  
long periods of time.  
Only charge a battery with a battery charger after the  
battery has been disconnected from the vehicle’s  
electrical circuit.  
The maintenance-free battery is located in the trunk  
under the right-hand wheel well cover panel.  
Always disconnect the battery negative lead first and  
connect last.  
For battery removal or installation, or jump starting the  
vehicle, first lift the trunk floor, then turn lock (1)  
counterclockwise and remove cover.  
When removing and connecting the battery, always  
make sure that all electrical consumers are off and the  
electronic key is in starter switch position 0. The  
battery, its filler caps, the vent tube and the opposite  
plug must always be securely installed when the vehicle  
is in operation.  
Important!  
Battery replacement information:  
Battery  
347  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwanlroacda.re  
Index  
data  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Battery  
348  
While the engine is running the battery terminal clamps  
must not be loosened or detached, otherwise the  
generator and other electronic components would be  
damaged.  
Battery recycling  
Batteries contain materials that can harm the  
environment with improper disposal.  
Large 12 Volt storage batteries contain lead.  
Note:  
Recycling of batteries is the preferred method of  
disposal.  
After reconnecting the battery also set the clock (see  
COMAND operator’s manual) resynchronize the express  
feature of the power windows (see page 180), the  
sliding/pop-up roof (see page 183), and the electronic  
stability program (see page 272).  
Many states require sellers of batteries to accept old  
batteries for recycling.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Jump starting  
Warning!  
Important!  
A discharged battery can freeze at approx. +14°F  
(–10°C). In that case, it must be thawed out before  
jumper cables are used. Attempting to jump start a  
frozen battery can result in it exploding, causing  
personal injury.  
Failure to follow these directions will cause  
damage to the electronic components, and can lead  
to a battery explosion and severe injury or death.  
Never lean over batteries while connecting or jump  
starting, you might get injured.  
Jumper cable specifications:  
Minimum cable cross-section of 25 mm2 or  
Battery fluid contains sulfuric acid. Do not allow  
this fluid to come in contact with eyes, skin or  
clothing. In case it does, immediately flush affected  
area with water, and seek medical help if  
necessary.  
approx. 2 AWG  
Maximum length of 11.5 ft. (3.5 m).  
If the battery is discharged, the engine should be started  
with jumper cables and the (12 V) battery of another  
vehicle.  
A battery will also produce hydrogen gas, which is  
flammable and very explosive. Keep flames or  
sparks away from battery, avoid improper  
connection of jumper cables, smoking etc..  
Only use 12 V battery to jump start your vehicle. Jump  
starting with more powerful battery could damage the  
vehicle’s electrical systems, which will not be covered  
by the Mercedes-Benz Limited Warranty.  
Read all instructions before proceeding.  
The battery is located in the trunk under the right-hand  
wheel well cover panel.  
Jump starting  
349  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwanlroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
   
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Jump starting  
350  
Proceed as follows:  
Important!  
1. Position the vehicle with the charged battery so that  
the jumper cables will reach, but never let the  
vehicles touch. Make sure the jumper cables do not  
have loose or missing insulation.  
5. Start engine of the vehicle with the charged battery  
and run at high idle. Make sure the cables are not  
on or near pulleys, fans, or other parts that move  
when the engine is started. Allow the discharged  
battery to charge for a few minutes. Start engine of  
the disabled vehicle in the usual manner.  
2. On both vehicles:  
Turn off engine and all lights and accessories,  
6. After the engine has started, remove jumper cables  
by exactly reversing the above installation  
sequence, starting with the last connection made  
first. When removing each clamp, make sure that it  
does not touch any other metal while the other end  
is still attached.  
except hazard warning flashers or work lights.  
Apply parking brake and shift selector lever to  
position “P”.  
Important!  
3. Clamp one end of the first jumper cable to the  
positive (+) terminal of the discharged battery and  
the other end to the positive (+) terminal of the  
charged battery. Make sure the cable clamps do not  
touch any other metal parts.  
Notes:  
If engine does not run after several unsuccessful  
starting attempts, have it checked at the nearest  
authorized Mercedes-Benz Center.  
Excessive unburned fuel may damage the catalytic  
converter.  
4. Clamp one end of the second jumper cable to the  
grounded negative (–) terminal of the charged  
battery and the final connection to the negative (–)  
under hood terminal of the disabled vehicle.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Towing the vehicle  
Warning!  
Important!  
When towing the vehicle, please, note the following:  
With the automatic central locking activated and the  
electronic key in starter switch position 2 (vehicles with  
KEYLESS-GO: in “On” position, see page 224), the  
vehicle doors lock if the left front wheel as well as the  
right rear wheel are turning at vehicle speeds of approx.  
9 mph (15 km/h) or more.  
Prior to towing the vehicle with all wheels on the  
ground, make certain that the electronic key is in  
starter switch position 2.  
If the electronic key is left in the starter switch  
position 0 for an extended period of time, it can no  
longer be turned in the switch. In this case, the  
steering is locked. To unlock, remove electronic key  
from starter switch and reinsert.  
To prevent the vehicle door locks from locking,  
deactivate the automatic central locking. See  
“VEHICLE” under “Individual settings” on page 144.  
Towing of the vehicle should only be done using the  
properly installed towing eye bolt. Never attach tow  
cable, tow rope or tow rod to vehicle chassis, frame  
or suspension parts.  
Note:  
The selector lever will remain locked in position “P” and  
the electronic key could not be turned in the starter  
switch if the battery is disconnected or discharged. See  
battery on page 346 or jump starting on page 349.  
Towing the vehicle  
351  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwanlroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
 
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Towing the vehicle  
352  
2
1 Cover on right side of front bumper  
2 Cover right side of rear bumper  
To remove cover:  
To remove cover:  
Press mark on cover in direction of arrow and lift cover  
off to reveal threaded hole for towing eye bolt. The  
towing eye bolt is supplied with the tool kit (located in  
trunk in spare wheel). Screw towing eye bolt in to its  
stop and tighten with lug wrench.  
Press mark on cover in direction of arrow and lift cover  
off to reveal threaded hole for towing eye bolt. The  
towing eye bolt is supplied with the tool kit (located in  
trunk in spare wheel). Screw towing eye bolt in to its  
stop and tighten with lug wrench.  
To reinstall cover:  
To reinstall cover:  
Fit cover and snap into place.  
Fit cover and snap into place.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
We recommend that the vehicle be transported using  
flat bed equipment. This method is preferable to other  
types of towing.  
Warning!  
With the engine not running, there is no power  
assistance for the braking and steering systems. In  
this case, it is important to keep in mind that a  
considerably higher degree of effort is necessary to  
brake and steer the vehicle.  
Important!  
To prevent damage during transport, do not tie down  
vehicle by its chassis or suspension parts.  
Note:  
The vehicle may be towed with all wheels on the ground  
and the selector lever in position “N” for distances up to  
30 miles (50 km) and at a speed not to exceed 30 mph  
(50 km/h). The electronic key must be in starter switch  
position 2.  
To signal turns while being towed with hazard warning  
flasher in use, turn electronic key in starter switch to  
position 2 and activate combination switch for left or  
right turn signal in usual manner – only the selected  
turn signal will operate.  
To be certain to avoid a possibility of damage to the  
transmission, however, we recommend the drive shaft  
be disconnected at the rear axle drive flange for any  
towing beyond a short tow to a nearby garage.  
Upon canceling the turn signal, the hazard warning  
flasher will operate again.  
Caution!  
Do not tow with sling-type equipment. Towing with  
sling-type equipment over bumpy roads will damage  
radiator and supports.  
If the vehicle is towed with the front axle raised, the  
engine must be shut off (electronic key in starter switch  
position 0 or 1). Otherwise, the ESP will immediately be  
engaged and will apply the rear wheel brakes.  
Use wheel lift, dolly, or flat bed equipment, with  
electronic key in starter switch turned to position 0.  
Switch off the tow-away alarm (see “VEHICLE” under  
“Individual settings” on page 144) as well as the ESP  
(see page 273).  
Towing the vehicle  
353  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwanlroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
 
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Exterior lamps  
354  
Exterior lamps  
Replacing bulbs  
Warning!  
Headlamp adjustment  
Because of high voltage in Xenon lamps, it is  
dangerous to replace the bulb or repair the lamp  
and its components. We recommend that you have  
such work done by a qualified technician.  
Correct headlamp adjustment is extremely important.  
Check and readjust headlamps at regular intervals and  
when a bulb has been replaced.  
Warning!  
Notes:  
Bulbs and bulb holders can be very hot. Allow the  
lamp to cool down before changing a bulb.  
To prevent a possible electrical short circuit, switch off  
lamp prior to replacing a bulb.  
Halogen lamps contain pressurized gas. A bulb can  
explode if you:  
When replacing bulbs, install only 12 volt bulbs with  
the specified watt rating.  
• touch or move it when hot,  
• drop the bulb,  
When replacing halogen bulbs do not touch glass  
portion of bulb with bare hands. Use plain paper or a  
clean cloth.  
• scratch the bulb.  
If the newly installed bulb does not light up, switch the  
lamp off and on again. If the bulb still does not light up,  
have the system checked at an authorized  
Mercedes-Benz Center.  
Wear eye and hand protection.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Headlamp assembly  
4
2
3
1
5
P82.10-2197-26  
P82.10-2198-26  
1 Headlamp cover for high beam headlamp, parking  
2 Electrical connector for high beam headlamp bulb  
3 Bulb socket for parking and standing lamp  
4 Bulb holder for turn signal lamp  
and standing lamp  
Warning!  
5 Cover for Xenon type headlamp bulb  
Do not remove cover (5) for Xenon headlamp.  
Because of high voltage in Xenon lamps, it is  
dangerous to replace the bulb or repair the lamp  
and its components. We recommend that you have  
such work done by a qualified technician.  
Exterior lamps  
355  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwanlroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
 
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Exterior lamps  
356  
Bulbs for high beam  
H7 (55 W)  
Xenon  
Bulb for low/high beam  
Open hood.  
Warning!  
Press the clip together (arrow) and remove headlamp  
cover (1).  
Because of high voltage in Xenon lamps, it is  
dangerous to replace the bulb or repair the lamp  
and its components. We recommend that you have  
such work done by a qualified technician.  
Pull electrical connector off.  
Unclip the retainer spring and take out the bulb.  
Insert the new bulb so that the base locates in the  
recess on the holder.  
Clip in retainer springs and plug the connector onto the  
bulb.  
Align headlamp cover (1) and click into place.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Turn signal lamp  
(1156 NA [26.9/5 W/32/4cp])  
Parking and standing lamp  
H 6W  
Open hood.  
Open hood.  
Twist bulb holder (4) counterclockwise and pull out.  
Push bulb into socket, turn counterclockwise and  
remove.  
Press the clip together (arrow) and remove headlamp  
cover (1).  
Remove the bulb socket (3). Push bulb into socket, turn  
counterclockwise and remove.  
Insert new bulb in socket, push in and twist clockwise.  
Reinstall bulb socket.  
Insert new bulb in socket, push in and twist clockwise.  
Reinstall bulb socket.  
Align bulb holder (4) and turn clockwise to lock.  
Align headlamp cover (1) and click into place.  
Exterior lamps  
357  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwanlroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
   
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Exterior lamps  
358  
Taillamp assemblies  
Open trunk lid.  
Turn lock (6) counterclockwise and fold trim to the side.  
Twist bulb socket counterclockwise and pull out. Push  
bulb into socket, turn counterclockwise and remove.  
Insert new bulb in socket, push in and twist clockwise.  
Reinstall bulb socket.  
Reinstall trim and secure with lock (6).  
6
P82.10-2635-26  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
7 Black socket:  
Backup lamp (1156 [32 cp] bulb)  
8 Red socket  
Driver’s side:  
Taillamp/parking lamp/rear fog lamp  
(P 21/4W bulb)  
Passenger side:  
10  
9
7
Taillamp/parking lamp (P 21/4W bulb)  
9 Grey socket:  
8
Taillamp/parking lamp/standing lamp/side marker  
(67 [4 cp] bulb)  
10 White socket:  
Turn signal lamp (1156 NA bulb [yellow])  
Exterior lamps  
359  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwanlroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Exterior lamps  
360  
License plate lamp  
Side marker lamp, front (5 W/4 cp bulb)  
1
2
P82.10-2634-26  
Loosen both securing screws (1), remove lamp and  
replace tubular lamp (C 5 W/4 cp).  
Carefully slide lamp towards rear (arrow 1), and remove  
front end first (arrow 2).  
Twist bulb socket counterclockwise and pull out.  
Remove bulb from socket.  
Insert new bulb in socket. Reinstall bulb socket, push in  
and twist clockwise.  
To reinstall lamp, set rear end of lamp in bumper and let  
front end snap into place.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Stop lamp,  
Standby bulb function  
High mounted stop lamp,  
Additional turn signals on the exterior mirror  
The rear fog lamp, dimmed, will act as a replacement  
lamp, if the bulb in the inner left-hand taillamp stops  
working.  
The stop lamps, the high mounted stop lamp (3rd brake  
lamp), and the additional turn signals on the exterior  
mirrors are equipped with LEDs.  
The inner taillamp acts as a replacement for the right or  
left-hand bulb of the outer taillamp, if it stops working  
as a parking lamp.  
Have the system checked at an authorized  
Mercedes-Benz Center if a malfunction occurs.  
Notes:  
The multifunction display will indicate that a bulb has  
failed. See malfunction and warning messages on  
page 297.  
Exterior lamps  
361  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwanlroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
 
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Exterior lamps  
362  
Low beam, switchable for left- or right-hand drive  
Driving in countries with left-hand traffic requires the  
headlamps to be switched over accordingly.  
1 Asymmetric low beam (right-hand traffic)  
2 Symmetric low beam (left-hand traffic)  
Turn lever to the respective position until it locks in  
place.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Changing batteries in the electronic main key  
2
1
3
4
P80.20-2201-26  
P80.35-2029-26  
1 Transmit buttons  
Changing batteries  
2 Lamp for battery check and function control  
Move locking tab (3) in direction of right arrow and  
remove mechanical key (4, left arrow).  
Checking batteries  
If one of the transmit buttons (1) is pressed, the battery  
check lamp (2) lights up briefly – indicating that the  
batteries are in order.  
Change batteries if the battery check lamp (2) does not  
light up briefly.  
Electronic main key  
363  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwanlroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
   
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Electronic main key  
364  
7
8
5
4
6
P80.35-2025-26  
P80.35-2027-26  
Insert mechanical key (4) in side opening (5) to open  
latch. Press briefly (do not use mechanical key as lever)  
to release battery compartment.  
Change batteries (7), inserting new ones under contact  
spring (8) with plus (+) side facing up.  
Return battery compartment into housing until locked  
in place and slide mechanical key back into electronic  
main key.  
Remove mechanical key from side opening.  
Carefully remove battery compartment in direction of  
arrow (6).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Important!  
Synchronizing remote control  
Batteries contain materials that can harm the  
environment if disposed of improperly. Recycling of  
batteries is the preferred method of disposal. For  
disposal, please follow manufacturer’s recommendation  
on battery package.  
The remote control may have to be resynchronized, if  
the vehicle cannot be locked or unlocked.  
To synchronize insert electronic key in starter switch.  
The remote control should once again be operational.  
Replacement Battery:  
Lithium, type CR 2025 or equivalent.  
Electronic main key  
365  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwanlroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
 
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
KEYLESS-GO-card  
Changing batteries in the KEYLESS-GO-card  
366  
Checking batteries  
Briefly press button (1). The indicator lamp “Unlock  
driver’s door” (2) or “Global Unlock” (3) should come on  
red or green.  
2
3
Change batteries if indicator lamps do not illuminate,  
see page 367.  
1
P80.30-2027-26  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Changing batteries  
Important!  
Batteries contain materials that can harm the  
environment if disposed of improperly. Recycling of  
batteries is the preferred method of disposal. For  
disposal, please follow manufacturer’s recommendation  
on battery package.  
Replacement batteries:  
Lithium, type CR 2025 or equivalent.  
Pry open cover (1) (e.g. by using a narrow blade screw  
driver) and remove batteries.  
Install new batteries as indicated by the “+” and “-”  
markings in the KEYLESS-GO-card.  
KEYLESS-GO-card  
367  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwanlroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
 
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Emergency engine shut-down  
Emergency engine shut-down  
368  
Fuel filler flap, manual release  
If the engine can no longer be stopped using the  
electronic key or the start-/stop button (vehicles with  
KEYLESS-GO), the engine can be turned off by  
withdrawing two fuses.  
For easy removal of fuses use the fuse extractor  
(supplied with vehicle tool kit) to pull out the fuses  
marked on the fuse chart as “ENGINE EMERGENCY  
OFF”.  
The fuse chart is also located in the vehicle tool kit,  
see page 335.  
For fuses see page 325.  
Remove the battery cover (see page 346) and the trim  
inside the trunk on the right-hand side. Pull the release  
knob (arrow) and open the fuel filler flap.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Emergency operation of sliding/pop-up roof  
2
1
P77.00-2022-26  
P77.00-2023-26  
The sliding/pop-up roof can be opened or closed  
manually should an electrical malfunction occur.  
Obtain crank (2) (supplied with vehicle) and insert  
through hole.  
The sliding/pop-up roof drive is located behind the lens  
of the left interior overhead light.  
To slide roof closed or to raise the roof at the rear:  
turn crank clockwise.  
Pry off the interior light lens (1) using a screwdriver.  
Turn electronic key in starter switch to position 1 or 2.  
To slide the roof open or to lower the roof at the rear:  
turn crank counterclockwise.  
See page 183 for instructions on synchronizing the  
sliding/pop-up roof after closing manually.  
Emergency operation of sliding/pop-up roof  
369  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwanlroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
 
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Replacing wiper blades  
Replacing wiper blades  
370  
Turn electronic key in starter switch to position 1.  
Turn combination switch to position I, see page 160.  
With wiper arms in position shown above, turn  
electronic key in starter switch to position 0.  
For safety reasons, remove electronic key from  
starter switch before replacing a wiper blade,  
otherwise the motor can suddenly turn on and cause  
injury.  
Notes:  
Do not open engine hood with wiper arm folded forward.  
Do not allow the wiper arm to contact the windshield  
glass without a wiper blade inserted. The glass may be  
scratched or broken.  
To prevent damage to the hood or the wipers, the wiper  
arms should only be folded forward while in the position  
shown above.  
Make certain that the wiper blades are properly  
installed. An improperly installed wiper blade may  
cause windshield damage.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Trunk lamp  
The trunk lamp will switch off after approximately  
10 minutes if the trunk lid is left open.  
3
4
2
1
P82.30-2089-26  
Removal:  
Fold the wiper arm (1) forward and turn the wiper  
blade (2) at a right-angle to wiper arm.  
Remove wiper blade from wiper arm.  
Installation:  
Install wiper blade onto the wiper arm by inserting  
pin (4) into take-up (3).  
Rotate wiper blade into position parallel to wiper arm.  
Replacing wiper blades  
371  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwanlroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
 
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Roof rack  
372  
Roof rack  
Use only those roof racks approved by Mercedes-Benz to  
avoid damage to the vehicle. Follow manufacturer’s  
installation instructions.  
Only mount roof racks on the retrofitted mounting  
points (see arrows).  
Mounting a roof rack requires a one-time installation of  
take-up points.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Ornamental moldings ...............377  
Headlamps, taillamps,  
turn signal lenses ......................377  
Cleaning the Distronic  
system sensor .............................378  
Cleaning the parktronic  
system sensors ...........................378  
Wiper blades ..............................379  
Light alloy wheels ..................... 380  
Instrument cluster ..................... 381  
Steering wheel and  
Vehicle care  
gear selector lever ......................381  
Cup holder ...................................381  
Seat belts .....................................382  
Headliner and shelf  
below rear window .....................382  
Leather upholstery .....................382  
Hard plastic trim items .............382  
Plastic and rubber parts ............382  
Cleaning and care  
of the vehicle .............................374  
Power washer ..............................375  
Tar stains .....................................376  
Paintwork, painted body  
components ................................. 376  
Engine cleaning .......................... 376  
Vehicle washing .........................376  
Contents - Vehicle care  
373  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwanlroacda.re  
Index  
data  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Cleaning and care of the vehicle  
374  
Cleaning and care of the vehicle  
More frequent washings are necessary to deal with  
unfavorable conditions; for example, near the ocean, in  
industrial areas (smoke, exhaust emissions), or during  
winter operation.  
Warning!  
Many cleaning products can be hazardous. Some  
are poisonous, others are flammable. Always follow  
the instructions on the particular container.  
Always open your vehicle’s doors or windows when  
cleaning the inside.  
You should check your vehicle from time to time for  
stone chipping or other damage. Any damage should be  
repaired as soon as possible to prevent the start of  
corrosion.  
Never use fluids or solvents that are not designed  
for cleaning your vehicle.  
In doing so, do not neglect the underside of the vehicle.  
A prerequisite for a thorough check is a washing of the  
underbody followed by a thorough inspection. Damaged  
areas need to be reundercoated.  
In operation, your vehicle is subjected to varying  
external influences which, if gone unchecked, can  
attack the paintwork as well as the underbody and  
cause lasting damage.  
Your vehicle has been treated at the factory with a wax-  
base rustproofing in the body cavities which will last for  
the lifetime of the vehicle. Post-production treatment is  
neither necessary nor recommended by Mercedes-Benz  
because of the possibility of incompatibility between  
materials used in the production process and others  
applied later.  
Such damage is caused not only by extreme and varying  
climatic conditions, but also by air polution, road salt,  
tar, gravel and stone chipping. Grease and oil, fuel,  
coolant, brake fluid, bird droppings, insects, tree resins  
etc. should be removed immediately to avoid paint  
damage. Frequent washing reduces and/or eliminates  
the aggressiveness and potency of the above adverse  
influences.  
We have selected car-care products and compiled  
recommendations which are specially matched to our  
vehicles and which always reflect the latest technology.  
You can obtain Mercedes-Benz approved car-care  
products at your authorized Mercedes-Benz Center.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Scratches, corrosive deposits, corrosion or damage due  
to negligent or incorrect care cannot always be removed  
or repaired with the car-care products recommended  
here. In such cases it is best to seek aid at your  
authorized Mercedes-Benz Center.  
Power washer  
When using a power washer for cleaning the vehicle  
always observe manufacturer’s operating instructions.  
Note:  
The following topics deal with the cleaning and care of  
your vehicle and give important “how-to” information as  
well as references to Mercedes-Benz approved car-care  
products.  
Vehicles with KEYLESS-GO:  
If a door handle is hit by a strong jet of water, and a  
KEYLESS-GO-card is in close proximity, approx. 3 ft.  
(approx. 1m), the vehicle could be inadvertently locked  
or unlocked.  
Additional information can be found in the booklet titled  
Vehicle Care Guide”.  
Caution!  
Never use a round nozzle to power wash tires. The  
intense jet of water can result in damage to the tire.  
Always replace a damaged tire.  
Always keep the jet of water moving across the surface.  
Do not aim directly at electrical parts, electrical  
connectors, seals, or other rubber parts.  
Cleaning and care of the vehicle  
375  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwanlroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
 
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Cleaning and care of the vehicle  
Tar stains  
376  
Engine cleaning  
Quickly remove tar stains before they dry and become  
more difficult to remove. A tar remover is  
recommended.  
Prior to cleaning the engine compartment make sure to  
protect electrical components and connectors from the  
intrusion of water and cleaning agents.  
Corrosion protection, such as MB Anticorrosion Wax  
should be applied to the engine compartment after  
every engine cleaning. Before applying, all control  
linkage bushings and joints should be lubricated. The  
poly-V-belt and all pulleys should be protected from any  
wax.  
Paintwork, painted body components  
Mercedes-Benz approved Paint Care should be applied  
when water drops on the paint surface do not “bead up”,  
normally in 3 to 5 months, depending on climate and  
washing detergent used.  
Mercedes-Benz approved Paint Cleaner should be  
applied if paint surface shows signs of dirt embedding  
(i.e. loss of gloss).  
Vehicle washing  
Do not use hot water or wash your vehicle in direct  
sunlight. Use only a mild car wash detergent, such as  
Mercedes-Benz approved Car Shampoo.  
Do not apply any of these products or wax if your  
vehicle is parked in the sun or if the hood is still hot.  
Thoroughly spray the vehicle with a diffused jet of  
water. Direct only a very weak spray towards the  
ventilation intake. Use plenty of water and rinse the  
sponge and chamois frequently.  
Use the appropriate MB-Touch-Up Stick for quick and  
provisional repairs of minor paint damage (i.e. chips  
from stones, vehicle doors etc.).  
Rinse with clear water and thoroughly wipe dry with a  
chamois. Do not allow cleaning agents to dry on the  
finish.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Due to the width of the vehicle, prior to running the  
vehicle through an automatic car wash, fold back the  
outside mirrors to prevent them from getting damaged.  
Ornamental moldings  
For regular cleaning and care of very dirty chrome-  
plated parts, use a chrome cleaner.  
In the winter, thoroughly remove all traces of road salt  
as soon as possible.  
Headlamps, taillamps, turn signal lenses  
When washing the underbody, do not forget to clean the  
inner sides of the wheels.  
Use a mild car wash detergent, such as Mercedes-Benz  
approved Car Shampoo, with plenty of water.  
Note:  
To prevent scratches, never apply strong force and use  
only a soft, non-scratchy cloth when cleaning the lenses.  
Do not attempt to wipe dirty lenses with a dry cloth or  
sponge.  
Vehicles with KEYLESS-GO:  
If a door handle is hit by a strong jet of water, and a  
KEYLESS-GO-card is in close proximity, approx 3 ft.  
(approx.1m), the vehicle could be inadvertently locked  
or unlocked.  
Cleaning and care of the vehicle  
377  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwanlroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
   
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Cleaning and care of the vehicle  
Cleaning the Distronic system sensor  
378  
Cleaning the parktronic system sensors  
1
1
1
Use a mild car wash detergent, such as Mercedes-Benz  
approved Car Shampoo, with plenty of water to clean  
the sensor (1).  
Use a mild car wash detergent, such as Mercedes-Benz  
approved Car Shampoo, with plenty of water.  
When using a steam cleaner or power washer, aim  
nozzle only briefly from a minimum distance of 4 in.  
(10 cm) at sensors (1).  
To prevent scratches, never apply strong force and use  
only a soft, non-scratchy cloth when cleaning the  
sensor. Do not attempt to wipe dirty sensors with a dry  
cloth or sponge.  
To prevent scratches, never apply strong force and use  
only a soft, non-scratchy cloth when cleaning the  
sensors. Do not attempt to wipe dirty sensors with a dry  
cloth or sponge.  
Note:  
Restart the engine after cleaning the sensor (1).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Wiper blades  
To prevent damage to the hood or the wipers, the wiper  
arms should only be folded forward in the position  
shown above.  
Turn electronic key in starter switch to position 1.  
Turn combination switch to position I, see page 160.  
Once the wiper arms are in the position shown  
above, turn key in starter switch to position 0.  
Note:  
For safety reasons, remove electronic key from  
starter switch before cleaning the wiper blades,  
otherwise the wiper motor can suddenly turn on and  
cause injury.  
Turn combination switch to position 0, see page 160.  
Clean the wiper blade rubber with a clean cloth and  
detergent solution.  
Cleaning and care of the vehicle  
379  
Instruments  
Operation  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwanlroacda.re  
Technical  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
and controls  
cluster display  
data  
 
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Cleaning and care of the vehicle  
Window cleaning  
380  
Light alloy wheels  
Use a window cleaning solution on all glass surfaces. An  
automotive glass cleaner is recommended.  
Mercedes-Benz approved Wheel Care should be used for  
regular cleaning of the light alloy wheels.  
If possible, clean wheels once a week with Mercedes-  
Benz approved Wheel Care, using a soft bristle brush  
and a strong spray of water.  
Note:  
For safety reasons, switch off wipers and remove  
electronic key from starter switch before cleaning the  
windshield, otherwise the wiper motor can suddenly  
turn on and cause injury.  
Follow instructions on container.  
Note:  
Use only acid-free cleaning materials. The acid could  
lead to corrosion.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Instrument cluster  
Cup holder  
Use a gentle dishwashing detergent or mild detergent  
for delicate fabrics as a washing solution. Wipe with a  
cloth moistened in lukewarm solution. Do not use  
scouring agents.  
Use a gentle dishwashing detergent or mild detergent  
for delicate fabrics as a washing solution. Wipe with a  
cloth moistened in lukewarm solution. Do not use  
scouring agents.  
Note:  
Steering wheel and gear selector lever  
For ease of cleaning, the cup holder between the front  
seats can be removed by pulling it up when in its closed  
position.  
Wipe with a damp cloth and dry thoroughly or clean  
with Mercedes-Benz approved Leather Care.  
Cleaning and care of the vehicle  
381  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwanlroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
     
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Cleaning and care of the vehicle  
Seat belts  
382  
Leather upholstery  
The webbing must not be treated with chemical  
cleaning agents. Use only clear, lukewarm water and  
soap. Do not dry the webbing at temperatures above  
176°F (80°C) or in direct sunlight.  
Using aftermarket seat covers or wearing clothing that  
have the tendency to give off coloring (e.g. when wet  
etc.) may cause the upholstery to become permanently  
discolored. By lining the seats with a proper  
intermediate cover, contact-discoloration will be  
prevented.  
Warning!  
Wipe leather upholstery with a damp cloth and dry  
thoroughly or clean with Mercedes-Benz approved  
Leather Care. Exercise particular care when cleaning  
perforated leather as its underside should not become  
wet.  
Do not bleach or dye seat belts as this may severely  
weaken them. In a crash they may not be able to  
provide adequate protection.  
Headliner and shelf below rear window  
Clean with soft bristle brush, or use a dry-shampoo  
cleaner in case of excessive dirt.  
Hard plastic trim items  
Pour Mercedes-Benz approved Interior Care onto soft  
lint-free cloth and apply with light pressure.  
Plastic and rubber parts  
Do not use oil or wax on these parts.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Engine oil additives ......................395  
Air conditioner  
refrigerant ................................. 395  
Brake fluid ...................................... 395  
Premium unleaded  
gasoline ...................................... 396  
Fuel requirements ........................ 396  
Gasoline additives .........................397  
Coolants ..........................................397  
Consumer information ................. 399  
Technical data  
Spare parts service ........................384  
Warranty coverage .........................384  
Identification labels .......................385  
Layout of poly-V-belt drive ............387  
Technical data ................................388  
Fuels, coolants,  
lubricants etc. - capacities .......393  
Engine oils ......................................395  
Contents - Technical data  
383  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Index  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Technical data  
384  
Spare parts service  
Warranty coverage  
All authorized Mercedes-Benz Centers maintain a stock  
of original spare parts required for maintenance and  
repair work. In addition, strategically located parts  
distribution centers provide quick and reliable parts  
service.  
Your vehicle is covered under the terms of the  
“warranties” printed in the Service and Warranty  
Information booklet and your authorized  
Mercedes-Benz Center will exchange or repair any  
defective parts originally installed on the vehicle in  
accordance with the terms of the following warranties:  
More than 300 000 different spare parts, for  
Mercedes-Benz models, are available.  
1. New vehicle limited warranty  
2. Emission system warranty  
3. Emission performance warranty  
Mercedes-Benz original spare parts are subjected to  
stringent quality inspections. Each part has been  
specifically developed, manufactured or selected for and  
adapted to Mercedes-Benz vehicles.  
4. California, Massachusetts, and Vermont emission  
control systems warranty  
Therefore, Mercedes-Benz original spare parts should  
be installed.  
Replacement parts and accessories are covered by the  
Mercedes-Benz Spare Parts and Accessories warranties,  
copies of which are available at any Mercedes-Benz  
Center.  
Important!  
The use of non-genuine parts and accessories not  
authorized by Mercedes-Benz could damage the vehicle  
which damage is not covered by the Mercedes-Benz  
Limited Warranty or compromise its durability or safety.  
Loss of Service and Warranty Information Booklet  
Should you lose your Service and Warranty Information  
booklet, have your authorized Mercedes-Benz Center  
arrange for a replacement. It will be mailed to you.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Identification labels  
2 Vehicle Identification Number (VIN)  
1 Certification label  
(below right rear passenger seat)  
(below driver’s door lock latch)  
Technical data  
385  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
 
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Technical data  
386  
3 Engine number  
4 VIN, visible (lower edge of windshield)  
5 Emission control label  
6 Information label, California version  
Vacuum line routing for emission control system  
When ordering spare parts, please specify vehicle  
identification and engine numbers.  
P61.20-2014-26  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Layout of poly-V-belt drive  
6
7
8
1
4
5
2
3
CL 500, CL 55 AMG  
CL 600  
1 Automatic belt tensioner  
2 Crankshaft  
5 Generator (alternator)  
6 Idler pulley  
3 Air conditioner compressor  
4 Coolant pump  
7 Power steering pump  
8 Idler pulley (CL 600 only)  
Technical data  
387  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
 
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Technical data  
388  
Technical data  
Model  
CL 500 (215.3751)  
113  
CL 55 AMG (215.3731)  
CL 600 (215.3781)  
Engine  
113  
137  
Mode of operation  
4-stroke engine,  
gasoline injection  
4-stroke engine,  
gasoline injection  
4-stroke engine,  
gasoline injection  
No. of cylinders  
Bore  
8
8
12  
3.82 in (97.00 mm)  
3.31 in (84.00 mm)  
303.5 cu.in. (4966 cm3)  
10:1  
3.82 in (97.00 mm)  
3.60 in (92.00 mm)  
332.0 cu.in. (5439 cm3)  
10.5:1  
3.31 in (84.00 mm)  
3.43 in (87.00 mm)  
353.6 cu.in. (5786 cm3)  
10:1  
Stroke  
Total piston displacement  
Compression ratio  
Output acc.  
to SAE J 1349  
302 hp/5600 rpm  
(225 kW/5600 rpm)  
355 hp/5500 rpm  
(265 kW/5500 rpm)  
362 hp/5500 rpm  
(270 kW/5500 rpm)  
Maximum torque acc.  
to SAE J 1349  
339 ft-lb/2700 rpm  
(460 Nm/2700 rpm)  
390 ft.lb/3150 rpm  
(530 Nm/3150 rpm)  
391 ft-lb/4100 rpm  
(530 Nm/4100 rpm)  
Maximum engine speed  
Firing order  
6000 rpm  
6000 rpm  
6000 rpm  
1-5-4-2-6-3-7-8  
2390 mm  
1-5-4-2-6-3-7-8  
2390 mm  
1-12-5-8-3-10-6-7-2-11-4-9  
2345 mm  
Poly-V-belt  
1
The quoted data apply only to the standard vehicle. See an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center for the  
corresponding data of all special bodies and special equipment.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Rims – Tires  
Model  
CL 500, CL 600  
(except Sport Package)  
Model  
CL 500, CL 600  
(Sport Package)  
Rims (light alloy)  
Wheel offset:  
71/2 J x 17 H 2  
1.81 in (46 mm)  
Rims front axle  
AMG light alloy rims  
Wheel offset:  
81/2 J x 18 H 2  
1.73 in (44 mm)  
All season tires:  
Radial-ply tires  
225/55 R17 97H  
Rims rear axle  
AMG light alloy rims  
Wheel offset:  
91/2 J x 18 H 2  
1.81 in (46 mm)  
Winter tires:  
Radial-ply tires  
225/55 R17 97H M+S  
Radial-ply tires  
front axle  
rear axle  
245/45 R18 96Y1  
275/40 R18 99Y M02, 3  
Spare wheel  
Rim (light alloy)  
Wheel offset:  
71/2 J x 17 H 2  
2.0 in (51 mm)  
Spare wheel  
All season tire:  
Radial-ply tire  
Rim (light alloy)  
Wheel offset:  
71/2 J x 17 H 2  
1.81 in (46 mm)  
225/55 R17 97H  
All season tire:  
Radial-ply tire  
225/55 R17 97H  
1
2
3
Also permissible 245/45 ZR18  
Also permissible 275/40 ZR183  
Must not be used with snow chains.  
Technical data  
389  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
 
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Technical data  
390  
Rims – Winter tires  
Model  
Model  
CL 55 AMG  
CL 55 AMG  
Rims front axle  
AMG light alloy rims  
Wheel offset:  
Rim (light alloy)  
Wheel offset  
71/2 J x 17 H 2  
1.81 in (46 mm)  
81/2 J x 18 H 2  
1.73 in (44 mm)  
Winter tires:  
Rims rear axle  
AMG light alloy rims  
Radial-ply tires  
225/55 R17 97H M+S  
91/2 J x 18 H 2  
Wheel offset:  
1.81 in (46 mm)  
Radial-ply tires  
front axle  
rear axle  
245/45 R18 96Y1  
275/40 R18 99Y M02, 3  
Spare wheel  
Rim (light alloy)  
Wheel offset:  
71/2 J x 17 H 2  
1.81 in (46 mm)  
All season tire:  
Radial-ply tire  
225/55 R17 97H  
1
2
3
Also permissible 245/45 ZR18  
Also permissible 275/40 ZR183  
Must not be used with snow chains.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Electrical system  
Model  
CL 500  
CL 55 AMG  
14 V/150 A  
CL 600  
Generator (alternator)  
Starter motor  
Battery  
14 V/150 A  
12V/1.7 kW  
12V/100 Ah  
14 V/150 A  
12V/1.7 kW  
12V/100 Ah  
Bosch F 8 DPER  
12V/2.2 kW  
12V/100 Ah  
Beru 14 F 7-DPUR X 2  
Spark plugs  
Bosch F 8 DPER  
Beru 14 FGH 8 DPUR X 2  
NGK PFR 5 R-11  
0.039 in (1.0 mm)  
Electrode gap  
0.039 in (1.0 mm)  
0.041 in (1.05 mm)  
Tightening torque  
15 – 22 ft.lb (20 – 30 Nm) 15 – 22 ft.lb (20 – 30 Nm) 15 – 22 ft.lb (20 – 30 Nm)  
Technical data  
391  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
 
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Technical data  
392  
Main Dimensions  
Model  
CL 500  
CL 55 AMG  
CL 600  
Overall vehicle length  
Overall vehicle width  
Overall vehicle height  
Wheel base  
196.6 in (4993 mm)  
73.1 in (1857 mm)  
54.9 in (1394 mm)  
113.6 in (2885 mm)  
62.1 in (1577 mm)  
62.1 in (1578 mm)  
196.6 in (4993 mm)  
73.1 in (1857 mm)  
54.9 in (1394 mm)  
113.6 in (2885 mm)  
62.1 in (1577 mm)  
62.1 in (1578 mm)  
196.6 in (4993 mm)  
73.1 in (1857 mm)  
54.9 in (1394 mm)  
113.6 in (2885 mm)  
62.1 in (1577 mm)  
62.1 in (1578 mm)  
Track, front  
Track, rear  
Weights  
Roof load max.  
220 lb (100 kg)  
220 lb (100 kg)  
Trunk load max.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Fuels, coolants, lubricants etc. - capacities  
Vehicle components and their respective lubricants must match. Therefore use only brands tested and recommended  
by us. Please refer to the Factory Approved Service Products pamphlet, or inquire at your Mercedes-Benz Center.  
Model  
Capacity  
Fuels, coolants, lubricants etc.  
Engine with oil filter  
CL 500  
8.5 US qt (8.0 l)  
Recommended engine oils  
CL 55 AMG 8.0 US qt (7.5 l)  
CL 600  
10.0 US qt (9.5 l)  
Automatic transmission  
Rear axle  
9.6 US qt (9.1 l)  
Automatic transmission fluid  
Hypoid gear oil SAE 85 W 90  
MB Hydraulic fluid  
1.7 US qt (1.6 l)  
Hydraulic system for  
approx. 5.3 US qt (5.0 l)  
active body control (ABC)  
Power steering  
Front wheel hubs  
Brake system  
approx. 1.1 US qt (1.0 l)  
MB Power steering fluid  
approx. 2.1 oz (60 g) each High temperature roller bearing grease  
0.7 US qt (0.7 l) MB Brake fluid (DOT 4+)  
approx. 12.1 US qt (11.5 l) MB Anticorrosion/antifreeze  
CL 55 AMG approx. 12.1 US qt (11.5 l)  
Cooling system  
CL 500  
CL 600  
approx. 12.7 US qt (12.0 l)  
Fuels, coolants, lubricants etc. - capacities  
Instruments  
393  
Instrument  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Index  
and controls  
cluster display  
     
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Fuels, coolants, lubricants etc. - capacities  
Model  
394  
Capacity  
Fuels, coolants, lubricants etc.  
Fuel tank  
including a reserve of  
23.2 US gal (88.0 l)  
2.9 US gal (11.0 l)  
Premium unleaded gasoline:  
Posted Octane 91 (Avg. of 96 RON/86 MON)  
Air conditioner system  
R-134a refrigerant and special PAG lubricant  
(Never R-12)  
MB Windshield washer concentrate1  
Windshield washer and  
7.1 US qt (6.7 l)  
headlamp cleaning system  
1
Use MB Windshield Washer Concentrate “S” and water for temperatures above freezing or MB Windshield Washer Concentrate “S” and  
commercially available premixed windshield washer solvent/antifreeze for temperatures below freezing. Follow suggested mixing ratios, see  
page 334.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Engine oils  
Air conditioner refrigerant  
Engine oils are specifically tested for their suitability in  
our engines. Therefore, use only engine oils  
recommended by Mercedes-Benz. Information on  
recommended brands is available at your authorized  
Mercedes-Benz Center.  
R-134a (HFC) refrigerant and special PAG lubricating oil  
is used in the air conditioner system.  
Never use R-12 (CFC) or mineral-based lubricating oil,  
otherwise damage to the system will occur.  
Please follow Service Booklet recommendations for  
scheduled oil changes. Failure to do so could result in  
engine damage not covered by the Mercedes-Benz  
Limited Warranty.  
Brake fluid  
During vehicle operation, the boiling point of the brake  
fluid is continuously reduced through the absorption of  
moisture from the atmosphere. Under extremely hard  
operating conditions, this moisture content can lead to  
the formation of bubbles in the system thus reducing  
the system’s efficiency.  
Engine oil additives  
Do not blend oil additives with engine oil. They may be  
harmful to the engine operation.  
The brake fluid must therefore be replaced every two  
years, preferably in the spring.  
Damage or malfunctions resulting from blending oil  
additives are not covered by the Mercedes-Benz Limited  
Warranty.  
It is recommended to use only brake fluid approved by  
Mercedes-Benz. Your authorized Mercedes-Benz Center  
will provide you with additional information.  
Fuels, coolants, lubricants etc. - capacities  
395  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
       
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Fuels, coolants, lubricants etc. - capacities  
Premium unleaded gasoline  
396  
Fuel requirements  
Use only Premium unleaded meeting ASTM  
standard D 439:  
Caution!  
To maintain the engine’s durability and performance,  
premium unleaded gasoline must be used. If premium  
unleaded is not available and low octane fuel is used,  
follow these precautions:  
The octane number (posted at the pump) must be  
91 min. It is an average of both the Research (R) octane  
number and the Motor (M) octane number: (R+M)/2).  
This is also known as ANTI-KNOCK INDEX.  
have the fuel tank filled only partially with unleaded  
regular and fill up with premium unleaded as soon  
as possible,  
Unleaded gasoline containing oxygenates such as  
Ethanol, IPA, IBA and TBA can be used provided the  
ratio of any one of these oxygenates to gasoline does not  
exceed 10%, MTBE not to exceed 15%.  
avoid full throttle driving and abrupt acceleration,  
The ratio of Methanol to gasoline must not exceed 3%  
plus additional cosolvents.  
do not exceed an engine speed of 3000 rpm, if the  
vehicle is loaded with a light load such as two  
persons and no luggage,  
do not exceed 2/3 of maximum accelerator pedal  
position, if the vehicle is fully loaded or operating in  
mountainous terrain.  
Using mixtures of Ethanol and Methanol is not allowed.  
Gasohol, which contains 10% Ethanol and 90% unleaded  
gasoline, can be used.  
These blends must also meet all other fuel requirements  
such as resistance to spark knock, boiling range, vapor  
pressure etc..  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Gasoline additives  
Coolants  
A major concern among engine manufacturers is carbon  
build up caused by gasoline. Mercedes-Benz  
The engine coolant is a mixture of water and  
anticorrosion/antifreeze, which provides:  
recommends the use of only quality gasoline containing  
additives that prevent the build up of carbon deposits.  
corrosion protection,  
freeze protection,  
After an extended period of using fuels without such  
additives, carbon deposits can build up especially on the  
intake valves and in the combustion area, leading to  
engine performance problems such as:  
boiling protection (by increasing the boiling point).  
The cooling system was filled at the factory with a  
coolant providing freeze protection to approximately  
-22°F (-30°C) and corrosion protection.  
warm-up hesitation,  
unstable idle,  
knocking/pinging,  
misfire,  
If the antifreeze mixture is effective to -22°F (-30°C), the  
boiling point of the coolant in the pressurized cooling  
system is reached at approximately 266°F (130°C).  
The coolant solution must be used year round to provide  
the necessary corrosion protection and increase in the  
boil-over protection. You should have it replaced every  
3 years.  
power loss.  
Do not blend other specific fuel additives with fuel.  
They only result in unnecessary cost, and may be  
harmful to the engine operation.  
To provide the important corrosion protection, the  
solution must be at least 45% anticorrosion/antifreeze  
(equals a freeze protection to approx. - 22°F [-30°C]). If  
you use a solution that is more than 55% anticorrosion/  
antifreeze (freeze protection to approx. - 49°F [-45°C]),  
Damage or malfunctions resulting from poor fuel  
quality or from blending specific fuel additives are not  
covered by the Mercedes-Benz Limited Warranty.  
Fuels, coolants, lubricants etc. - capacities  
397  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
   
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Fuels, coolants, lubricants etc. - capacities  
398  
the engine temperature will increase due to the lower  
heat transfer capability of the solution. Therefore, do not  
use more than this amount of anticorrosion/antifreeze.  
Before the start of the winter season (or once a year in  
the hot southern regions), you should have the  
anticorrosion/antifreeze concentration checked. The  
coolant is also regularly checked each time you bring  
your vehicle to your authorized Mercedes-Benz Center  
for service.  
If the coolant level is low, water and MB anticorrosion/  
antifreeze should be used to bring it up to the proper  
level (have cooling system checked for signs of leakage).  
Anticorrosion/antifreeze quantity  
The water in the cooling system must meet minimum  
requirements, which are usually satisfied by normal  
drinking water. If you are not sure about the water  
quality, consult your authorized Mercedes-Benz Center.  
Model  
Approx. freeze protection  
– 35°F  
(– 37°C)  
– 49°F  
(– 45°C)  
Anticorrosion/antifreeze  
CL 500,  
CL 55 AMG  
6.1 US qt  
(5.75 l)  
6.7 US qt  
(6.3 l)  
Your vehicle contains a number of aluminium parts. The  
use of aluminium components in motor vehicle engines  
necessitates that anticorrosion/antifreeze coolant used  
in such engines be specifically formulated to protect the  
aluminium parts. (Failure to use such anticorrosion/  
antifreeze coolant will result in a significantly  
shortened service life.)  
CL 600  
6.3 US qt  
(6.0 l)  
7.0 US qt  
(6.6 l)  
Therefore the following product is strongly  
recommended for use in your vehicle: Mercedes-Benz  
anticorrosion/antifreeze agent.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Consumer information  
may depart significantly from the norm due to  
variations in driving habits, service practices and  
differences in road characteristics and climate.  
This has been prepared as required of all manufactures  
of passenger cars under Title 49, Code of U.S. Federal  
Regulations, Part 575 pursuant to the “National Traffic  
and Motor Vehicle Safety Act of 1966”.  
Traction  
The traction grades, from highest to lowest are AA, A, B,  
and C. Those grades represent the tire’s ability to stop  
on wet pavement as measured under controlled  
conditions on specified government test surfaces of  
asphalt and concrete. A tire marked C may have poor  
traction performance.  
Uniform tire quality grading  
Quality grades can be found where applicable on the  
tire sidewall between tread shoulder and maximum  
section width. For example:  
Tread wear 200 Traction AA  
Temperature A  
Warning!  
The traction grade assigned to this tire is based on  
straightahead braking traction tests, and does not  
include acceleration, cornering, hydroplaning, or  
peak traction characteristics.  
All passenger car tires must conform to federal safety  
requirements in addition to these grades.  
Treadwear  
The treadwear grade is a comparative rating based on  
the wear rate of the tire when tested under controlled  
conditions on a specified government test course. For  
example, a tire graded 150 would wear one and one-half  
(1 1/2) times as well on the government course as a tire  
graded 100. The relative performance of tires depends  
upon the actual conditions of their use, however, and  
Consumer information  
399  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
 
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Consumer information  
400  
Temperature  
Warning!  
The temperature grades are A (the highest), B, and C,  
representing the tire’s resistance to the generation of  
heat and its ability to dissipate heat when tested under  
controlled conditions on a specified indoor laboratory  
test wheel. Sustained high temperature can cause the  
material of the tire to degenerate and reduce tire life,  
and excessive temperature can lead to sudden tire  
failure. The grade C corresponds to a level of  
The temperature grade for this tire is established  
for a tire that is properly inflated and not  
overloaded. Excessive speed, underinflation, or  
excessive loading, either separately or in  
combination, can cause excessive heat build up  
and possible tire failure.  
performance which all passenger car tires must meet  
under the Federal Motor Vehicle Safety Standard  
No. 109. Grades B and A represent higher levels of  
performance on the laboratory test wheel than the  
minimum required by law.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Aquaplaning .................................................................. 244  
Armrest, rear bench .......................................................195  
Ashtrays ...........................................................................196  
Center console, front ................................................196  
Rear seats ...................................................................197  
Audio systems .................................................................125  
Cassette player ..........................................................127  
CD player ....................................................................126  
Radio ...........................................................................125  
Automatic central locking ..............................................52  
Automatic climate control ............................................164  
Activated charcoal filter ...........................................172  
Adjustable air outlets,  
Index  
A
ABS (Antilock brake system) .......................................269  
Malfunction indicator lamp .....................................294  
ACTIVE BODY CONTROL -  
malfunction and warning messages ...................... 310  
Active body control (ABC) ............................................275  
Active body control (ABC) fluid level .........................332  
Air conditioner refrigerant ...........................................395  
Air distribution, manual ...............................................169  
Air volume, manual .......................................................169  
Airbag deactivation system ............................................88  
Airbag OFF indicator lamp ...........................................296  
Airbags ..............................................................................92  
Front airbags ...............................................................92  
Side impact airbags ....................................................95  
Window curtain airbags .............................................95  
Alarm system ............................................................. 62, 64  
Anticorrosion/antifreeze ................... 247, 333, 393, 398  
Antiglare night position ...............................................106  
Antilock brake system (ABS) .......................................269  
Malfunction indicator lamp .....................................294  
Antitheft alarm system ...................................................62  
rear passenger compartment .............................177  
Air distribution, manual ..........................................169  
Air recirculation ........................................................ 171  
Air volume, manual ..................................................169  
Basic setting ...............................................................168  
Defogging windows ...........................................170, 171  
Defrosting ...................................................................170  
Display and controls .................................................166  
Dust filter ...................................................................167  
Economy mode ..........................................................173  
Front center console  
storage compartment ventilation .......................175  
Rear window defroster ............................................. 176  
Index  
401  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Index  
data  
   
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Index  
402  
Residual engine heat utilization ............................ 174  
Special settings .........................................................169  
Switching on and off ................................................175  
Windows fogged on the inside ................................170  
Windows fogged on the outside .............................. 171  
Emergency operation ...............................................237  
Fluid level ...................................................................332  
Program mode selector switch ...............................236  
Selector lever position ..............................................232  
Brake fluid ...........................................240, 292, 393, 395  
BRAKE FLUID -  
malfunction and warning messages ......................301  
BRAKE LINING WEAR -  
malfunction and warning messages ......................301  
Brake pad wear ...............................................................301  
Brake warning lamp ..................................................... 292  
Brake fluid low ......................................................... 292  
Brakes ...................................................238, 240, 268, 272  
C
B
Capacities  
BabySmartTM airbag deactivation system .....................88  
Self-test .........................................................................89  
Backrest .............................................................................72  
BAS (Brake assist system) ............................................268  
Battery .............................................................................346  
Battery recycling .......................................................348  
BATTERY/ALTERNATOR -  
Fuels, coolants, lubricants etc. .............................. 393  
Card, KEYLESS-GO ..........................................................28  
Cargo tie-down hooks ................................................... 200  
Catalytic converter ........................................................ 220  
Center console ..................................................................24  
Center console lighting .................................................185  
Central locking switch ....................................................50  
Central locking system ....................................................34  
Automatic central locking .........................................52  
Central locking switch ...............................................50  
Choosing global or selective mode .....................37, 43  
Electronic main key ....................................................29  
malfunction and warning messages ......................299  
Block heater ....................................................................249  
BRAKE ASSIST - malfunction  
and warning messages ............................................300  
Brake assist system (BAS) ............................................268  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
KEYLESS-GO-card ....................................................... 31  
Locking and unlocking ..............................................36  
Locking and unlocking  
with KEYLESS-GO-card .........................................40  
Mechanical keys ..........................................................47  
Remote control ............................................................28  
Simultaneous use of electronic main key  
COOLANT (coolant temperature) -  
malfunction and warning messages ..................... 305  
Coolant level  
Adding ........................................................................ 333  
Checking .................................................................... 333  
Coolant temperature gauge .......................................... 117  
Coolants .......................................................................... 397  
Anticorrosion/antifreeze quantity ........................ 398  
Courtesy lighting ...........................................................185  
Cruise control ................................................................ 250  
CRUISE CONTROL -  
and KEYLESS-GO-card ..........................................44  
Changing batteries in the KEYLESS-GO-card ...........366  
Changing wheels ...........................................................340  
CHECK ENGINE  
malfunction and warning messages ..................... 309  
Cup holder  
malfunction indicator lamp .....................................290  
Check regularly and before a long trip ......................287  
Checking engine oil level  
Center console, front ................................................193  
Rear bench armrest ...................................................195  
Via engine oil level indicator ..................................154  
Via oil dipstick ...........................................................331  
Child restraint ............................................70, 82, 88, 102  
Cleaning and care of the vehicle .................................374  
Coat hooks ...................................................................... 192  
COMAND, radio and telephone ...................................208  
Combination switch ......................................................160  
Consumer information ..................................................399  
Control and operation of radio transmitters .............208  
COOLANT (coolant level) -  
D
Dashboard .........................................................................22  
Daytime running lamps ................................................158  
Deep water  
Driving instructions ................................................ 248  
DISPLAY DEFECTIVE (engine control unit) -  
malfunction and warning messages ..................... 298  
DISPLAY DEFECTIVE (several systems) -  
malfunction and warning messages ......................304  
malfunction and warning messages ..................... 298  
Index  
403  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Index  
data  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Index  
404  
Display illumination .......................................................116  
Distronic (DTR) ...................................................... 133, 253  
Activation of Distronic .............................................256  
Additional driving hints ..........................................261  
Cleaning sensor ........................................................378  
Displays in the speedometer dial ...........................267  
Distance warning function ......................................264  
Distronic settings ......................................................265  
Driving with Distronic activated ............................259  
Invalid attempts to activate .....................................257  
Multifunction display ...............................................266  
Warning lamp ............................................................295  
DISTRONIC (DTR) -  
E
Easy-entry/exit feature ...................................................66  
ELEC. STABIL. PROGR. -  
malfunction and warning messages ..................... 303  
Electronic main key .........................................................29  
Changing batteries .................................................. 363  
Synchronizing remote control ............................... 365  
Electronic stability program (ESP) ..............................271  
Warning lamp ........................................................... 295  
Emergency call  
See Tele Aid ...............................................................210  
Emergency engine shut-down ..................................... 368  
Emergency operation of sliding/pop-up roof ............ 369  
Emergency tensioning retractor (ETR) .........................91  
Emergency trunk lid release button .............................61  
Emergency unlocking in case of accident ...................52  
Emission control ............................................................221  
Emission control label .................................................. 386  
Engine compartment .................................................... 328  
Engine malfunction  
malfunction and warning messages ......................321  
DOOR -  
malfunction and warning messages ...................... 316  
Door control panel ...........................................................20  
Door entry lamps ...........................................................185  
Doors ..................................................................................48  
Power closing assist ...................................................50  
Drinking and driving ....................................................239  
Drive sensibly - save fuel ..............................................239  
Driving instructions ......................................................239  
Driving off .......................................................................241  
CHECK ENGINE  
malfunction indicator lamp ............................... 290  
Engine oil additives ...................................................... 395  
Engine oil consumption ................................................155  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Engine oil level  
Side marker lamp, front .......................................... 360  
Standing lamps ......................................................... 357  
Taillamp assemblies ................................................ 358  
Turn signal lamp ...................................................... 357  
Exterior mirror adjustment ..........................................107  
Checking ....................................................................331  
Warning .............................................................. 314, 318  
ENGINE OIL LEVEL -  
malfunction and warning messages ..............314, 318  
ENGINE OIL LEVEL - NOT WHEN ENGINE ON  
Exterior mirror, front passenger side,  
(measuring) - multifunction indicator ...................154  
parking position ........................................................108  
Engine oil level indicator ..............................................154  
Entrance lamps, exit lamps ..........................................185  
ENTRANCE POSITION -  
Exterior rear view mirrors ............................................107  
Electrically folding ....................................................109  
Parking position ........................................................108  
malfunction and warning messages ......................300  
ESP (Electronic stability program) .............245, 271, 353  
Control switch ...........................................................273  
Malfunction and warning messages ......................303  
Synchronizing ...........................................................272  
Exterior lamp  
malfunction and warning messages ......................306  
Exterior lamp switch .....................................................156  
Daytime running lamp mode ..................................158  
Headlamp cleaning system .....................................159  
Exterior lamps ................................................................354  
License plate lamps ..................................................360  
Low and high beam ..................................................355  
Parking lamps ...........................................................357  
Replacing bulbs .........................................................354  
F
Fastening seat belts .........................................................85  
First aid kit ..................................................................... 324  
Flexible service system (FSS) ......................................147  
Footwell lighting ............................................................185  
Front airbags ....................................................................92  
Front center console  
storage compartment ventilation ............................175  
Front seat adjustment .....................................................67  
Fuel  
Gasoline additives .................................................... 397  
Premium unleaded gasoline ..................285, 394, 396  
Fuel cap placement warning  
Index  
405  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Index  
data  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Index  
406  
See CHECK ENGINE  
Headlamp adjustment .................................................. 354  
Headlamp cleaning system ...........................................159  
Headlamp mode (HEADLAMPS) ..................................157  
Headlights .......................................................................156  
Heated seats ...................................................................... 76  
Hood ................................................................................ 328  
malfunction indicator lamp ................................290  
Fuel filler flap, manual release ...................................368  
Fuel requirements .........................................................396  
Fuel reserve warning ....................................................293  
Fuels, coolants, lubricants etc. - capacities ...............393  
Fuses, electrical .............................................................325  
HOOD -  
malfunction and warning messages ......................317  
G
I
Garage door opener .......................................................202  
Gasoline  
Identification labels ...................................................... 385  
Illuminated vanity mirrors ...........................................187  
Indicator lamps in the instrument cluster ........ 114, 290  
Individual settings .........................................................138  
"INSTRUMENT CLUSTER" .......................................140  
"LIGHTING" ................................................................142  
"VEHICLE" .................................................................144  
Infant and child restraint systems ..............................102  
Installation .................................................................104  
Information call  
Additives ....................................................................397  
Fuel requirements ....................................................396  
Premium unleaded ...................................................396  
General notes on the central locking system ..............33  
Glove box .........................................................................189  
H
Hazard warning flasher switch ...................................163  
Head restraints  
Power head restraints, rear ....................................... 81  
Head restraints, front seats  
See Tele Aid ...............................................................210  
Infrared reflecting windshield .................................... 206  
Inside rear view mirror .................................................106  
INSTRUMENT CLUSTER  
Removal and installation ........................................... 71  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
See individual settings ............................................140  
Instrument cluster ..........................................................114  
Activating ....................................................................116  
Instrument cluster illumination ...................................116  
Instrument lamps ...........................................................116  
Instruments and controls ............................................... 18  
Interior  
Convenience feature ...................................................45  
Keys, vehicle .....................................................................28  
L
Lamps, exterior .............................................................. 354  
Headlamps ................................................156, 306, 377  
License plate lamp ................................................... 360  
Low and high beam .................................................. 355  
Parking lamps ........................................................... 357  
Replacing bulbs ........................................................ 354  
Side marker lamp, front .......................................... 360  
Standing lamps ......................................................... 357  
Taillamp assemblies ................................................ 358  
Turn signal lamp ...................................................... 357  
Layout of poly-V-belt drive ........................................... 387  
Level control system ......................................................276  
LIGHT SENSOR - malfunction  
Interior lighting .............................................................184  
J
Jack ...................................................................................336  
Jump starting ..................................................................349  
K
KEYLESS-GO .....................................................................38  
Changing batteries in the card ...............................366  
Checking last KEYLESS-GO-card locking mode .....43  
Choosing global or selective mode ...........................43  
Easy-entry/exit feature ..............................................66  
Starting the engine ...................................................227  
Turning off the engine .............................................228  
KEYLESS-GO-card ......................................................28, 31  
and warning messages ....................................308, 320  
Lighter .............................................................................198  
LIGHTING  
See individual settings .............................................142  
LIGHTING SYSTEM - malfunction  
and warning messages ............................................ 306  
Limp home mode (Automatic transmission) ............ 237  
Index  
407  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Index  
data  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Index  
408  
Locking and unlocking ............................................ 36, 40  
Low engine coolant level warning ..............................304  
Lumbar support ............................................................... 74  
HOOD ..........................................................................317  
KEY .............................................................................. 316  
LIGHT SENSOR .................................................308, 320  
LIGHTING SYSTEM .................................................. 306  
PARKING BRAKE ..................................................... 302  
SEAT BACKREST .......................................................315  
SEAT BELT SYSTEM ................................................. 308  
TELE AID ....................................................................317  
TELEPHONE - FUNCTION ....................................... 309  
TIRE PRESSURE ........................................................312  
TRUNK OPEN ........................................................... 302  
WASHER FLUID ......................................................... 319  
Malfunction/warning message memory ....................136  
Manual operation of sliding/pop-up roof .................. 369  
Mechanical keys ...............................................................47  
Memory function ............................................................111  
Mirror, exterior  
M
Maintenance ...................................................................209  
Malfunction and indicator lamps  
in the instrument cluster .........................................290  
Malfunction and warning messages ...........................297  
ACTIVE BODY CONTROL ......................................... 310  
BATTERY/ALTERNATOR ..........................................299  
BRAKE ASSIST ..........................................................300  
BRAKE FLUID ............................................................301  
BRAKE LINING WEAR .............................................301  
COOLANT (coolant level) .........................................304  
COOLANT (coolant temperature) ...........................305  
CRUISE CONTROL ....................................................309  
DISPLAY DEFECTIVE (engine control unit) .........298  
DISPLAY DEFECTIVE (several systems) ...............298  
DISTRONIC (DTR) .....................................................321  
DOOR .......................................................................... 316  
ELEC. STABIL. PROG. ...............................................303  
ENGINE OIL LEVEL ..........................................314, 318  
ENTRANCE POSITION .............................................300  
Parking position ........................................................108  
Mirror, exterior, adjusting ............................................107  
Mirror, exterior, parking position,  
front passenger side .................................................108  
Mirror, exterior, rear view ............................................107  
Mirror, inside, rear view ...............................................106  
Multicontour backrest .....................................................74  
Multifunction display ....................................................120  
Audio systems ............................................................125  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Cassette player ..........................................................127  
CD Player ....................................................................126  
Distronic (DTR) .......................................................... 133  
Engine oil level indicator .........................................124  
FSS ..............................................................................124  
Individual settings ....................................................138  
Malfunction/warning message memory ...............136  
Telephone ...................................................................128  
Telephone — Incoming call ...................................... 131  
Telephone — Redialing .............................................130  
Telephone book .........................................................128  
Tire inflation pressure monitor ..............................124  
Trip and main odometer ..........................................124  
Trip computer ............................................................134  
Multifunction steering wheel ......................................120  
O
On-board diagnostic system ........................................ 290  
Operator’s Manual .............................................................8  
Outside temperature indicator ..................................... 117  
Overhead control panel ...................................................21  
Panic button ......................................................................47  
Parcel net in front passenger footwell ....................... 200  
Parcel net in trunk .........................................................199  
Parking ........................................................................... 242  
Parking assist (Parktronic) .......................................... 279  
Parking brake .....................196, 227, 238, 242, 292, 340  
PARKING BRAKE - malfunction  
and warning messages ............................................ 302  
Power assistance ........................................................... 240  
Power closing assist  
N
Doors and trunk lid ....................................................50  
Power head restraints, rear ............................................81  
Power seats, front  
Navigation system .......................................................... 132  
Night security illumination .........................................158  
Backrest ........................................................................72  
Seat ventilation system ..............................................79  
Power windows ...............................................................178  
Blocking of rear side window operation ................180  
Index  
409  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Index  
data  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Index  
410  
Express opening and closing ..................................179  
Opening and closing ..................................................45  
Synchronizing ...........................................................180  
Problems with your vehicle ........................................... 14  
Product information .......................................................... 7  
Replacement keys  
Obtaining ......................................................................31  
Replacing bulbs ............................................................. 354  
Replacing wiper blades ................................................ 370  
Reporting Safety Defects ................................................. 15  
Reserve key .......................................................................30  
Reserve warning lamp  
Fuel reserve warning ............................................... 293  
Residual engine heat utilization (REST) .................... 174  
Roadside assistance .........................................................10  
Roadside assistance call  
R
Radio transmitters .........................................................208  
Rain sensor  
See intermittent wiping ........................................... 161  
Rear passenger compartment  
adjustable air outlets ................................................177  
Rear view mirror  
See Tele Aid ...............................................................210  
Roof rack ......................................................................... 372  
Inside, automatic antiglare .....................................106  
Rear view mirrors ..........................................................106  
Exterior .......................................................................107  
Interior ........................................................................106  
Storing mirror positions ..........................................106  
Rear window defroster ...................................................176  
Rear window sunshade .................................................186  
Remote control .................................................................28  
Battery replacement .................................................363  
S
SEAT BACKREST -  
malfunction and warning messages ......................315  
SEAT BELT SYSTEM -  
malfunction and warning messages ..................... 308  
Seat belts ...........................................................................82  
Fastening ......................................................................85  
Operation ......................................................................86  
Seat belt nonusage warning system .........................83  
Unfastening ..................................................................86  
Removal and installation of  
front seat head restraints .......................................... 71  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Warning lamp ............................................................296  
Seat belts and integrated restraint system ..................82  
Seat heater ........................................................................ 76  
Seat ventilation system ...................................................79  
Seats  
SRS malfunction ...............................................................92  
Standby bulb function ...................................................361  
Start lock-out .....................................................................32  
Electronic main key ....................................................32  
KEYLESS-GO-card .......................................................32  
Starter switch .........................................................222, 224  
Starting and turning off the engine ........................... 227  
Electronic main key ................................................. 227  
KEYLESS-GO ............................................................. 227  
Steering lock  
See Starter switch ............................................222, 224  
Steering wheel  
Front seat adjustment ................................................67  
Service indicator  
Setting the audio volume ..............................................146  
Shelf below rear window ..............................................327  
Side impact airbags .........................................................95  
Side marker lamp ..........................................................360  
Simultaneous use of electronic main key  
and KEYLESS-GO-card ...............................................44  
Sliding/pop-up roof ....................................................... 181  
Emergency operation ...............................................369  
Opening and closing ..................................................45  
Synchronizing ...........................................................183  
Snow chains ....................................................................245  
SOS-call  
See Tele Aid ............................................................... 210  
Spare wheel ....................................................................338  
Spare wheel, vehicle tools,  
Easy-entry/exit feature ..............................................66  
Storage compartment  
Trunk floor ................................................................ 335  
Storage compartment in the  
rear passenger compartment ..................................192  
Storage compartments and armrests ..........................188  
Center console ...........................................................190  
Glove box ....................................................................189  
Storing mirror positions ...............................................107  
Sun visors ........................................................................187  
Supplemental restraint system (SRS) ...........................90  
Synchronizing remote control .................................... 365  
storage compartment ................................................335  
Special settings (Automatic climate control) ............169  
SRS indicator lamp ........................................................293  
Index  
411  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Index  
data  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Index  
412  
Tire inflation pressure monitor ...................................150  
Inquiry of present tire inflation pressure .............150  
TIRE PRESSURE -  
T
Tachometer ......................................................................119  
Technical data ................................................................388  
Electrical system .......................................................391  
Main dimensions ......................................................392  
Rims and tires ...........................................................389  
Weights .......................................................................392  
Tele Aid ........................................................................... 210  
Emergency calls ........................................................ 211  
Information ................................................................ 215  
Initiating an emergency call manually ................. 213  
Roadside Assistance ................................................. 214  
malfunction and warning messages ......................312  
Tire traction ................................................................... 244  
Tires ................................................................................ 399  
Driving instructions ................................................ 243  
Rims and tires .......................................................... 389  
Rotating wheels ........................................................ 338  
Tire inflation pressure ............................................ 345  
Tire replacement ...................................................... 337  
Winter driving instructions .................................... 247  
Tow-away alarm ................................................................64  
Towing the vehicle .........................................................351  
Transmission ................................................................. 229  
Traveling abroad ........................................................... 249  
Trip computer .................................................................134  
Trip odometer ................................................................. 119  
Trunk .................................................................................53  
Opening ........................................................................37  
Power closing assist ....................................................50  
Release switch .............................................................57  
Release/close system ..................................................58  
Trunk lid closing feature ...........................................55  
Trunk lamp .....................................................................371  
TELE AID - malfunction  
and warning messages ............................................ 317  
Telephone ........................................................................128  
General notes .............................................................201  
Incoming call ............................................................. 131  
Redialing .................................................................... 130  
Telephone book .........................................................128  
TELEPHONE - FUNCTION -  
malfunction and warning messages ......................309  
Telephones and two-way radios ...................................208  
The first 1 000 miles (1 500 km) ................................209  
Tire inflation pressure ..................................................345  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Trunk lid  
Emergency release ..................................................... 61  
Trunk lid release switch .................................................57  
TRUNK OPEN -  
W
Warranty coverage ........................................................ 384  
WASHER FLUID -  
malfunction and warning messages ...................... 319  
Washing the vehicle ......................................................376  
What you should know at the gas station ................. 284  
Wheels ............................................................................ 337  
Where to find it ................................................................ 13  
Window curtain airbags ..................................................96  
Windshield washer system .......................................... 334  
Winter driving ............................................................... 247  
Winter driving instructions ......................................... 246  
Wiper blades, replacing ............................................... 370  
malfunction and warning messages ......................302  
Turn signal failure .........................................................160  
Turn signals .................................................................... 160  
Turning off the engine  
Electronic main key ..................................................228  
KEYLESS-GO ..............................................................228  
U
Unlocking the vehicle with remote control .................36  
Unlocking with KEYLESS-GO-card ...............................40  
V
Vanity mirrors ................................................................187  
VEHICLE  
See individual settings ............................................144  
Vehicle jack .....................................................................336  
Vehicle keys ......................................................................28  
Vehicle tools ....................................................................335  
Ventilated seats ................................................................79  
Index  
413  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Index  
data  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Service and Literature  
Your authorized Mercedes-Benz Center has trained technicians and original Mercedes-Benz parts to service your  
vehicle properly. For expert advice and quality service, see your authorized Mercedes-Benz Center.  
If you are interested in obtaining service literature for your vehicle, please contact your authorized Mercedes-Benz  
Center. We consider this the best way for you to obtain accurate information for your vehicle.  
For further information you can find us on the Mercedes-Benz site www.mbusa.com.  
Warning!  
To help avoid personal injury, be extremely careful when performing any service work or repairs. Improper  
or incomplete service or the use of incorrect or inappropriate parts or materials may damage the vehicle or its  
equipment, which may in turn result in personal injury.  
If you have any question about carrying out some service, turn to the advice of an authorized Mercedes-Benz  
Center.  
We reserve the right to modify the technical details of the vehicle as given in the data and illustrations of this  
Operator’s Manual. Reprinting, translation and copying, even of excerpts, is not permitted without our prior  
authorization in writing.  
Title illustration no. P00.00-2835-26  
Press time 10/31/00  
MBUSA/TI  
Printed in the U.S.A.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Order No. 65152136 13 Part No. 215 5842282 USA Edition B 2001  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  

Learning Resources Musical Toy Instrument LER 7630 User Manual
Learning Resources Watch LER 2288 User Manual
LifeSource Blood Pressure Monitor UA 851 V VL User Manual
Lynx Music Mixer D AD 3220 B User Manual
Mackie Musical Instrument X200 User Manual
Magic Chef Oven MCSPZO12ST User Manual
Magnavox VCR VRZ255 User Manual
Manhattan Computer Products Car Satellite TV System T2 User Manual
Martin Audio Portable Speaker Screen 4 User Manual
Maytag Refrigerator JS42CSDBFA User Manual